ATTINY25-10PI [ATMEL]

Microcontroller;
ATTINY25-10PI
型号: ATTINY25-10PI
厂家: ATMEL    ATMEL
描述:

Microcontroller

微控制器
文件: 总214页 (文件大小:1943K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
Features  
High Performance, Low Power AVR® 8-Bit Microcontroller  
Advanced RISC Architecture  
– 120 Powerful Instructions – Most Single Clock Cycle Execution  
– 32 x 8 General Purpose Working Registers  
– Fully Static Operation  
Non-volatile Program and Data Memories  
– 2/4/8K Byte of In-System Programmable Program Memory Flash (ATtiny25/45/85)  
Endurance: 10,000 Write/Erase Cycles  
– 128/256/512 Bytes In-System Programmable EEPROM (ATtiny25/45/85)  
Endurance: 100,000 Write/Erase Cycles  
– 128/256/512 Bytes Internal SRAM (ATtiny25/45/85)  
– Programming Lock for Self-Programming Flash Program and EEPROM Data  
Security  
8-bit  
Microcontroller  
with 2/4/8K  
Bytes In-System  
Programmable  
Flash  
Peripheral Features  
– 8-bit Timer/Counter with Prescaler and Two PWM Channels  
– 8-bit High Speed Timer/Counter with Separate Prescaler  
2 High Frequency PWM Outputs with Separate Output Compare Registers  
Programmable Dead Time Generator  
– USI – Universal Serial Interface with Start Condition Detector  
– 10-bit ADC  
4 Single Ended Channels  
ATtiny25/V  
ATtiny45/V  
ATtiny85/V  
2 Differential ADC Channel Pairs with Programmable Gain (1x, 20x)  
Temperature Measurement  
– Programmable Watchdog Timer with Separate On-chip Oscillator  
– On-chip Analog Comparator  
Special Microcontroller Features  
– debugWIRE On-chip Debug System  
– In-System Programmable via SPI Port  
– External and Internal Interrupt Sources  
– Low Power Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, and Power-down Modes  
– Enhanced Power-on Reset Circuit  
Preliminary  
– Programmable Brown-out Detection Circuit  
– Internal Calibrated Oscillator  
I/O and Packages  
– Six Programmable I/O Lines  
– 8-pin PDIP, 8-pin SOIC and 20-pad QFN/MLF  
Operating Voltage  
– 1.8 - 5.5V for ATtiny25/45/85V  
– 2.7 - 5.5V for ATtiny25/45/85  
Speed Grade  
ATtiny25/45/85V: 0 - 4 MHz @ 1.8 - 5.5V, 0 - 10 MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5V  
ATtiny25/45/85: 0 - 10 MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5V, 0 - 20 MHz @ 4.5 - 5.5V  
Industrial Temperature Range  
Low Power Consumption  
– Active Mode:  
1 MHz, 1.8V: 450µA  
– Power-down Mode:  
0.1µA at 1.8V  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
1. Pin Configurations  
Figure 1-1. Pinout ATtiny25/45/85  
PDIP/SOIC  
(PCINT5/RESET/ADC0/dW) PB5  
1
2
3
4
8
7
6
5
VCC  
(PCINT3/XTAL1/CLKI/OC1B/ADC3) PB3  
(PCINT4/XTAL2/CLKO/OC1B/ADC2) PB4  
GND  
PB2 (SCK/USCK/SCL/ADC1/T0/INT0/PCINT2)  
PB1 (MISO/DO/AIN1/OC0B/OC1A/PCINT1)  
PB0 (MOSI/DI/SDA/AIN0/OC0A/OC1A/AREF/PCINT0)  
QFN/MLF  
1
15  
(PCINT5/RESET/ADC0/dW) PB5  
VCC  
2
3
4
5
14  
13  
12  
11  
(PCINT3/XTAL1/CLKI/OC1B/ADC3) PB3  
PB2 (SCK/USCK/SCL/ADC1/T0/INT0/PCINT2)  
DNC  
DNC  
DNC  
PB1 (MISO/DO/AIN1/OC0B/OC1A/PCINT1)  
PB0 (MOSI/DI/SDA/AIN0/OC0A/OC1A/AREF/PCINT0)  
(PCINT4/XTAL2/CLKO/OC1B/ADC2) PB4  
NOTE: Bottom pad should be soldered to ground.  
DNC: Do Not Connect  
1.1  
Disclaimer  
Typical values contained in this data sheet are based on simulations and characterization of other AVR microcontrollers  
manufactured on the same process technology. Min and Max values will be available after the device is characterized.  
2
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2. Overview  
The ATtiny25/45/85 is a low-power CMOS 8-bit microcontroller based on the AVR enhanced  
RISC architecture. By executing powerful instructions in a single clock cycle, the ATtiny25/45/85  
achieves throughputs approaching 1 MIPS per MHz allowing the system designer to optimize  
power consumption versus processing speed.  
2.1  
Block Diagram  
Figure 2-1. Block Diagram  
8-BIT DATABUS  
CALIBRATED  
INTERNAL  
OSCILLATOR  
PROGRAM  
COUNTER  
STACK  
POINTER  
WATCHDOG  
TIMER  
TIMING AND  
CONTROL  
VCC  
GND  
MCU CONTROL  
REGISTER  
PROGRAM  
FLASH  
SRAM  
MCU STATUS  
REGISTER  
GENERAL  
PURPOSE  
REGISTERS  
INSTRUCTION  
REGISTER  
TIMER/  
COUNTER0  
X
Y
Z
INSTRUCTION  
DECODER  
TIMER/  
COUNTER1  
UNIVERSAL  
SERIAL  
INTERFACE  
CONTROL  
LINES  
ALU  
INTERRUPT  
UNIT  
STATUS  
REGISTER  
PROGRAMMING  
LOGIC  
DATA  
EEPROM  
OSCILLATORS  
DATA REGISTER  
PORT B  
DATA DIR.  
REG.PORT B  
ADC /  
ANALOG COMPARATOR  
PORT B DRIVERS  
RESET  
PB0-PB5  
The AVR core combines a rich instruction set with 32 general purpose working registers. All the  
32 registers are directly connected to the Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU), allowing two independent  
3
2586D–AVR–02/06  
registers to be accessed in one single instruction executed in one clock cycle. The resulting  
architecture is more code efficient while achieving throughputs up to ten times faster than con-  
ventional CISC microcontrollers.  
The ATtiny25/45/85 provides the following features: 2/4/8K byte of In-System Programmable  
Flash, 128/256/512 bytes EEPROM, 128/256/256 bytes SRAM, 6 general purpose I/O lines, 32  
general purpose working registers, one 8-bit Timer/Counter with compare modes, one 8-bit high  
speed Timer/Counter, Universal Serial Interface, Internal and External Interrupts, a 4-channel,  
10-bit ADC, a programmable Watchdog Timer with internal Oscillator, and three software select-  
able power saving modes. The Idle mode stops the CPU while allowing the SRAM,  
Timer/Counter, ADC, Analog Comparator, and Interrupt system to continue functioning. The  
Power-down mode saves the register contents, disabling all chip functions until the next Inter-  
rupt or Hardware Reset. The ADC Noise Reduction mode stops the CPU and all I/O modules  
except ADC, to minimize switching noise during ADC conversions.  
The device is manufactured using Atmel’s high density non-volatile memory technology. The  
On-chip ISP Flash allows the Program memory to be re-programmed In-System through an SPI  
serial interface, by a conventional non-volatile memory programmer or by an On-chip boot code  
running on the AVR core.  
The ATtiny25/45/85 AVR is supported with a full suite of program and system development tools  
including: C Compilers, Macro Assemblers, Program Debugger/Simulators, In-Circuit Emulators,  
and Evaluation kits.  
2.2  
Pin Descriptions  
2.2.1  
VCC  
Supply voltage.  
2.2.2  
2.2.3  
GND  
Ground.  
Port B (PB5..PB0)  
Port B is a 6-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The  
Port B output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source  
capability. As inputs, Port B pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up  
resistors are activated. The Port B pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,  
even if the clock is not running.  
Port B also serves the functions of various special features of the ATtiny25/45/85 as listed on  
page 59.  
On the ATtiny25 device the programmable I/O ports PB3 and PB4 (pins 2 and 3) are exchanged  
in the ATtiny15 compatibility mode for supporting the backward compatibility with ATtiny15.  
2.2.4  
RESET  
Reset input. A low level on this pin for longer than the minimum pulse length will generate a  
reset, even if the clock is not running. The minimum pulse length is given in Table 9-1 on page  
37. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset.  
4
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
3. Resources  
A comprehensive set of development tools, application notes and datasheets are available for  
download on http://www.atmel.com/avr.  
4. About Code Examples  
This documentation contains simple code examples that briefly show how to use various parts of  
the device. These code examples assume that the part specific header file is included before  
compilation. Be aware that not all C compiler vendors include bit definitions in the header files  
and interrupt handling in C is compiler dependent. Please confirm with the C compiler documen-  
tation for more details.  
5
2586D–AVR–02/06  
5. AVR CPU Core  
5.1  
Introduction  
This section discusses the AVR core architecture in general. The main function of the CPU core  
is to ensure correct program execution. The CPU must therefore be able to access memories,  
perform calculations, control peripherals, and handle interrupts.  
5.2  
Architectural Overview  
Figure 5-1. Block Diagram of the AVR Architecture  
Data Bus 8-bit  
Program  
Counter  
Status  
and Control  
Flash  
Program  
Memory  
32 x 8  
General  
Purpose  
Registrers  
Instruction  
Register  
Interrupt  
Unit  
Instruction  
Decoder  
Watchdog  
Timer  
ALU  
Analog  
Comparator  
Control Lines  
I/O Module1  
I/O Module 2  
I/O Module n  
Data  
SRAM  
EEPROM  
I/O Lines  
In order to maximize performance and parallelism, the AVR uses a Harvard architecture – with  
separate memories and buses for program and data. Instructions in the Program memory are  
executed with a single level pipelining. While one instruction is being executed, the next instruc-  
tion is pre-fetched from the Program memory. This concept enables instructions to be executed  
in every clock cycle. The Program memory is In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory.  
6
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
The fast-access Register File contains 32 x 8-bit general purpose working registers with a single  
clock cycle access time. This allows single-cycle Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU) operation. In a typ-  
ical ALU operation, two operands are output from the Register File, the operation is executed,  
and the result is stored back in the Register File – in one clock cycle.  
Six of the 32 registers can be used as three 16-bit indirect address register pointers for Data  
Space addressing – enabling efficient address calculations. One of the these address pointers  
can also be used as an address pointer for look up tables in Flash Program memory. These  
added function registers are the 16-bit X-, Y-, and Z-register, described later in this section.  
The ALU supports arithmetic and logic operations between registers or between a constant and  
a register. Single register operations can also be executed in the ALU. After an arithmetic opera-  
tion, the Status Register is updated to reflect information about the result of the operation.  
Program flow is provided by conditional and unconditional jump and call instructions, able to  
directly address the whole address space. Most AVR instructions have a single 16-bit word for-  
mat. Every Program memory address contains a 16- or 32-bit instruction.  
During interrupts and subroutine calls, the return address Program Counter (PC) is stored on the  
Stack. The Stack is effectively allocated in the general data SRAM, and consequently the Stack  
size is only limited by the total SRAM size and the usage of the SRAM. All user programs must  
initialize the SP in the Reset routine (before subroutines or interrupts are executed). The Stack  
Pointer (SP) is read/write accessible in the I/O space. The data SRAM can easily be accessed  
through the five different addressing modes supported in the AVR architecture.  
The memory spaces in the AVR architecture are all linear and regular memory maps.  
A flexible interrupt module has its control registers in the I/O space with an additional Global  
Interrupt Enable bit in the Status Register. All interrupts have a separate Interrupt Vector in the  
Interrupt Vector table. The interrupts have priority in accordance with their Interrupt Vector posi-  
tion. The lower the Interrupt Vector address, the higher the priority.  
The I/O memory space contains 64 addresses for CPU peripheral functions as Control Regis-  
ters, SPI, and other I/O functions. The I/O memory can be accessed directly, or as the Data  
Space locations following those of the Register File, 0x20 - 0x5F.  
5.3  
5.4  
ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit  
The high-performance AVR ALU operates in direct connection with all the 32 general purpose  
working registers. Within a single clock cycle, arithmetic operations between general purpose  
registers or between a register and an immediate are executed. The ALU operations are divided  
into three main categories – arithmetic, logical, and bit-functions. Some implementations of the  
architecture also provide a powerful multiplier supporting both signed/unsigned multiplication  
and fractional format. See the “Instruction Set” section for a detailed description.  
Status Register  
The Status Register contains information about the result of the most recently executed arith-  
metic instruction. This information can be used for altering program flow in order to perform  
conditional operations. Note that the Status Register is updated after all ALU operations, as  
specified in the Instruction Set Reference. This will in many cases remove the need for using the  
dedicated compare instructions, resulting in faster and more compact code.  
The Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine and restored  
when returning from an interrupt. This must be handled by software.  
7
2586D–AVR–02/06  
5.4.1  
SREG – AVR Status Register  
The AVR Status Register – SREG – is defined as:  
Bit  
7
I
6
T
5
H
4
S
3
V
2
N
1
Z
0
C
0x3F  
SREG  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
• Bit 7 – I: Global Interrupt Enable  
The Global Interrupt Enable bit must be set for the interrupts to be enabled. The individual inter-  
rupt enable control is then performed in separate control registers. If the Global Interrupt Enable  
Register is cleared, none of the interrupts are enabled independent of the individual interrupt  
enable settings. The I-bit is cleared by hardware after an interrupt has occurred, and is set by  
the RETI instruction to enable subsequent interrupts. The I-bit can also be set and cleared by  
the application with the SEI and CLI instructions, as described in the instruction set reference.  
• Bit 6 – T: Bit Copy Storage  
The Bit Copy instructions BLD (Bit LoaD) and BST (Bit STore) use the T-bit as source or desti-  
nation for the operated bit. A bit from a register in the Register File can be copied into T by the  
BST instruction, and a bit in T can be copied into a bit in a register in the Register File by the  
BLD instruction.  
• Bit 5 – H: Half Carry Flag  
The Half Carry Flag H indicates a Half Carry in some arithmetic operations. Half Carry is useful  
in BCD arithmetic. See the “Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.  
• Bit 4 – S: Sign Bit, S = N V  
The S-bit is always an exclusive or between the Negative Flag N and the Two’s Complement  
Overflow Flag V. See the “Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.  
• Bit 3 – V: Two’s Complement Overflow Flag  
The Two’s Complement Overflow Flag V supports two’s complement arithmetics. See the  
“Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.  
• Bit 2 – N: Negative Flag  
The Negative Flag N indicates a negative result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the  
“Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.  
• Bit 1 – Z: Zero Flag  
The Zero Flag Z indicates a zero result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the “Instruction  
Set Description” for detailed information.  
• Bit 0 – C: Carry Flag  
The Carry Flag C indicates a carry in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the “Instruction Set  
Description” for detailed information.  
8
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
5.5  
General Purpose Register File  
The Register File is optimized for the AVR Enhanced RISC instruction set. In order to achieve  
the required performance and flexibility, the following input/output schemes are supported by the  
Register File:  
• One 8-bit output operand and one 8-bit result input  
Two 8-bit output operands and one 8-bit result input  
Two 8-bit output operands and one 16-bit result input  
• One 16-bit output operand and one 16-bit result input  
Figure 5-2 shows the structure of the 32 general purpose working registers in the CPU.  
Figure 5-2. AVR CPU General Purpose Working Registers  
7
0
Addr.  
R0  
R1  
0x00  
0x01  
0x02  
R2  
R13  
R14  
R15  
R16  
R17  
0x0D  
0x0E  
0x0F  
0x10  
0x11  
General  
Purpose  
Working  
Registers  
R26  
R27  
R28  
R29  
R30  
R31  
0x1A  
0x1B  
0x1C  
0x1D  
0x1E  
0x1F  
X-register Low Byte  
X-register High Byte  
Y-register Low Byte  
Y-register High Byte  
Z-register Low Byte  
Z-register High Byte  
Most of the instructions operating on the Register File have direct access to all registers, and  
most of them are single cycle instructions.  
As shown in Figure 5-2, each register is also assigned a Data memory address, mapping them  
directly into the first 32 locations of the user Data Space. Although not being physically imple-  
mented as SRAM locations, this memory organization provides great flexibility in access of the  
registers, as the X-, Y- and Z-pointer registers can be set to index any register in the file.  
5.5.1  
The X-register, Y-register, and Z-register  
The registers R26..R31 have some added functions to their general purpose usage. These reg-  
isters are 16-bit address pointers for indirect addressing of the data space. The three indirect  
address registers X, Y, and Z are defined as described in Figure 5-3.  
Figure 5-3. The X-, Y-, and Z-registers  
15  
XH  
XL  
0
0
X-register  
7
0
7
R27 (0x1B)  
R26 (0x1A)  
9
2586D–AVR–02/06  
15  
YH  
YL  
ZL  
0
0
Y-register  
Z-register  
7
0
7
R29 (0x1D)  
R28 (0x1C)  
15  
ZH  
0
0
7
7
0
R31 (0x1F)  
R30 (0x1E)  
In the different addressing modes these address registers have functions as fixed displacement,  
automatic increment, and automatic decrement (see the instruction set reference for details).  
5.6  
Stack Pointer  
The Stack is mainly used for storing temporary data, for storing local variables and for storing  
return addresses after interrupts and subroutine calls. The Stack Pointer Register always points  
to the top of the Stack. Note that the Stack is implemented as growing from higher memory loca-  
tions to lower memory locations. This implies that a Stack PUSH command decreases the Stack  
Pointer.  
The Stack Pointer points to the data SRAM Stack area where the Subroutine and Interrupt  
Stacks are located. This Stack space in the data SRAM must be defined by the program before  
any subroutine calls are executed or interrupts are enabled. The Stack Pointer must be set to  
point above 0x60. The Stack Pointer is decremented by one when data is pushed onto the Stack  
with the PUSH instruction, and it is decremented by two when the return address is pushed onto  
the Stack with subroutine call or interrupt. The Stack Pointer is incremented by one when data is  
popped from the Stack with the POP instruction, and it is incremented by two when data is  
popped from the Stack with return from subroutine RET or return from interrupt RETI.  
The AVR Stack Pointer is implemented as two 8-bit registers in the I/O space. The number of  
bits actually used is implementation dependent. Note that the data space in some implementa-  
tions of the AVR architecture is so small that only SPL is needed. In this case, the SPH Register  
will not be present.  
5.6.1  
5.7  
10  
SPH and SPL – Stack Pointer Register  
Bit  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
0x3E  
0x3D  
SP15  
SP7  
SP14  
SP6  
SP13  
SP5  
SP12  
SP4  
SP11  
SP3  
SP10  
SP2  
SP9  
SP8  
SPH  
SPL  
SP1  
SP0  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
RAMEND  
Instruction Execution Timing  
This section describes the general access timing concepts for instruction execution. The AVR  
CPU is driven by the CPU clock clkCPU, directly generated from the selected clock source for the  
chip. No internal clock division is used.  
Figure 5-4 shows the parallel instruction fetches and instruction executions enabled by the Har-  
vard architecture and the fast access Register File concept. This is the basic pipelining concept  
to obtain up to 1 MIPS per MHz with the corresponding unique results for functions per cost,  
functions per clocks, and functions per power-unit.  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 5-4. The Parallel Instruction Fetches and Instruction Executions  
T1  
T2  
T3  
T4  
clkCPU  
1st Instruction Fetch  
1st Instruction Execute  
2nd Instruction Fetch  
2nd Instruction Execute  
3rd Instruction Fetch  
3rd Instruction Execute  
4th Instruction Fetch  
Figure 5-5 shows the internal timing concept for the Register File. In a single clock cycle an ALU  
operation using two register operands is executed, and the result is stored back to the destina-  
tion register.  
Figure 5-5. Single Cycle ALU Operation  
T1  
T2  
T3  
T4  
clkCPU  
Total Execution Time  
Register Operands Fetch  
ALU Operation Execute  
Result Write Back  
5.8  
Reset and Interrupt Handling  
The AVR provides several different interrupt sources. These interrupts and the separate Reset  
Vector each have a separate Program Vector in the Program memory space. All interrupts are  
assigned individual enable bits which must be written logic one together with the Global Interrupt  
Enable bit in the Status Register in order to enable the interrupt.  
The lowest addresses in the Program memory space are by default defined as the Reset and  
Interrupt Vectors. The complete list of vectors is shown in ”Interrupts” on page 46. The list also  
determines the priority levels of the different interrupts. The lower the address the higher is the  
priority level. RESET has the highest priority, and next is INT0 – the External Interrupt Request  
0.  
When an interrupt occurs, the Global Interrupt Enable I-bit is cleared and all interrupts are dis-  
abled. The user software can write logic one to the I-bit to enable nested interrupts. All enabled  
interrupts can then interrupt the current interrupt routine. The I-bit is automatically set when a  
Return from Interrupt instruction – RETI – is executed.  
There are basically two types of interrupts. The first type is triggered by an event that sets the  
Interrupt Flag. For these interrupts, the Program Counter is vectored to the actual Interrupt Vec-  
tor in order to execute the interrupt handling routine, and hardware clears the corresponding  
Interrupt Flag. Interrupt Flags can also be cleared by writing a logic one to the flag bit position(s)  
to be cleared. If an interrupt condition occurs while the corresponding interrupt enable bit is  
11  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
cleared, the Interrupt Flag will be set and remembered until the interrupt is enabled, or the flag is  
cleared by software. Similarly, if one or more interrupt conditions occur while the Global Interrupt  
Enable bit is cleared, the corresponding Interrupt Flag(s) will be set and remembered until the  
Global Interrupt Enable bit is set, and will then be executed by order of priority.  
The second type of interrupts will trigger as long as the interrupt condition is present. These  
interrupts do not necessarily have Interrupt Flags. If the interrupt condition disappears before the  
interrupt is enabled, the interrupt will not be triggered.  
When the AVR exits from an interrupt, it will always return to the main program and execute one  
more instruction before any pending interrupt is served.  
Note that the Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine, nor  
restored when returning from an interrupt routine. This must be handled by software.  
When using the CLI instruction to disable interrupts, the interrupts will be immediately disabled.  
No interrupt will be executed after the CLI instruction, even if it occurs simultaneously with the  
CLI instruction. The following example shows how this can be used to avoid interrupts during the  
timed EEPROM write sequence..  
Assembly Code Example  
in r16, SREG  
; store SREG value  
cli ; disable interrupts during timed sequence  
sbiEECR, EEMPE ; start EEPROM write  
sbiEECR, EEPE  
outSREG, r16  
; restore SREG value (I-bit)  
C Code Example  
char cSREG;  
cSREG = SREG;/* store SREG value */  
/* disable interrupts during timed sequence */  
_CLI();  
EECR |= (1<<EEMPE); /* start EEPROM write */  
EECR |= (1<<EEPE);  
SREG = cSREG; /* restore SREG value (I-bit) */  
When using the SEI instruction to enable interrupts, the instruction following SEI will be exe-  
cuted before any pending interrupts, as shown in this example.  
Assembly Code Example  
sei ; set Global Interrupt Enable  
sleep; enter sleep, waiting for interrupt  
; note: will enter sleep before any pending  
; interrupt(s)  
C Code Example  
_SEI(); /* set Global Interrupt Enable */  
_SLEEP(); /* enter sleep, waiting for interrupt */  
/* note: will enter sleep before any pending interrupt(s) */  
12  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
5.8.1  
Interrupt Response Time  
The interrupt execution response for all the enabled AVR interrupts is four clock cycles mini-  
mum. After four clock cycles the Program Vector address for the actual interrupt handling routine  
is executed. During this four clock cycle period, the Program Counter is pushed onto the Stack.  
The vector is normally a jump to the interrupt routine, and this jump takes three clock cycles. If  
an interrupt occurs during execution of a multi-cycle instruction, this instruction is completed  
before the interrupt is served. If an interrupt occurs when the MCU is in sleep mode, the interrupt  
execution response time is increased by four clock cycles. This increase comes in addition to the  
start-up time from the selected sleep mode.  
A return from an interrupt handling routine takes four clock cycles. During these four clock  
cycles, the Program Counter (two bytes) is popped back from the Stack, the Stack Pointer is  
incremented by two, and the I-bit in SREG is set.  
13  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
6. AVR Memories  
This section describes the different memories in the ATtiny25/45/85. The AVR architecture has  
two main memory spaces, the Data memory and the Program memory space. In addition, the  
ATtiny25/45/85 features an EEPROM Memory for data storage. All three memory spaces are lin-  
ear and regular.  
6.1  
In-System Re-programmable Flash Program Memory  
The ATtiny25/45/85 contains 2/4/8K byte On-chip In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory  
for program storage. Since all AVR instructions are 16 or 32 bits wide, the Flash is organized as  
1024/2049/4096 x 16.  
The Flash memory has an endurance of at least 10,000 write/erase cycles. The ATtiny25/45/85  
Program Counter (PC) is 10/11/12 bits wide, thus addressing the 1024/2048/4096 Program  
memory locations. ”Memory Programming” on page 149 contains a detailed description on Flash  
data serial downloading using the SPI pins.  
Constant tables can be allocated within the entire Program memory address space (see the  
LPM – Load Program memory instruction description).  
Timing diagrams for instruction fetch and execution are presented in ”Instruction Execution Tim-  
ing” on page 10.  
Figure 6-1. Program Memory Map  
Program Memory  
0x0000  
0x03FF/0x07FF/0x0FFF  
6.2  
SRAM Data Memory  
Figure 6-2 shows how the ATtiny25/45/85 SRAM Memory is organized.  
The lower 224/352/607 Data memory locations address both the Register File, the I/O memory  
and the internal data SRAM. The first 32 locations address the Register File, the next 64 loca-  
tions the standard I/O memory, and the last 128/256/512 locations address the internal data  
SRAM.  
The five different addressing modes for the Data memory cover: Direct, Indirect with Displace-  
ment, Indirect, Indirect with Pre-decrement, and Indirect with Post-increment. In the Register  
File, registers R26 to R31 feature the indirect addressing pointer registers.  
The direct addressing reaches the entire data space.  
The Indirect with Displacement mode reaches 63 address locations from the base address given  
by the Y- or Z-register.  
14  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
When using register indirect addressing modes with automatic pre-decrement and post-incre-  
ment, the address registers X, Y, and Z are decremented or incremented.  
The 32 general purpose working registers, 64 I/O Registers, and the 128/256/512 bytes of inter-  
nal data SRAM in the ATtiny25/45/85 are all accessible through all these addressing modes.  
The Register File is described in ”General Purpose Register File” on page 9.  
Figure 6-2. Data Memory Map  
Data Memory  
0x0000 - 0x001F  
0x0020 - 0x005F  
0x0060  
32 Registers  
64 I/O Registers  
Internal SRAM  
(128/256/512 x 8)  
0x0DF/0x015F/0x025F  
6.2.1  
Data Memory Access Times  
This section describes the general access timing concepts for internal memory access. The  
internal data SRAM access is performed in two clkCPU cycles as described in Figure 6-3.  
Figure 6-3. On-chip Data SRAM Access Cycles  
T1  
T2  
T3  
clkCPU  
Address valid  
Compute Address  
Address  
Data  
WR  
Data  
RD  
Memory Access Instruction  
Next Instruction  
6.3  
EEPROM Data Memory  
The ATtiny25/45/85 contains 128/256/512 bytes of data EEPROM memory. It is organized as a  
separate data space, in which single bytes can be read and written. The EEPROM has an  
endurance of at least 100,000 write/erase cycles. The access between the EEPROM and the  
CPU is described in the following, specifying the EEPROM Address Registers, the EEPROM  
Data Register, and the EEPROM Control Register. For a detailed description of Serial data  
downloading to the EEPROM, see page 153.  
15  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
6.3.1  
EEPROM Read/Write Access  
The EEPROM Access Registers are accessible in the I/O space.  
The write access times for the EEPROM are given in Table 6-1. A self-timing function, however,  
lets the user software detect when the next byte can be written. If the user code contains instruc-  
tions that write the EEPROM, some precautions must be taken. In heavily filtered power  
supplies, VCC is likely to rise or fall slowly on Power-up/down. This causes the device for some  
period of time to run at a voltage lower than specified as minimum for the clock frequency used.  
See ”Preventing EEPROM Corruption” on page 20 for details on how to avoid problems in these  
situations.  
In order to prevent unintentional EEPROM writes, a specific write procedure must be followed.  
Refer to ”Atomic Byte Programming” on page 18 and ”Split Byte Programming” on page 18 for  
details on this.  
When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four clock cycles before the next instruction is  
executed. When the EEPROM is written, the CPU is halted for two clock cycles before the next  
instruction is executed.  
6.3.2  
EEARH and EEARL – EEPROM Address Register  
Bit  
0x1F  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EEAR8  
EEAR0  
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
EEARH  
EEARL  
0x1E  
EEAR7  
EEAR6  
EEAR5  
EEAR4  
EEAR3  
EEAR2  
EEAR1  
Bit  
7
R
6
R
5
R
4
R
3
R
2
R
1
R
Read/Write  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
Initial Value  
R/W  
R/W  
X
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
• Bit 7:1 – Res6:0: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved for future use and will always read as 0 in ATtiny25/45/85.  
• Bits 8:0 – EEAR8:0: EEPROM Address  
The EEPROM Address Registers – EEARH and EEARL – specifies the high EEPROM address  
in the 128/256/512 bytes EEPROM space. The EEPROM data bytes are addressed linearly  
between 0 and 127/255/511. The initial value of EEAR is undefined. A proper value must be writ-  
ten before the EEPROM may be accessed.  
6.3.3  
EEDR – EEPROM Data Register  
Bit  
7
6
EEDR6  
R/W  
0
5
EEDR5  
R/W  
0
4
EEDR4  
R/W  
0
3
EEDR3  
R/W  
0
2
EEDR2  
R/W  
0
1
EEDR1  
R/W  
0
0
EEDR0  
R/W  
0
0x1D  
EEDR7  
R/W  
0
EEDR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 7:0 – EEDR7:0: EEPROM Data  
For the EEPROM write operation the EEDR Register contains the data to be written to the  
EEPROM in the address given by the EEAR Register. For the EEPROM read operation, the  
EEDR contains the data read out from the EEPROM at the address given by EEAR.  
16  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
6.3.4  
EECR – EEPROM Control Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
EEPM1  
R/W  
X
4
EEPM0  
R/W  
X
3
EERIE  
R/W  
0
2
EEMPE  
R/W  
0
1
EEPE  
R/W  
X
0
EERE  
R/W  
0
0x1C  
EECR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 – Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is reserved for future use and will always read as 0 in ATtiny25/45/85. For compatibility  
with future AVR devices, always write this bit to zero. After reading, mask out this bit.  
• Bit 6 – Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is reserved in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 5:4 – EEPM1 and EEPM0: EEPROM Programming Mode Bits  
The EEPROM Programming mode bits setting defines which programming action that will be  
triggered when writing EEPE. It is possible to program data in one atomic operation (erase the  
old value and program the new value) or to split the Erase and Write operations in two different  
operations. The Programming times for the different modes are shown in Table 6-1. While EEPE  
is set, any write to EEPMn will be ignored. During reset, the EEPMn bits will be reset to 0b00  
unless the EEPROM is busy programming.  
Table 6-1.  
EEPROM Mode Bits  
Programming  
EEPM1  
EEPM0  
Time  
3.4 ms  
1.8 ms  
1.8 ms  
Operation  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Erase and Write in one operation (Atomic Operation)  
Erase Only  
Write Only  
Reserved for future use  
• Bit 3 – EERIE: EEPROM Ready Interrupt Enable  
Writing EERIE to one enables the EEPROM Ready Interrupt if the I-bit in SREG is set. Writing  
EERIE to zero disables the interrupt. The EEPROM Ready Interrupt generates a constant inter-  
rupt when Non-volatile memory is ready for programming.  
• Bit 2 – EEMPE: EEPROM Master Program Enable  
The EEMPE bit determines whether writing EEPE to one will have effect or not.  
When EEMPE is set, setting EEPE within four clock cycles will program the EEPROM at the  
selected address. If EEMPE is zero, setting EEPE will have no effect. When EEMPE has been  
written to one by software, hardware clears the bit to zero after four clock cycles.  
• Bit 1 – EEPE: EEPROM Program Enable  
The EEPROM Program Enable Signal EEPE is the programming enable signal to the EEPROM.  
When EEPE is written, the EEPROM will be programmed according to the EEPMn bits setting.  
The EEMPE bit must be written to one before a logical one is written to EEPE, otherwise no  
EEPROM write takes place. When the write access time has elapsed, the EEPE bit is cleared  
by hardware. When EEPE has been set, the CPU is halted for two cycles before the next  
instruction is executed.  
17  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
• Bit 0 – EERE: EEPROM Read Enable  
The EEPROM Read Enable Signal – EERE – is the read strobe to the EEPROM. When the cor-  
rect address is set up in the EEAR Register, the EERE bit must be written to one to trigger the  
EEPROM read. The EEPROM read access takes one instruction, and the requested data is  
available immediately. When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four cycles before the  
next instruction is executed. The user should poll the EEPE bit before starting the read opera-  
tion. If a write operation is in progress, it is neither possible to read the EEPROM, nor to change  
the EEAR Register.  
6.3.5  
Atomic Byte Programming  
Using Atomic Byte Programming is the simplest mode. When writing a byte to the EEPROM, the  
user must write the address into the EEARL Register and data into EEDR Register. If the  
EEPMn bits are zero, writing EEPE (within four cycles after EEMPE is written) will trigger the  
erase/write operation. Both the erase and write cycle are done in one operation and the total  
programming time is given in Table 1. The EEPE bit remains set until the erase and write opera-  
tions are completed. While the device is busy with programming, it is not possible to do any  
other EEPROM operations.  
6.3.6  
Split Byte Programming  
It is possible to split the erase and write cycle in two different operations. This may be useful if  
the system requires short access time for some limited period of time (typically if the power sup-  
ply voltage falls). In order to take advantage of this method, it is required that the locations to be  
written have been erased before the write operation. But since the erase and write operations  
are split, it is possible to do the erase operations when the system allows doing time-critical  
operations (typically after Power-up).  
6.3.7  
6.3.8  
Erase  
Write  
To erase a byte, the address must be written to EEAR. If the EEPMn bits are 0b01, writing the  
EEPE (within four cycles after EEMPE is written) will trigger the erase operation only (program-  
ming time is given in Table 1). The EEPE bit remains set until the erase operation completes.  
While the device is busy programming, it is not possible to do any other EEPROM operations.  
To write a location, the user must write the address into EEAR and the data into EEDR. If the  
EEPMn bits are 0b10, writing the EEPE (within four cycles after EEMPE is written) will trigger  
the write operation only (programming time is given in Table 1). The EEPE bit remains set until  
the write operation completes. If the location to be written has not been erased before write, the  
data that is stored must be considered as lost. While the device is busy with programming, it is  
not possible to do any other EEPROM operations.  
The calibrated Oscillator is used to time the EEPROM accesses. Make sure the Oscillator fre-  
quency is within the requirements described in ”OSCCAL – Oscillator Calibration Register” on  
page 27.  
The following code examples show one assembly and one C function for erase, write, or atomic  
write of the EEPROM. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled (e.g., by disabling  
interrupts globally) so that no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions.  
18  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Assembly Code Example  
EEPROM_write:  
; Wait for completion of previous write  
sbic EECR,EEPE  
rjmp EEPROM_write  
; Set Programming mode  
ldi r16, (0<<EEPM1)|(0<<EEPM0)  
out EECR, r16  
; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register  
out EEARH, r18  
out EEARL, r17  
; Write data (r16) to data register  
out EEDR, r16  
; Write logical one to EEMPE  
sbi EECR,EEMPE  
; Start eeprom write by setting EEPE  
sbi EECR,EEPE  
ret  
C Code Example  
void EEPROM_write(unsigned char ucAddress, unsigned char ucData)  
{
/* Wait for completion of previous write */  
while(EECR & (1<<EEPE))  
;
/* Set Programming mode */  
EECR = (0<<EEPM1)|(0<<EEPM0);  
/* Set up address and data registers */  
EEAR = ucAddress;  
EEDR = ucData;  
/* Write logical one to EEMPE */  
EECR |= (1<<EEMPE);  
/* Start eeprom write by setting EEPE */  
EECR |= (1<<EEPE);  
}
19  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
The next code examples show assembly and C functions for reading the EEPROM. The exam-  
ples assume that interrupts are controlled so that no interrupts will occur during execution of  
these functions.  
Assembly Code Example  
EEPROM_read:  
; Wait for completion of previous write  
sbic EECR,EEPE  
rjmp EEPROM_read  
; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register  
out EEARH, r18  
out EEARL, r17  
; Start eeprom read by writing EERE  
sbi EECR,EERE  
; Read data from data register  
in r16,EEDR  
ret  
C Code Example  
unsigned char EEPROM_read(unsigned char ucAddress)  
{
/* Wait for completion of previous write */  
while(EECR & (1<<EEPE))  
;
/* Set up address register */  
EEAR = ucAddress;  
/* Start eeprom read by writing EERE */  
EECR |= (1<<EERE);  
/* Return data from data register */  
return EEDR;  
}
6.3.9  
Preventing EEPROM Corruption  
During periods of low VCC, the EEPROM data can be corrupted because the supply voltage is  
too low for the CPU and the EEPROM to operate properly. These issues are the same as for  
board level systems using EEPROM, and the same design solutions should be applied.  
An EEPROM data corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First,  
a regular write sequence to the EEPROM requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Sec-  
ondly, the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage is too low.  
EEPROM data corruption can easily be avoided by following this design recommendation:  
Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage. This can  
be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD). If the detection level of the internal  
BOD does not match the needed detection level, an external low VCC reset protection circuit can  
be used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be com-  
pleted provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient.  
20  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
6.4  
I/O Memory  
The I/O space definition of the ATtiny25/45/85 is shown in ”Register Summary” on page 194.  
All ATtiny25/45/85 I/Os and peripherals are placed in the I/O space. All I/O locations may be  
accessed by the LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions, transferring data between the 32  
general purpose working registers and the I/O space. I/O Registers within the address range  
0x00 - 0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these registers, the  
value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions. Refer to the  
instruction set section for more details. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the  
I/O addresses 0x00 - 0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data space using  
LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these addresses.  
For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed.  
Reserved I/O memory addresses should never be written.  
Some of the Status Flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that, unlike most  
other AVRs, the CBI and SBI instructions will only operate on the specified bit, and can therefore  
be used on registers containing such Status Flags. The CBI and SBI instructions work with reg-  
isters 0x00 to 0x1F only.  
The I/O and Peripherals Control Registers are explained in later sections.  
21  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
7. System Clock and Clock Options  
7.1  
Clock Systems and their Distribution  
Figure 7-1 presents the principal clock systems in the AVR and their distribution. All of the clocks  
need not be active at a given time. In order to reduce power consumption, the clocks to modules  
not being used can be halted by using different sleep modes, as described in ”Power Manage-  
ment and Sleep Modes” on page 32. The clock systems are detailed below.  
Figure 7-1. Clock Distribution  
General I/O  
Modules  
Flash and  
EEPROM  
ADC  
CPU Core  
RAM  
clkPCK  
clkI/O  
clkCPU  
AVR Clock  
Control Unit  
clkFLASH  
clkADC  
Reset Logic  
Watchdog Timer  
Source clock  
Watchdog clock  
System Clock  
Prescaler  
Clock  
Multiplexer  
Watchdog  
Oscillator  
PLL  
Oscillator  
Crystal
Oscillator  
Low-Frequency  
Crystal Oscillator  
Calibrated RC  
Oscillator  
External Clock  
7.1.1  
7.1.2  
CPU Clock – clkCPU  
The CPU clock is routed to parts of the system concerned with operation of the AVR core.  
Examples of such modules are the General Purpose Register File, the Status Register and the  
Data memory holding the Stack Pointer. Halting the CPU clock inhibits the core from performing  
general operations and calculations.  
I/O Clock – clkI/O  
The I/O clock is used by the majority of the I/O modules, like Timer/Counter. The I/O clock is  
also used by the External Interrupt module, but note that some external interrupts are detected  
by asynchronous logic, allowing such interrupts to be detected even if the I/O clock is halted.  
7.1.3  
7.1.4  
Flash Clock – clkFLASH  
The Flash clock controls operation of the Flash interface. The Flash clock is usually active simul-  
taneously with the CPU clock.  
ADC Clock – clkADC  
The ADC is provided with a dedicated clock domain. This allows halting the CPU and I/O clocks  
in order to reduce noise generated by digital circuitry. This gives more accurate ADC conversion  
results.  
22  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
7.1.5  
Internal PLL for Fast Peripheral Clock Generation - clkPCK  
The internal PLL in ATtiny25/45/85 generates a clock frequency that is 8x multiplied from a  
source input. The source of the PLL input clock is the output of the internal RC oscillator having  
a frequency of 8.0 MHz. Thus the output of the PLL, the fast peripheral clock is 64 MHz. The fast  
peripheral clock, or a clock prescaled from that, can be selected as the clock source for  
Timer/Counter1. See the Figure 7-2 on page 23.  
Since the ATtiny25/45/85 device is a migration path for ATtiny15, there is an ATtiny15 compati-  
bility mode for supporting the backward compatibility with ATtiny15. The ATtiny15 compatibility  
mode is selected by programming the CKSEL fuses to ‘0011’. In the ATtiny15 compatibility  
mode the frequency of the internal RC oscillator is calibrated down to 6.4 MHz and the multipli-  
cation factor of the PLL is set to 4x. With these adjustments the clocking system is ATtiny15  
compatible and the resulting fast peripheral clock has a frequency of 25.6 MHz (same as in  
ATtiny15).  
The PLL is locked on the RC oscillator and adjusting the RC oscillator via OSCCAL register will  
adjust the fast peripheral clock at the same time. However, even if the RC oscillator is taken to a  
higher frequency than 8 MHz, the fast peripheral clock frequency saturates at 85 MHz (worst  
case) and remains oscillating at the maximum frequency. It should be noted that the PLL in this  
case is not locked any longer with the RC oscillator clock.  
Therefore, it is recommended not to take the OSCCAL adjustments to a higher frequency than 8  
MHz in order to keep the PLL in the correct operating range. The internal PLL is enabled only  
when the PLLE bit in the register PLLCSR is set or the PLLCK fuse is programmed (‘0’). The bit  
PLOCK from the register PLLCSR is set when PLL is locked.  
Both internal RC oscillator and PLL are switched off in power down and stand-by sleep modes.  
Figure 7-2. PCK Clocking System  
OSCCAL  
PLLCK & CKSEL FUSES  
PLLE  
CLKPS3..0  
PLOCK  
PCK  
Lock  
Detector  
PLL  
8x / 4x  
RC OSCILLATOR  
8.0 MHz / 6.4 MHz  
64 / 25.6 MHz  
DIVIDE  
BY 4  
SYSTEM  
System  
CLOCK  
Clock  
Prescaler  
XTAL1  
XTAL2  
OSCILLATORS  
23  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
7.2  
Clock Sources  
The device has the following clock source options, selectable by Flash Fuse bits as shown  
below. The clock from the selected source is input to the AVR clock generator, and routed to the  
appropriate modules.  
Table 7-1.  
Device Clocking Options Select(1)  
Device Clocking Option  
External Clock  
CKSEL3:0  
0000  
PLL Clock  
0001  
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator 8.0 MHz  
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator 6.4 MHz  
Watchdog Oscillator 128 kHz  
External Low-frequency Oscillator  
External Crystal/Ceramic Resonator  
Reserved  
0010  
0011  
0100  
0110  
1000-1111  
0101, 0111  
Note:  
1. For all fuses “1” means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed.  
The various choices for each clocking option is given in the following sections. When the CPU  
wakes up from Power-down, the selected clock source is used to time the start-up, ensuring sta-  
ble Oscillator operation before instruction execution starts. When the CPU starts from reset,  
there is an additional delay allowing the power to reach a stable level before commencing nor-  
mal operation. The Watchdog Oscillator is used for timing this real-time part of the start-up time.  
The number of WDT Oscillator cycles used for each time-out is shown in Table 7-2.  
Table 7-2.  
Number of Watchdog Oscillator Cycles  
Typ Time-out  
4 ms  
Number of Cycles  
512  
64 ms  
8K (8,192)  
7.3  
7.4  
Default Clock Source  
The device is shipped with CKSEL = “0010”, SUT = “10”, and CKDIV8 programmed. The default  
clock source setting is therefore the Internal RC Oscillator running at 8 MHz with longest start-up  
time and an initial system clock prescaling of 8. This default setting ensures that all users can  
make their desired clock source setting using an In-System or High-voltage Programmer.  
Crystal Oscillator  
XTAL1 and XTAL2 are input and output, respectively, of an inverting amplifier which can be con-  
figured for use as an On-chip Oscillator, as shown in Figure 7-3. Either a quartz crystal or a  
ceramic resonator may be used.  
C1 and C2 should always be equal for both crystals and resonators. The optimal value of the  
capacitors depends on the crystal or resonator in use, the amount of stray capacitance, and the  
electromagnetic noise of the environment. Some initial guidelines for choosing capacitors for  
use with crystals are given in Table 7-3. For ceramic resonators, the capacitor values given by  
the manufacturer should be used.  
24  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 7-3. Crystal Oscillator Connections  
C2  
XTAL2  
XTAL1  
GND  
C1  
The Oscillator can operate in three different modes, each optimized for a specific frequency  
range. The operating mode is selected by the fuses CKSEL3..1 as shown in Table 7-3.  
Table 7-3.  
Crystal Oscillator Operating Modes  
Recommended Range for Capacitors C1 and  
C2 for Use with Crystals (pF)  
CKSEL3:1  
100(1)  
101  
Frequency Range (MHz)  
0.4 - 0.9  
0.9 - 3.0  
3.0 - 8.0  
8.0 -  
12 - 22  
12 - 22  
12 - 22  
110  
111  
Notes: 1. This option should not be used with crystals, only with ceramic resonators.  
The CKSEL0 Fuse together with the SUT1..0 Fuses select the start-up times as shown in Table  
7-4.  
Table 7-4.  
Start-up Times for the Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection  
Additional Delay  
Start-up Time from  
Power-down  
from Reset  
(VCC = 5.0V)  
CKSEL0  
SUT1:0  
Recommended Usage  
Ceramic resonator, fast  
rising power  
0
00  
258 CK(1)  
14CK + 4.1 ms  
14CK + 65 ms  
14CK  
Ceramic resonator, slowly  
rising power  
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
01  
10  
11  
00  
01  
10  
11  
258 CK(1)  
Ceramic resonator, BOD  
enabled  
1K (1024) CK(2)  
1K (1024)CK(2)  
1K (1024)CK(2)  
16K (16384) CK  
16K (16384) CK  
16K (16384) CK  
Ceramic resonator, fast  
rising power  
14CK + 4.1 ms  
14CK + 65 ms  
14CK  
Ceramic resonator, slowly  
rising power  
Crystal Oscillator, BOD  
enabled  
Crystal Oscillator, fast  
rising power  
14CK + 4.1 ms  
14CK + 65 ms  
Crystal Oscillator, slowly  
rising power  
25  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Notes: 1. These options should only be used when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the  
device, and only if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. These  
options are not suitable for crystals.  
2. These options are intended for use with ceramic resonators and will ensure frequency stability  
at start-up. They can also be used with crystals when not operating close to the maximum fre-  
quency of the device, and if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application.  
7.5  
Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator  
To use a 32.768 kHz watch crystal as the clock source for the device, the low-frequency crystal  
oscillator must be selected by setting CKSEL fuses to ‘0110’. The crystal should be connected  
as shown in Figure 7-3. Refer to the 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator Application Note for details on  
oscillator operation and how to choose appropriate values for C1 and C2.  
When this oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT fuses as shown in  
Table 7-5.  
Table 7-5.  
Start-up Times for the Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection  
Start-up Time from  
Power Down  
Additional Delay from  
Reset (VCC = 5.0V)  
SUT1:0  
Recommended usage  
Fast rising power or BOD  
enabled  
00  
1K (1024) CK(1)  
4 ms  
01  
10  
11  
1K (1024) CK(1)  
32K (32768) CK  
64 ms  
Slowly rising power  
64 ms  
Stable frequency at start-up  
Reserved  
Notes: 1. These options should only be used if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the  
application.  
7.6  
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator  
The calibrated internal RC Oscillator provides an 8.0 MHz clock. The frequency is the nominal  
value at 3V and 25°C. If the frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC),  
the CKDIV8 Fuse must be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8 during  
start-up. See Section “7.10” on page 30. for more details. This clock may be selected as the sys-  
tem clock by programming the CKSEL Fuses as shown in Table 7-6. If selected, it will operate  
with no external components. During reset, hardware loads the calibration byte into the OSC-  
CAL Register and thereby automatically calibrates the RC Oscillator. At 3V and 25°C, this  
calibration gives a frequency within ± 1% of the nominal frequency. When this Oscillator is used  
as the chip clock, the Watchdog Oscillator will still be used for the Watchdog Timer and for the  
Reset Time-out. For more information on the pre-programmed calibration value, see the section  
”Calibration Byte” on page 152.  
In addition the calibrated internal RC Oscillator provides a 6.4 MHz clock that is chosen by writ-  
ing the CKSEL fuses to “0011” as shown in Table 7. When this CKSEL setting is written the  
nominal frequency of the calibrated internal RC Oscillator is calibrated down to 6.4 MHz. This  
clock frequency is needed for the ATtiny15 compatibility mode. In the ATtiny15 compatibility  
mode the 6.4 MHz internal RC oscillator is used as a reference clock for the PLL that is generat-  
26  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
ing a 4x multiplied frequency from the reference clock. The resulting frequency is 25.6 MHz and  
it is needed for supporting the same PWM frequencies as in ATtiny15.  
Table 7-6.  
Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Operating Modes  
CKSEL3:0  
0010(1)  
0011  
Nominal Frequency  
8.0 MHz  
6.4 MHz  
Note:  
1. The device is shipped with this option selected.  
When this Oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in  
Table 7-7 and the start-up times in ATtiny15 compatibility mode in Table 7-8..  
Table 7-7.  
Start-up Times for the Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Clock Selection  
Start-up Time  
from Power-down  
Additional Delay from  
Reset (VCC = 5.0V)  
SUT1:0  
00  
Recommended Usage  
BOD enabled  
6 CK  
6 CK  
6 CK  
14CK  
01  
14CK + 4 ms  
14CK + 64 ms  
Reserved  
Fast rising power  
Slowly rising power  
10(1)  
11  
Note:  
1. The device is shipped with this option selected.  
Table 7-8.  
Start-up Times for the Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Clock Selection  
Start-up Time  
from Power-down  
Additional Delay from  
Reset (VCC = 5.0V)  
SUT1:0  
00  
Recommended Usage  
6 CK  
6 CK  
6 CK  
1 CK  
14CK + 64 ms  
14CK + 64 ms  
14CK + 4 ms  
14CK  
01  
10(1)  
11  
7.6.1  
OSCCAL – Oscillator Calibration Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x31  
CAL7  
CAL6  
R/W  
CAL5  
R/W  
CAL4  
R/W  
CAL3  
R/W  
CAL2  
R/W  
CAL1  
R/W  
CAL0  
R/W  
OSCCAL  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
Device Specific Calibration Value  
• Bits 7:0 – CAL7:0: Oscillator Calibration Value  
Writing the calibration byte to this address will trim the internal Oscillator to remove process vari-  
ations from the Oscillator frequency. This is done automatically during Chip Reset. When  
OSCCAL is zero, the lowest available frequency is chosen. Writing non-zero values to this regis-  
ter will increase the frequency of the internal Oscillator. Writing 0xFF to the register gives the  
highest available frequency. The calibrated Oscillator is used to time EEPROM and Flash  
access. If EEPROM or Flash is written, do not calibrate to more than 8.8 MHz frequency. Other-  
wise, the EEPROM or Flash write may fail.  
The CAL7 bit determines the range of operation for the oscillator. Setting this bit to 0 gives the  
lowest frequency range, setting this bit to 1 gives the highest frequency range. The two fre-  
27  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
quency ranges are overlapping, in other words a setting of OSCCAL = 0x7F gives a higher  
frequency than OSCCAL = 0x80.  
The CAL6:0 bits are used to tune the frequency within the selected range. A setting of 0x00  
gives the lowest frequency in that range, and a setting of 0x7F gives the highest frequency in the  
range. Incrementing CAL6:0 by 1 will give a frequency increment of less than 2% in the fre-  
quency range 7.3 - 8.1 MHz.  
Avoid changing the calibration value in large steps when calibrating the calibrated internal RC  
Oscillator to ensure stable operation of the MCU. A variation in frequency of more than 2% from  
one cycle to the next can lead to unpredicatble behavior. Changes in OSCCAL should not  
exceed 0x20 for each calibration. It is required to ensure that the MCU is kept in Reset during  
such changes in the clock frequency  
Table 7-9.  
Internal RC Oscillator Frequency Range  
Min Frequency in Percentage of  
Max Frequency in Percentage of  
Nominal Frequency  
OSCCAL Value  
0x00  
Nominal Frequency  
50%  
75%  
100%  
150%  
200%  
0x3F  
0x7F  
100%  
7.7  
External Clock  
To drive the device from an external clock source, CLKI should be driven as shown in Figure 7-  
4. To run the device on an external clock, the CKSEL Fuses must be programmed to “00”.  
Figure 7-4. External Clock Drive Configuration  
EXTERNAL  
CLKI  
GND  
CLOCK  
SIGNAL  
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in  
Table 7-10.  
Table 7-10. Start-up Times for the External Clock Selection  
Start-up Time from  
Power-down  
Additional Delay from  
Reset  
SUT1:0  
00  
Recommended Usage  
BOD enabled  
6 CK  
6 CK  
6 CK  
14CK  
14CK + 4 ms  
14CK + 64 ms  
Reserved  
01  
Fast rising power  
Slowly rising power  
10  
11  
Note that the System Clock Prescaler can be used to implement run-time changes of the internal  
clock frequency while still ensuring stable operation. Refer to ”System Clock Prescaler” on page  
30 for details.  
28  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
7.7.1  
High Frequency PLL Clock - PLLCLK  
There is an internal PLL that provides nominally 64 MHz clock rate locked to the RC Oscillator  
for the use of the Peripheral Timer/Counter1 and for the system clock source. When selected as  
a system clock source, by programming the CKSEL fuses to ‘0001’, it is divided by four like  
shown in Table 7-11. When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the  
SUT fuses as shown in Table 7-12. See also ”PCK Clocking System” on page 23.  
Table 7-11. PLLCK Operating Modes  
CKSEL3:0  
Nominal Frequency  
0001  
16 MHz  
Table 7-12. Start-up Times for the PLLCK  
Start-up Time from  
Additional Delay from Reset  
(VCC = 5.0V)  
Recommended  
usage  
SUT1:0  
00  
Power Down  
14CK + 1K (1024) CK + 4 ms  
14CK + 16K (16384) CK + 4 ms  
14CK + 1K (1024) CK + 64 ms  
14CK + 16K (16384) CK + 64 ms  
14CK + 1K (1024) CK + 8ms  
BOD enabled  
01  
14CK + 16K (16384) CK + 8ms Fast rising power  
10  
14CK + 1K (1024) CK + 68 ms  
14CK + 1K (1024) CK + 68 ms  
Slowly rising power  
Slowly rising power  
11  
7.8  
128 kHz Internal Oscillator  
The 128 kHz internal Oscillator is a low power Oscillator providing a clock of 128 kHz. The fre-  
quency is nominal at 3V and 25°C. This clock may be select as the system clock by  
programming the CKSEL Fuses to “11”.  
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in  
Table 7-13.  
Table 7-13. Start-up Times for the 128 kHz Internal Oscillator  
Start-up Time from  
Power-down  
Additional Delay from  
Reset  
SUT1:0  
00  
Recommended Usage  
BOD enabled  
6 CK  
6 CK  
6 CK  
14CK  
01  
14CK + 4 ms  
14CK + 64 ms  
Reserved  
Fast rising power  
Slowly rising power  
10  
11  
7.9  
Clock Output Buffer  
The device can output the system clock on the CLKO pin. To enable the output, the CKOUT  
Fuse has to be programmed. This mode is suitable when the chip clock is used to drive other cir-  
cuits on the system. Note that the clock will not be output during reset and the normal operation  
of I/O pin will be overridden when the fuse is programmed. Any clock source, including the inter-  
nal RC Oscillator, can be selected when the clock is output on CLKO. If the System Clock  
Prescaler is used, it is the divided system clock that is output.  
29  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
7.10 System Clock Prescaler  
The ATtiny25/45/85 system clock can be divided by setting the Clock Prescale Register –  
CLKPR. This feature can be used to decrease power consumption when the requirement for  
processing power is low. This can be used with all clock source options, and it will affect the  
clock frequency of the CPU and all synchronous peripherals. clkI/O, clkADC, clkCPU, and clkFLASH  
are divided by a factor as shown in Table 7-14.  
7.10.1  
CLKPR – Clock Prescale Register  
Bit  
0x26  
7
6
R
0
5
R
0
4
R
0
3
2
1
0
CLKPCE  
CLKPS3  
R/W  
CLKPS2  
R/W  
CLKPS1  
R/W  
CLKPS0  
R/W  
CLKPR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
See Bit Description  
• Bit 7 – CLKPCE: Clock Prescaler Change Enable  
The CLKPCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the CLKPS bits. The CLKPCE  
bit is only updated when the other bits in CLKPR are simultaniosly written to zero. CLKPCE is  
cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when the CLKPS bits are written. Rewriting  
the CLKPCE bit within this time-out period does neither extend the time-out period, nor clear the  
CLKPCE bit.  
• Bits 6:4 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 3:0 – CLKPS3:0: Clock Prescaler Select Bits 3 - 0  
These bits define the division factor between the selected clock source and the internal system  
clock. These bits can be written run-time to vary the clock frequency to suit the application  
requirements. As the divider divides the master clock input to the MCU, the speed of all synchro-  
nous peripherals is reduced when a division factor is used. The division factors are given in  
Table 7-14.  
To avoid unintentional changes of clock frequency, a special write procedure must be followed  
to change the CLKPS bits:  
1. Write the Clock Prescaler Change Enable (CLKPCE) bit to one and all other bits in  
CLKPR to zero.  
2. Within four cycles, write the desired value to CLKPS while writing a zero to CLKPCE.  
Interrupts must be disabled when changing prescaler setting to make sure the write procedure is  
not interrupted.  
The CKDIV8 Fuse determines the initial value of the CLKPS bits. If CKDIV8 is unprogrammed,  
the CLKPS bits will be reset to “0000”. If CKDIV8 is programmed, CLKPS bits are reset to  
“0011”, giving a division factor of eight at start up. This feature should be used if the selected  
clock source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the device at the present  
operating conditions. Note that any value can be written to the CLKPS bits regardless of the  
CKDIV8 Fuse setting. The Application software must ensure that a sufficient division factor is  
chosen if the selcted clock source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the  
30  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
device at the present operating conditions. The device is shipped with the CKDIV8 Fuse  
programmed.  
Table 7-14. Clock Prescaler Select  
CLKPS3  
CLKPS2  
CLKPS1  
CLKPS0  
Clock Division Factor  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
4
8
16  
32  
64  
128  
256  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
7.10.2  
Switching Time  
When switching between prescaler settings, the System Clock Prescaler ensures that no  
glitches occur in the clock system and that no intermediate frequency is higher than neither the  
clock frequency corresponding to the previous setting, nor the clock frequency corresponding to  
the new setting.  
The ripple counter that implements the prescaler runs at the frequency of the undivided clock,  
which may be faster than the CPU’s clock frequency. Hence, it is not possible to determine the  
state of the prescaler – even if it were readable, and the exact time it takes to switch from one  
clock division to another cannot be exactly predicted.  
From the time the CLKPS values are written, it takes between T1 + T2 and T1 + 2*T2 before the  
new clock frequency is active. In this interval, 2 active clock edges are produced. Here, T1 is the  
previous clock period, and T2 is the period corresponding to the new prescaler setting.  
31  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
8. Power Management and Sleep Modes  
The high performance and industry leading code efficiency makes the AVR microcontrollers an  
ideal choise for low power applications.  
Sleep modes enable the application to shut down unused modules in the MCU, thereby saving  
power. The AVR provides various sleep modes allowing the user to tailor the power consump-  
tion to the application’s requirements.  
To enter any of the three sleep modes, the SE bit in MCUCR must be written to logic one and a  
SLEEP instruction must be executed. The SM1:0 bits in the MCUCR Register select which sleep  
mode (Idle, ADC Noise Reduction or Power-down) will be activated by the SLEEP instruction.  
See Table 8-1 for a summary. If an enabled interrupt occurs while the MCU is in a sleep mode,  
the MCU wakes up. The MCU is then halted for four cycles in addition to the start-up time, exe-  
cutes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the instruction following SLEEP. The  
contents of the Register File and SRAM are unaltered when the device wakes up from sleep. If a  
reset occurs during sleep mode, the MCU wakes up and executes from the Reset Vector.  
Figure 7-1 on page 22 presents the different clock systems in the ATtiny25/45/85, and their dis-  
tribution. The figure is helpful in selecting an appropriate sleep mode.  
8.0.1  
MCUCR – MCU Control Register  
The MCU Control Register contains control bits for power management.  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x35  
PUD  
R/W  
0
SE  
R/W  
0
SM1  
R/W  
0
SM0  
R/W  
0
R
0
ISC01  
R/W  
0
ISC00  
R/W  
0
MCUCR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bit 5 – SE: Sleep Enable  
The SE bit must be written to logic one to make the MCU enter the sleep mode when the SLEEP  
instruction is executed. To avoid the MCU entering the sleep mode unless it is the programmer’s  
purpose, it is recommended to write the Sleep Enable (SE) bit to one just before the execution of  
the SLEEP instruction and to clear it immediately after waking up.  
• Bits 4, 3 – SM1:0: Sleep Mode Select Bits 2..0  
These bits select between the three available sleep modes as shown in Table 8-1.  
Table 8-1.  
SM1  
Sleep Mode Select  
SM0  
Sleep Mode  
Idle  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
ADC Noise Reduction  
Power-down  
Reserved  
• Bit 2 – Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserv ed bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
32  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
8.1  
Idle Mode  
When the SM1:0 bits are written to 00, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Idle mode,  
stopping the CPU but allowing Analog Comparator, ADC, USI, Timer/Counter, Watchdog, and  
the interrupt system to continue operating. This sleep mode basically halts clkCPU and clkFLASH  
while allowing the other clocks to run.  
,
Idle mode enables the MCU to wake up from external triggered interrupts as well as internal  
ones like the Timer Overflow. If wake-up from the Analog Comparator interrupt is not required,  
the Analog Comparator can be powered down by setting the ACD bit in the Analog Comparator  
Control and Status Register – ACSR. This will reduce power consumption in Idle mode. If the  
ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automatically when this mode is entered.  
8.2  
ADC Noise Reduction Mode  
When the SM1:0 bits are written to 01, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter ADC Noise  
Reduction mode, stopping the CPU but allowing the ADC, USI, the external interrupts, and the  
Watchdog to continue operating (if enabled). This sleep mode halts clkI/O, clkCPU, and clkFLASH  
while allowing the other clocks to run.  
,
This improves the noise environment for the ADC, enabling higher resolution measurements. If  
the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automatically when this mode is entered. Apart form the  
ADC Conversion Complete interrupt, only an External Reset, a Watchdog Reset, a Brown-out  
Reset, an SPM/EEPROM ready interrupt, an external level interrupt on INT0 or a pin change  
interrupt can wake up the MCU from ADC Noise Reduction mode.  
8.3  
Power-down Mode  
When the SM1:0 bits are written to 10, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Power-  
down mode. In this mode, the Oscillator is stopped, while the external interrupts, the USI start  
condition detection and the Watchdog continue operating (if enabled). Only an External Reset, a  
Watchdog Reset, a Brown-out Reset, USI start condition interupt, an external level interrupt on  
INT0 or a pin change interrupt can wake up the MCU. This sleep mode halts all generated  
clocks, allowing operation of asynchronous modules only.  
Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down mode, the changed  
level must be held for some time to wake up the MCU. Refer to ”External Interrupts” on page 48  
for details..  
Table 8-2.  
Active Clock Domains and Wake-up Sources in the Different Sleep Modes  
Active Clock Domains  
Oscillators  
Wake-up Sources  
Sleep Mode  
Idle  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
ADC Noise  
Reduction  
X(1)  
X(1)  
Power-down  
Note:  
1. For INT0, only level interrupt.  
33  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
8.4  
Power Reduction Register  
The Power Reduction Register, PRR, provides a method to stop the clock to individualperipher-  
als to reduce power consumption. The current state of the peripheral is frozenand the I/O  
registers can not be read or written. Resources used by the peripheral when stopping the clock  
will remain occupied, hence the peripheral should in most cases be disabled before stopping the  
clock. Waking up a module, which is done by clearing the bit in PRR, puts the module in the  
same state as before shutdown.  
Module shutdown can be used in Idle mode and Active mode to significantly reduce the overall  
power consumption. See “Power-Down Supply Current” on page TBD for examples. In all other  
sleep modes, the clock is already stopped  
8.4.1  
PRR – Power Reduction Register  
.
Bit  
7
R
0
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
2
1
0
0x20  
PRTIM1  
R/W  
0
PRTIM0  
R/W  
0
PRUSI  
R/W  
0
PRADC  
R/W  
0
PRR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7:4- Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 3- PRTIM1: Power Reduction Timer/Counter1  
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter1 module. When the Timer/Counter1  
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.  
• Bit 2- PRTIM0: Power Reduction Timer/Counter0  
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter0 module. When the Timer/Counter0  
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.  
• Bit 1 - PRUSI: Power Reduction USI  
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USI by stopping the clock to the module. When  
waking up the USI again, the USI should be re initialized to ensure proper operation.  
• Bit 0 - PRADC: Power Reduction ADC  
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the ADC. The ADC must be disabled before shut down.  
The analog comparator cannot use the ADC input MUX when the ADC is shut down.  
8.5  
Minimizing Power Consumption  
There are several issues to consider when trying to minimize the power consumption in an AVR  
controlled system. In general, sleep modes should be used as much as possible, and the sleep  
mode should be selected so that as few as possible of the device’s functions are operating. All  
functions not needed should be disabled. In particular, the following modules may need special  
consideration when trying to achieve the lowest possible power consumption.  
8.5.1  
Analog to Digital Converter  
If enabled, the ADC will be enabled in all sleep modes. To save power, the ADC should be dis-  
abled before entering any sleep mode. When the ADC is turned off and on again, the next  
34  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
conversion will be an extended conversion. Refer to ”Analog to Digital Converter” on page 124  
for details on ADC operation.  
8.5.2  
Analog Comparator  
When entering Idle mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled if not used. When entering  
ADC Noise Reduction mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled. In the other sleep  
modes, the Analog Comparator is automatically disabled. However, if the Analog Comparator is  
set up to use the Internal Voltage Reference as input, the Analog Comparator should be dis-  
abled in all sleep modes. Otherwise, the Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled,  
independent of sleep mode. Refer to ”Analog Comparator” on page 121 for details on how to  
configure the Analog Comparator.  
8.5.3  
8.5.4  
Brown-out Detector  
If the Brown-out Detector is not needed in the application, this module should be turned off. If the  
Brown-out Detector is enabled by the BODLEVEL Fuses, it will be enabled in all sleep modes,  
and hence, always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly  
to the total current consumption. Refer to ”Brown-out Detection” on page 38 for details on how to  
configure the Brown-out Detector.  
Internal Voltage Reference  
The Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled when needed by the Brown-out Detection, the  
Analog Comparator or the ADC. If these modules are disabled as described in the sections  
above, the internal voltage reference will be disabled and it will not be consuming power. When  
turned on again, the user must allow the reference to start up before the output is used. If the  
reference is kept on in sleep mode, the output can be used immediately. Refer to ”Internal Volt-  
age Reference” on page 40 for details on the start-up time.  
8.5.5  
8.5.6  
Watchdog Timer  
If the Watchdog Timer is not needed in the application, this module should be turned off. If the  
Watchdog Timer is enabled, it will be enabled in all sleep modes, and hence, always consume  
power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consump-  
tion. Refer to ”Watchdog Timer” on page 41 for details on how to configure the Watchdog Timer.  
Port Pins  
When entering a sleep mode, all port pins should be configured to use minimum power. The  
most important thing is then to ensure that no pins drive resistive loads. In sleep modes where  
both the I/O clock (clkI/O) and the ADC clock (clkADC) are stopped, the input buffers of the device  
will be disabled. This ensures that no power is consumed by the input logic when not needed. In  
some cases, the input logic is needed for detecting wake-up conditions, and it will then be  
enabled. Refer to the section ”Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes” on page 55 for details on  
which pins are enabled. If the input buffer is enabled and the input signal is left floating or has an  
analog signal level close to VCC/2, the input buffer will use excessive power.  
For analog input pins, the digital input buffer should be disabled at all times. An analog signal  
level close to VCC/2 on an input pin can cause significant current even in active mode. Digital  
input buffers can be disabled by writing to the Digital Input Disable Register (DIDR0). Refer to  
”DIDR0 – Digital Input Disable Register 0” on page 123 for details.  
35  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
9. System Control and Reset  
9.0.1  
Resetting the AVR  
During reset, all I/O Registers are set to their initial values, and the program starts execution  
from the Reset Vector. The instruction placed at the Reset Vector must be a RJMP – Relative  
Jump – instruction to the reset handling routine. If the program never enables an interrupt  
source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these  
locations. The circuit diagram in Figure 9-1 shows the reset logic. Table 9-1 defines the electrical  
parameters of the reset circuitry.  
The I/O ports of the AVR are immediately reset to their initial state when a reset source goes  
active. This does not require any clock source to be running.  
After all reset sources have gone inactive, a delay counter is invoked, stretching the internal  
reset. This allows the power to reach a stable level before normal operation starts. The time-out  
period of the delay counter is defined by the user through the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. The dif-  
ferent selections for the delay period are presented in ”Clock Sources” on page 24.  
9.0.2  
Reset Sources  
The ATtiny25/45/85 has four sources of reset:  
• Power-on Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage is below the Power-on Reset  
threshold (VPOT).  
• External Reset. The MCU is reset when a low level is present on the RESET pin for longer than  
the minimum pulse length.  
• Watchdog Reset. The MCU is reset when the Watchdog Timer period expires and the  
Watchdog is enabled.  
• Brown-out Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage VCC is below the Brown-out Reset  
threshold (VBOT) and the Brown-out Detector is enabled.  
Figure 9-1. Reset Logic  
DATA BUS  
MCU Status  
Register (MCUSR)  
Power-on Reset  
Circuit  
Brown-out  
Reset Circuit  
BODLEVEL [2..0]  
Pull-up Resistor  
SPIKE  
FILTER  
Watchdog  
Oscillator  
Delay Counters  
Clock  
CK  
Generator  
TIMEOUT  
CKSEL[1:0]  
SUT[1:0]  
36  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 9-1.  
Symbol  
Reset Characteristics(1)  
Parameter  
Condition  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Units  
Power-on Reset Threshold  
Voltage (rising)  
TA = -40 - 85°C  
0.7  
1.0  
1.4  
V
VPOT  
Power-on Reset Threshold  
Voltage (falling)(2)  
TA = -40 - 85°C  
0.6  
0.9  
1.3  
0.9 VCC  
2.5  
V
V
RESET Pin Threshold  
Voltage  
VRST  
tRST  
VCC = 3V  
0.2 VCC  
Minimum pulse width on  
RESET Pin  
VCC = 3V  
µs  
Notes: 1. Values are guidelines only. Actual values are TBD.  
2. The Power-on Reset will not work unless the supply voltage has been below VPOT (falling)  
9.0.3  
Power-on Reset  
A Power-on Reset (POR) pulse is generated by an On-chip detection circuit. The detection level  
is defined in Table 9-1. The POR is activated whenever VCC is below the detection level. The  
POR circuit can be used to trigger the Start-up Reset, as well as to detect a failure in supply  
voltage.  
A Power-on Reset (POR) circuit ensures that the device is reset from Power-on. Reaching the  
Power-on Reset threshold voltage invokes the delay counter, which determines how long the  
device is kept in RESET after VCC rise. The RESET signal is activated again, without any delay,  
when VCC decreases below the detection level.  
Figure 9-2. MCU Start-up, RESET Tied to VCC  
VPOT  
VCC  
VRST  
RESET  
tTOUT  
TIME-OUT  
INTERNAL  
RESET  
37  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 9-3. MCU Start-up, RESET Extended Externally  
VPOT  
VCC  
VRST  
RESET  
tTOUT  
TIME-OUT  
INTERNAL  
RESET  
9.0.4  
External Reset  
An External Reset is generated by a low level on the RESET pin if enabled. Reset pulses longer  
than the minimum pulse width (see Table 9-1) will generate a reset, even if the clock is not run-  
ning. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset. When the applied signal reaches  
the Reset Threshold Voltage – VRST – on its positive edge, the delay counter starts the MCU  
after the Time-out period – tTOUT – has expired.  
Figure 9-4. External Reset During Operation  
CC  
9.0.5  
Brown-out Detection  
ATtiny25/45/85 has an On-chip Brown-out Detection (BOD) circuit for monitoring the VCC level  
during operation by comparing it to a fixed trigger level. The trigger level for the BOD can be  
selected by the BODLEVEL Fuses. The trigger level has a hysteresis to ensure spike free  
Brown-out Detection. The hysteresis on the detection level should be interpreted as VBOT+  
BOT + VHYST/2 and VBOT- = VBOT - VHYST/2.  
=
V
Table 9-2.  
BODLEVEL Fuse Coding(1)  
Min VBOT  
BODLEVEL [2:0] Fuses  
111  
Typ VBOT  
Max VBOT  
Units  
BOD Disabled  
38  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 9-2.  
BODLEVEL [2:0] Fuses  
BODLEVEL Fuse Coding(1)  
Min VBOT  
Typ VBOT  
1.8  
Max VBOT  
Units  
110  
101  
100  
011  
010  
001  
000  
2.7  
4.3  
2.3  
V
2.2  
1.9  
2.0  
Note:  
1. VBOT may be below nominal minimum operating voltage for some devices. For devices where  
this is the case, the device is tested down to VCC = VBOT during the production test. This guar-  
antees that a Brown-out Reset will occur before VCC drops to a voltage where correct  
operation of the microcontroller is no longer guaranteed.  
Table 9-3.  
Symbol  
VHYST  
Brown-out Characteristics  
Parameter  
Min  
Typ  
50  
2
Max  
Units  
mV  
Brown-out Detector Hysteresis  
Min Pulse Width on Brown-out Reset  
tBOD  
µs  
When the BOD is enabled, and VCC decreases to a value below the trigger level (VBOT- in Figure  
9-5), the Brown-out Reset is immediately activated. When VCC increases above the trigger level  
(VBOT+ in Figure 9-5), the delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period tTOUT has  
expired.  
The BOD circuit will only detect a drop in VCC if the voltage stays below the trigger level for  
longer than tBOD given in Table 9-1.  
Figure 9-5. Brown-out Reset During Operation  
VBOT+  
VCC  
VBOT-  
RESET  
t
TOUT  
TIME-OUT  
INTERNAL  
RESET  
9.0.6  
Watchdog Reset  
When the Watchdog times out, it will generate a short reset pulse of one CK cycle duration. On  
the falling edge of this pulse, the delay timer starts counting the Time-out period tTOUT. Refer to  
page 41 for details on operation of the Watchdog Timer.  
39  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 9-6. Watchdog Reset During Operation  
CC  
CK  
9.0.7  
MCUSR – MCU Status Register  
The MCU Status Register provides information on which reset source caused an MCU Reset.  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
R
0
4
R
0
3
2
1
0
0x34  
WDRF  
R/W  
BORF  
R/W  
EXTRF  
R/W  
PORF  
R/W  
MCUSR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
See Bit Description  
• Bits 7..4 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 3 – WDRF: Watchdog Reset Flag  
This bit is set if a Watchdog Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a  
logic zero to the flag.  
• Bit 2 – BORF: Brown-out Reset Flag  
This bit is set if a Brown-out Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a  
logic zero to the flag.  
• Bit 1 – EXTRF: External Reset Flag  
This bit is set if an External Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a  
logic zero to the flag.  
• Bit 0 – PORF: Power-on Reset Flag  
This bit is set if a Power-on Reset occurs. The bit is reset only by writing a logic zero to the flag.  
To make use of the Reset Flags to identify a reset condition, the user should read and then reset  
the MCUSR as early as possible in the program. If the register is cleared before another reset  
occurs, the source of the reset can be found by examining the Reset Flags.  
9.1  
Internal Voltage Reference  
ATtiny25/45/85 features an internal bandgap reference. This reference is used for Brown-out  
Detection, and it can be used as an input to the Analog Comparator or the ADC.  
40  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
9.1.1  
Voltage Reference Enable Signals and Start-up Time  
The voltage reference has a start-up time that may influence the way it should be used. The  
start-up time is given in Table 9-4. To save power, the reference is not always turned on. The  
reference is on during the following situations:  
1. When the BOD is enabled (by programming the BODLEVEL [2..0] Fuse).  
2. When the bandgap reference is connected to the Analog Comparator (by setting the  
ACBG bit in ACSR).  
3. When the ADC is enabled.  
Thus, when the BOD is not enabled, after setting the ACBG bit or enabling the ADC, the user  
must always allow the reference to start up before the output from the Analog Comparator or  
ADC is used. To reduce power consumption in Power-down mode, the user can avoid the three  
conditions above to ensure that the reference is turned off before entering Power-down mode.  
Table 9-4.  
Symbol  
Internal Voltage Reference Characteristics(1)  
Parameter  
Condition  
Min  
Typ  
Max  
Units  
VCC = 1.1V / 2.7V,  
TA = 25°C  
VBG  
tBG  
IBG  
Bandgap reference voltage  
1.0  
1.1  
1.2  
V
VCC = 2.7V,  
TA = 25°C  
Bandgap reference start-up time  
40  
15  
70  
µs  
Bandgap reference current  
consumption  
VCC = 2.7V,  
TA = 25°C  
µA  
Note:  
1. Values are guidelines only. Actual values are TBD.  
9.2  
Watchdog Timer  
The Watchdog Timer is clocked from an On-chip Oscillator which runs at 128 kHz. By controlling  
the Watchdog Timer prescaler, the Watchdog Reset interval can be adjusted as shown in Table  
9-7 on page 43. The WDR – Watchdog Reset – instruction resets the Watchdog Timer. The  
Watchdog Timer is also reset when it is disabled and when a Chip Reset occurs. Ten different  
clock cycle periods can be selected to determine the reset period. If the reset period expires  
without another Watchdog Reset, the ATtiny25/45/85 resets and executes from the Reset Vec-  
tor. For timing details on the Watchdog Reset, refer to Table 9-7 on page 43.  
The Wathdog Timer can also be configured to generate an interrupt instead of a reset. This can  
be very helpful when using the Watchdog to wake-up from Power-down.  
To prevent unintentional disabling of the Watchdog or unintentional change of time-out period,  
two different safety levels are selected by the fuse WDTON as shown in Table 9-5. Refer to  
”Timed Sequences for Changing the Configuration of the Watchdog Timer” on page 44 for  
details.  
Table 9-5.  
WDT Configuration as a Function of the Fuse Settings of WDTON  
Safety  
Level  
WDT Initial  
State  
How to Disable the  
WDT  
How to Change Time-  
out  
WDTON  
Unprogrammed  
Programmed  
1
2
Disabled  
Enabled  
Timed sequence  
Always enabled  
No limitations  
Timed sequence  
41  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 9-7. Watchdog Timer  
WATCHDOG  
PRESCALER  
128 kHz  
OSCILLATOR  
WATCHDOG  
RESET  
WDP0  
WDP1  
WDP2  
WDP3  
WDE  
MCU RESET  
9.2.1  
WDTCR – Watchdog Timer Control Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x21  
WDIF  
R/W  
0
WDIE  
R/W  
0
WDP3  
R/W  
0
WDCE  
R/W  
0
WDE  
R/W  
X
WDP2  
R/W  
0
WDP1  
R/W  
0
WDP0  
R/W  
0
WDTCR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bit 7 – WDIF: Watchdog Timeout Interrupt Flag  
This bit is set when a time-out occurs in the Watchdog Timer and the Watchdog Timer is config-  
ured for interrupt. WDIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt  
handling vector. Alternatively, WDIF is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in  
SREG and WDIE are set, the Watchdog Time-out Interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 6 – WDIE: Watchdog Timeout Interrupt Enable  
When this bit is written to one, WDE is cleared, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the  
Watchdog Time-out Interrupt is enabled. In this mode the corresponding interrupt is executed  
instead of a reset if a timeout in the Watchdog Timer occurs.  
If WDE is set, WDIE is automatically cleared by hardware when a time-out occurs. This is useful  
for keeping the Watchdog Reset security while using the interrupt. After the WDIE bit is cleared,  
the next time-out will generate a reset. To avoid the Watchdog Reset, WDIE must be set after  
each interrupt.  
Table 9-6.  
Watchdog Timer Configuration  
WDE  
WDIE  
Watchdog Timer State  
Stopped  
Action on Time-out  
None  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Running  
Interrupt  
Running  
Reset  
Running  
Interrupt  
• Bit 4 – WDCE: Watchdog Change Enable  
This bit must be set when the WDE bit is written to logic zero. Otherwise, the Watchdog will not  
be disabled. Once written to one, hardware will clear this bit after four clock cycles. Refer to the  
42  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
description of the WDE bit for a Watchdog disable procedure. This bit must also be set when  
changing the prescaler bits. See Section “9.3” on page 44.  
• Bit 3 – WDE: Watchdog Enable  
When the WDE is written to logic one, the Watchdog Timer is enabled, and if the WDE is written  
to logic zero, the Watchdog Timer function is disabled. WDE can only be cleared if the WDCE bit  
has logic level one. To disable an enabled Watchdog Timer, the following procedure must be  
followed:  
1. In the same operation, write a logic one to WDCE and WDE. A logic one must be written  
to WDE even though it is set to one before the disable operation starts.  
2. Within the next four clock cycles, write a logic 0 to WDE. This disables the Watchdog.  
In safety level 2, it is not possible to disable the Watchdog Timer, even with the algorithm  
described above. See Section “9.3” on page 44.  
In safety level 1, WDE is overridden by WDRF in MCUSR. See ”MCUSR – MCU Status Regis-  
ter” on page 40 for description of WDRF. This means that WDE is always set when WDRF is set.  
To clear WDE, WDRF must be cleared before disabling the Watchdog with the procedure  
described above. This feature ensures multiple resets during conditions causing failure, and a  
safe start-up after the failure.  
Note:  
If the watchdog timer is not going to be used in the application, it is important to go through a  
watchdog disable procedure in the initialization of the device. If the Watchdog is accidentally  
enabled, for example by a runaway pointer or brown-out condition, the device will be reset, which  
in turn will lead to a new watchdog reset. To avoid this situation, the application software should  
always clear the WDRF flag and the WDE control bit in the initialization routine.  
• Bits 5, 2:0 – WDP3:0: Watchdog Timer Prescaler 3, 2, 1, and 0  
The WDP3:0 bits determine the Watchdog Timer prescaling when the Watchdog Timer is  
enabled. The different prescaling values and their corresponding Timeout Periods are shown in  
Table 9-7.  
Table 9-7.  
Watchdog Timer Prescale Select  
Number of WDT Oscillator  
Typical Time-out at  
VCC = 5.0V  
WDP3  
WDP2  
WDP1  
WDP0  
Cycles  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2K (2048) cycles  
16 ms  
32 ms  
64 ms  
0.125 s  
0.25 s  
0.5 s  
4K (4096) cycles  
8K (8192) cycles  
16K (16384) cycles  
32K (32764) cycles  
64K (65536) cycles  
128K (131072) cycles  
256K (262144) cycles  
512K (524288) cycles  
1024K (1048576) cycles  
1.0 s  
2.0 s  
4.0 s  
8.0 s  
43  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 9-7.  
Watchdog Timer Prescale Select  
Number of WDT Oscillator  
Typical Time-out at  
VCC = 5.0V  
WDP3  
WDP2  
WDP1  
WDP0  
Cycles  
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Reserved  
The following code example shows one assembly and one C function for turning off the WDT.  
The example assumes that interrupts are controlled (e.g., by disabling interrupts globally) so that  
no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions.  
Assembly Code Example(1)  
WDT_off:  
WDR  
; Clear WDRF in MCUSR  
ldi r16, (0<<WDRF)  
out MCUSR, r16  
; Write logical one to WDCE and WDE  
; Keep old prescaler setting to prevent unintentional Watchdog Reset  
in r16, WDTCR  
ori r16, (1<<WDCE)|(1<<WDE)  
out WDTCR, r16  
; Turn off WDT  
ldi r16, (0<<WDE)  
out WDTCR, r16  
ret  
C Code Example(1)  
void WDT_off(void)  
{
_WDR();  
/* Clear WDRF in MCUSR */  
MCUSR = 0x00  
/* Write logical one to WDCE and WDE */  
WDTCR |= (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE);  
/* Turn off WDT */  
WDTCR = 0x00;  
}
Note:  
1. The example code assumes that the part specific header file is included.  
9.3  
Timed Sequences for Changing the Configuration of the Watchdog Timer  
The sequence for changing configuration differs slightly between the two safety levels. Separate  
procedures are described for each level.  
44  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
9.3.1  
Safety Level 1  
In this mode, the Watchdog Timer is initially disabled, but can be enabled by writing the WDE bit  
to one without any restriction. A timed sequence is needed when disabling an enabled Watch-  
dog Timer. To disable an enabled Watchdog Timer, the following procedure must be followed:  
1. In the same operation, write a logic one to WDCE and WDE. A logic one must be written  
to WDE regardless of the previous value of the WDE bit.  
2. Within the next four clock cycles, in the same operation, write the WDE and WDP bits as  
desired, but with the WDCE bit cleared.  
9.3.2  
Safety Level 2  
In this mode, the Watchdog Timer is always enabled, and the WDE bit will always read as one. A  
timed sequence is needed when changing the Watchdog Time-out period. To change the  
Watchdog Time-out, the following procedure must be followed:  
1. In the same operation, write a logical one to WDCE and WDE. Even though the WDE  
always is set, the WDE must be written to one to start the timed sequence.  
2. Within the next four clock cycles, in the same operation, write the WDP bits as desired,  
but with the WDCE bit cleared. The value written to the WDE bit is irrelevant.  
45  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
10. Interrupts  
This section describes the specifics of the interrupt handling as performed in ATtiny25/45/85.  
For a general explanation of the AVR interrupt handling, refer to ”Reset and Interrupt Handling”  
on page 11.  
10.1 Interrupt Vectors in ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 10-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors  
Vector Program  
No. Address  
Source  
Interrupt Definition  
External Pin, Power-on Reset, Brown-out Reset,  
Watchdog Reset  
1
0x0000  
RESET  
2
3
0x0001  
0x0002  
0x0003  
0x0004  
0x0005  
0x0006  
0x0007  
0x0008  
0x0009  
0x000A  
0x000B  
0x000C  
0x000D  
0x000E  
INT0  
External Interrupt Request 0  
Pin Change Interrupt Request 0  
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match A  
Timer/Counter1 Overflow  
Timer/Counter0 Overflow  
EEPROM Ready  
PCINT0  
4
TIMER1_COMPA  
TIMER1_OVF  
TIMER0_OVF  
EE_RDY  
5
6
7
8
ANA_COMP  
ADC  
Analog Comparator  
9
ADC Conversion Complete  
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match B  
Watchdog Time-out  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
TIMER1_COMPB  
TIMER0_COMPA  
TIMER0_COMPB  
WDT  
USI_START  
USI_OVF  
USI START  
USI Overflow  
If the program never enables an interrupt source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular  
program code can be placed at these locations. The most typical and general program setup for  
the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses in ATtiny25/45/85 is:  
Address Labels Code  
Comments  
0x0000  
0x0001  
0x0002  
0x0003  
0x0004  
0x0005  
0x0006  
0x0007  
0x0008  
0x0009  
0x000A  
0x000B  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
RESET  
; Reset Handler  
EXT_INT0  
PCINT0  
; IRQ0 Handler  
; PCINT0 Handler  
; Timer1 CompareA Handler  
; Timer1 Overflow Handler  
; Timer0 Overflow Handler  
; EEPROM Ready Handler  
; Analog Comparator Handler  
; ADC Conversion Handler  
; Timer1 CompareB Handler  
;
TIM1_COMPA  
TIM1_OVF  
TIM0_OVF  
EE_RDY  
ANA_COMP  
ADC  
TIM1_COMPB  
TIM0_COMPA  
TIM0_COMPB  
;
46  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
0x000C  
0x000D  
0x000E  
rjmp  
rjmp  
rjmp  
WDT  
;
;
;
USI_START  
USI_OVF  
0x000F RESET: ldi  
r16, low(RAMEND); Main program start  
0x0010  
0x0011  
0x0012  
0x0013  
0x0014  
...  
ldi  
out  
r17, high(RAMEND); Tiny45/85 also has SPH  
SPL, r16  
SPH, r17  
; Set Stack Pointer to top of RAM  
; Tiny45/85 als has SPH  
; Enable interrupts  
out  
sei  
<instr> xxx  
...  
... ...  
47  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
11. External Interrupts  
The External Interrupts are triggered by the INT0 pin or any of the PCINT5..0 pins. Observe that,  
if enabled, the interrupts will trigger even if the INT0 or PCINT5..0 pins are configured as out-  
puts. This feature provides a way of generating a software interrupt. Pin change interrupts PCI  
will trigger if any enabled PCINT5..0 pin toggles. The PCMSK Register control which pins con-  
tribute to the pin change interrupts. Pin change interrupts on PCINT5..0 are detected  
asynchronously. This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the part also from  
sleep modes other than Idle mode.  
The INT0 interrupts can be triggered by a falling or rising edge or a low level. This is set up as  
indicated in the specification for the MCU Control Register – MCUCR. When the INT0 interrupt is  
enabled and is configured as level triggered, the interrupt will trigger as long as the pin is held  
low. Note that recognition of falling or rising edge interrupts on INT0 requires the presence of an  
I/O clock, described in ”Clock Systems and their Distribution” on page 22. Low level interrupt on  
INT0 is detected asynchronously. This implies that this interrupt can be used for waking the part  
also from sleep modes other than Idle mode. The I/O clock is halted in all sleep modes except  
Idle mode.  
Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down, the required level  
must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If  
the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no inter-  
rupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses as described  
in ”System Clock and Clock Options” on page 22.  
11.1 Pin Change Interrupt Timing  
An example of timing of a pin change interrupt is shown in Figure .  
Timing of pin change interrupts  
pin_lat  
pcint_in_(0)  
PCINT(0)  
clk  
0
x
D
Q
pcint_syn  
pcint_setflag  
PCIF  
pin_sync  
PCINT(0) in PCMSK(x)  
LE  
clk  
clk  
PCINT(0)  
pin_lat  
pin_sync  
pcint_in_(0)  
pcint_syn  
pcint_setflag  
PCIF  
48  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
11.2 External Interrupts Register Description  
11.2.1  
MCUCR – MCU Control Register  
The External Interrupt Control Register A contains control bits for interrupt sense control.  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
5
4
3
2
R
0
1
0
0x35  
PUD  
R/W  
0
SE  
R/W  
0
SM1  
R/W  
0
SM0  
R/W  
0
ISC01  
R/W  
0
ISC00  
R/W  
0
MCUCR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 1, 0 – ISC01, ISC00: Interrupt Sense Control 0 Bit 1 and Bit 0  
The External Interrupt 0 is activated by the external pin INT0 if the SREG I-flag and the corre-  
sponding interrupt mask are set. The level and edges on the external INT0 pin that activate the  
interrupt are defined in Table 11-1. The value on the INT0 pin is sampled before detecting  
edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one clock period will  
generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level  
interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing  
instruction to generate an interrupt.  
Table 11-1. Interrupt 0 Sense Control  
ISC01  
ISC00  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
The low level of INT0 generates an interrupt request.  
Any logical change on INT0 generates an interrupt request.  
The falling edge of INT0 generates an interrupt request.  
The rising edge of INT0 generates an interrupt request.  
11.2.2  
GIMSK – General Interrupt Mask Register  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
5
4
R
0
3
R
0
2
R
0
1
R
0
0
R
0
0x3B  
INT0  
R/W  
0
PCIE  
R/W  
0
GIMSK  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 7, 4:0 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 6 – INT0: External Interrupt Request 0 Enable  
When the INT0 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), the exter-  
nal pin interrupt is enabled. The Interrupt Sense Control0 bits 1/0 (ISC01 and ISC00) in the MCU  
Control Register (MCUCR) define whether the external interrupt is activated on rising and/or fall-  
ing edge of the INT0 pin or level sensed. Activity on the pin will cause an interrupt request even  
if INT0 is configured as an output. The corresponding interrupt of External Interrupt Request 0 is  
executed from the INT0 Interrupt Vector.  
• Bit 5 – PCIE: Pin Change Interrupt Enable  
When the PCIE bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), pin  
change interrupt is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT5:0 pin will cause an interrupt.  
The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI Interrupt  
Vector. PCINT5:0 pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK0 Register.  
49  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
11.2.3  
GIFR – General Interrupt Flag Register  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
5
4
R
0
3
R
0
2
R
0
1
R
0
0
R
0
0x3A  
INTF0  
R/W  
0
PCIF  
R/W  
0
GIFR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 7, 4:0 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 6 – INTF0: External Interrupt Flag 0  
When an edge or logic change on the INT0 pin triggers an interrupt request, INTF0 becomes set  
(one). If the I-bit in SREG and the INT0 bit in GIMSK are set (one), the MCU will jump to the cor-  
responding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed.  
Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it. This flag is always cleared  
when INT0 is configured as a level interrupt.  
• Bit 5 – PCIF: Pin Change Interrupt Flag  
When a logic change on any PCINT5:0 pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF becomes set  
(one). If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE bit in GIMSK are set (one), the MCU will jump to the cor-  
responding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed.  
Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it.  
11.2.4  
PCMSK – Pin Change Mask Register  
Bit  
0x15  
7
6
R
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCINT5  
R/W  
1
PCINT4  
R/W  
1
PCINT3  
R/W  
1
PCINT2  
R/W  
1
PCINT1  
R/W  
1
PCINT0  
R/W  
1
PCMSK  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
• Bits 7, 6 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 5:0 – PCINT5:0: Pin Change Enable Mask 5:0  
Each PCINT5:0 bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin.  
If PCINT5:0 is set and the PCIE bit in GIMSK is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the corre-  
sponding I/O pin. If PCINT5:0 is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is  
disabled.  
50  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
12. I/O Ports  
12.1 Introduction  
All AVR ports have true Read-Modify-Write functionality when used as general digital I/O ports.  
This means that the direction of one port pin can be changed without unintentionally changing  
the direction of any other pin with the SBI and CBI instructions. The same applies when chang-  
ing drive value (if configured as output) or enabling/disabling of pull-up resistors (if configured as  
input). Each output buffer has symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source  
capability. The pin driver is strong enough to drive LED displays directly. All port pins have indi-  
vidually selectable pull-up resistors with a supply-voltage invariant resistance. All I/O pins have  
protection diodes to both VCC and Ground as indicated in Figure 12-1. Refer to ”Electrical Char-  
acteristics” on page 165 for a complete list of parameters.  
Figure 12-1. I/O Pin Equivalent Schematic  
Rpu  
Pxn  
Logic  
Cpin  
See Figure  
"General Digital I/O" for  
Details  
All registers and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “x” repre-  
sents the numbering letter for the port, and a lower case “n” represents the bit number. However,  
when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used. For example,  
PORTB3 for bit no. 3 in Port B, here documented generally as PORTxn. The physical I/O Regis-  
ters and bit locations are listed in ”Register Description for I/O-Ports” on page 63.  
Three I/O memory address locations are allocated for each port, one each for the Data Register  
– PORTx, Data Direction Register – DDRx, and the Port Input Pins – PINx. The Port Input Pins  
I/O location is read only, while the Data Register and the Data Direction Register are read/write.  
However, writing a logic one to a bit in the PINx Register, will result in a toggle in the correspond-  
ing bit in the Data Register. In addition, the Pull-up Disable – PUD bit in MCUCR disables the  
pull-up function for all pins in all ports when set.  
Using the I/O port as General Digital I/O is described in ”Ports as General Digital I/O” on page  
52. Most port pins are multiplexed with alternate functions for the peripheral features on the  
device. How each alternate function interferes with the port pin is described in ”Alternate Port  
Functions” on page 57. Refer to the individual module sections for a full description of the alter-  
nate functions.  
51  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Note that enabling the alternate function of some of the port pins does not affect the use of the  
other pins in the port as general digital I/O.  
12.2 Ports as General Digital I/O  
The ports are bi-directional I/O ports with optional internal pull-ups. Figure 12-2 shows a func-  
tional description of one I/O-port pin, here generically called Pxn.  
Figure 12-2. General Digital I/O(1)  
PUD  
Q
D
DDxn  
Q CLR  
WDx  
RDx  
RESET  
1
0
Q
D
Pxn  
PORTxn  
Q CLR  
RESET  
WPx  
WRx  
SLEEP  
RRx  
SYNCHRONIZER  
RPx  
D
Q
D
L
Q
Q
PINxn  
Q
clk I/O  
WDx:  
RDx:  
WRx:  
RRx:  
RPx:  
WPx:  
WRITE DDRx  
READ DDRx  
WRITE PORTx  
PUD:  
SLEEP:  
clkI/O  
PULLUP DISABLE  
SLEEP CONTROL  
I/O CLOCK  
:
READ PORTx REGISTER  
READ PORTx PIN  
WRITE PINx REGISTER  
Note:  
1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O  
,
SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports.  
12.2.1  
Configuring the Pin  
Each port pin consists of three register bits: DDxn, PORTxn, and PINxn. As shown in ”Register  
Description for I/O-Ports” on page 63, the DDxn bits are accessed at the DDRx I/O address, the  
PORTxn bits at the PORTx I/O address, and the PINxn bits at the PINx I/O address.  
The DDxn bit in the DDRx Register selects the direction of this pin. If DDxn is written logic one,  
Pxn is configured as an output pin. If DDxn is written logic zero, Pxn is configured as an input  
pin.  
If PORTxn is written logic one when the pin is configured as an input pin, the pull-up resistor is  
activated. To switch the pull-up resistor off, PORTxn has to be written logic zero or the pin has to  
be configured as an output pin. The port pins are tri-stated when reset condition becomes active,  
even if no clocks are running.  
52  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
If PORTxn is written logic one when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port pin is driven  
high (one). If PORTxn is written logic zero when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port  
pin is driven low (zero).  
12.2.2  
12.2.3  
Toggling the Pin  
Writing a logic one to PINxn toggles the value of PORTxn, independent on the value of DDRxn.  
Note that the SBI instruction can be used to toggle one single bit in a port.  
Switching Between Input and Output  
When switching between tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) and output high ({DDxn, PORTxn}  
= 0b11), an intermediate state with either pull-up enabled {DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01) or output  
low ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b10) must occur. Normally, the pull-up enabled state is fully accept-  
able, as a high-impedant environment will not notice the difference between a strong high driver  
and a pull-up. If this is not the case, the PUD bit in the MCUCR Register can be set to disable all  
pull-ups in all ports.  
Switching between input with pull-up and output low generates the same problem. The user  
must use either the tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) or the output high state ({DDxn, PORTxn}  
= 0b10) as an intermediate step.  
Table 12-1 summarizes the control signals for the pin value.  
Table 12-1. Port Pin Configurations  
PUD  
DDxn  
PORTxn  
(in MCUCR)  
I/O  
Pull-up  
No  
Comment  
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
X
0
Input  
Tri-state (Hi-Z)  
Input  
Yes  
No  
Pxn will source current if ext. pulled low.  
Tri-state (Hi-Z)  
1
Input  
X
X
Output  
Output  
No  
Output Low (Sink)  
Output High (Source)  
No  
12.2.4  
Reading the Pin Value  
Independent of the setting of Data Direction bit DDxn, the port pin can be read through the  
PINxn Register bit. As shown in Figure 12-2, the PINxn Register bit and the preceding latch con-  
stitute a synchronizer. This is needed to avoid metastability if the physical pin changes value  
near the edge of the internal clock, but it also introduces a delay. Figure 12-3 shows a timing dia-  
gram of the synchronization when reading an externally applied pin value. The maximum and  
minimum propagation delays are denoted tpd,max and tpd,min respectively.  
53  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 12-3. Synchronization when Reading an Externally Applied Pin value  
SYSTEM CLK  
XXX  
XXX  
in r17, PINx  
INSTRUCTIONS  
SYNC LATCH  
PINxn  
0x00  
tpd, max  
0xFF  
r17  
tpd, min  
Consider the clock period starting shortly after the first falling edge of the system clock. The latch  
is closed when the clock is low, and goes transparent when the clock is high, as indicated by the  
shaded region of the “SYNC LATCH” signal. The signal value is latched when the system clock  
goes low. It is clocked into the PINxn Register at the succeeding positive clock edge. As indi-  
cated by the two arrows tpd,max and tpd,min, a single signal transition on the pin will be delayed  
between ½ and 1½ system clock period depending upon the time of assertion.  
When reading back a software assigned pin value, a nop instruction must be inserted as indi-  
cated in Figure 12-4. The out instruction sets the “SYNC LATCH” signal at the positive edge of  
the clock. In this case, the delay tpd through the synchronizer is one system clock period.  
Figure 12-4. Synchronization when Reading a Software Assigned Pin Value  
SYSTEM CLK  
0xFF  
r16  
out PORTx, r16  
nop  
in r17, PINx  
INSTRUCTIONS  
SYNC LATCH  
PINxn  
0x00  
tpd  
0xFF  
r17  
The following code example shows how to set port B pins 0 and 1 high, 2 and 3 low, and define  
the port pins from 4 to 5 as input with a pull-up assigned to port pin 4. The resulting pin values  
are read back again, but as previously discussed, a nop instruction is included to be able to read  
back the value recently assigned to some of the pins.  
54  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Assembly Code Example(1)  
...  
; Define pull-ups and set outputs high  
; Define directions for port pins  
ldi r16,(1<<PB4)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0)  
ldi r17,(1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0)  
out PORTB,r16  
out DDRB,r17  
; Insert nop for synchronization  
nop  
; Read port pins  
in  
r16,PINB  
...  
C Code Example  
unsigned char i;  
...  
/* Define pull-ups and set outputs high */  
/* Define directions for port pins */  
PORTB = (1<<PB4)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0);  
DDRB = (1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0);  
/* Insert nop for synchronization*/  
_NOP();  
/* Read port pins */  
i = PINB;  
...  
Note:  
1. For the assembly program, two temporary registers are used to minimize the time from pull-  
ups are set on pins 0, 1 and 4, until the direction bits are correctly set, defining bit 2 and 3 as  
low and redefining bits 0 and 1 as strong high drivers.  
12.2.5  
Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes  
As shown in Figure 12-2, the digital input signal can be clamped to ground at the input of the  
schmitt-trigger. The signal denoted SLEEP in the figure, is set by the MCU Sleep Controller in  
Power-down mode and Standby mode to avoid high power consumption if some input signals  
are left floating, or have an analog signal level close to VCC/2.  
SLEEP is overridden for port pins enabled as external interrupt pins. If the external interrupt  
request is not enabled, SLEEP is active also for these pins. SLEEP is also overridden by various  
other alternate functions as described in ”Alternate Port Functions” on page 57.  
If a logic high level (“one”) is present on an asynchronous external interrupt pin configured as  
“Interrupt on Rising Edge, Falling Edge, or Any Logic Change on Pin” while the external interrupt  
is not enabled, the corresponding External Interrupt Flag will be set when resuming from the  
above mentioned Sleep mode, as the clamping in these sleep mode produces the requested  
logic change.  
55  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
12.2.6  
Unconnected Pins  
If some pins are unused, it is recommended to ensure that these pins have a defined level. Even  
though most of the digital inputs are disabled in the deep sleep modes as described above, float-  
ing inputs should be avoided to reduce current consumption in all other modes where the digital  
inputs are enabled (Reset, Active mode and Idle mode).  
The simplest method to ensure a defined level of an unused pin, is to enable the internal pull-up.  
In this case, the pull-up will be disabled during reset. If low power consumption during reset is  
important, it is recommended to use an external pull-up or pulldown. Connecting unused pins  
directly to VCC or GND is not recommended, since this may cause excessive currents if the pin is  
accidentally configured as an output.  
56  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
12.3 Alternate Port Functions  
Most port pins have alternate functions in addition to being general digital I/Os. Figure 12-5  
shows how the port pin control signals from the simplified Figure 12-2 can be overridden by  
alternate functions. The overriding signals may not be present in all port pins, but the figure  
serves as a generic description applicable to all port pins in the AVR microcontroller family.  
Figure 12-5. Alternate Port Functions(1)  
PUOExn  
PUOVxn  
1
PUD  
0
DDOExn  
DDOVxn  
1
Q
D
0
DDxn  
Q CLR  
WDx  
RDx  
PVOExn  
PVOVxn  
RESET  
1
0
1
0
Pxn  
Q
D
PORTxn  
PTOExn  
Q CLR  
DIEOExn  
DIEOVxn  
SLEEP  
WPx  
RESET  
WRx  
1
0
RRx  
SYNCHRONIZER  
RPx  
SET  
D
Q
D
L
Q
Q
PINxn  
CLR Q  
CLR  
clk I/O  
DIxn  
AIOxn  
PUOExn: Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE ENABLE  
PUOVxn: Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE VALUE  
DDOExn: Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE ENABLE  
DDOVxn: Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE VALUE  
PVOExn: Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE ENABLE  
PVOVxn: Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE VALUE  
PUD:  
WDx:  
RDx:  
RRx:  
WRx:  
RPx:  
WPx:  
PULLUP DISABLE  
WRITE DDRx  
READ DDRx  
READ PORTx REGISTER  
WRITE PORTx  
READ PORTx PIN  
WRITE PINx  
DIEOExn: Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE ENABLE  
DIEOVxn: Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE VALUE  
clkI/O  
:
I/O CLOCK  
SLEEP:  
SLEEP CONTROL  
DIxn:  
DIGITAL INPUT PIN n ON PORTx  
AIOxn:  
ANALOG INPUT/OUTPUT PIN n ON PORTx  
PTOExn: Pxn, PORT TOGGLE OVERRIDE ENABLE  
Note:  
1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O  
,
SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports. All other signals are unique for each pin.  
57  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 12-2 summarizes the function of the overriding signals. The pin and port indexes from Fig-  
ure 12-5 are not shown in the succeeding tables. The overriding signals are generated internally  
in the modules having the alternate function.  
Table 12-2. Generic Description of Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions  
Signal Name  
Full Name  
Description  
If this signal is set, the pull-up enable is controlled by the PUOV  
signal. If this signal is cleared, the pull-up is enabled when  
{DDxn, PORTxn, PUD} = 0b010.  
Pull-up Override  
Enable  
PUOE  
If PUOE is set, the pull-up is enabled/disabled when PUOV is  
set/cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn, PORTxn,  
and PUD Register bits.  
Pull-up Override  
Value  
PUOV  
DDOE  
DDOV  
If this signal is set, the Output Driver Enable is controlled by the  
DDOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Output driver is  
enabled by the DDxn Register bit.  
Data Direction  
Override Enable  
If DDOE is set, the Output Driver is enabled/disabled when  
DDOV is set/cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn  
Register bit.  
Data Direction  
Override Value  
If this signal is set and the Output Driver is enabled, the port  
value is controlled by the PVOV signal. If PVOE is cleared, and  
the Output Driver is enabled, the port Value is controlled by the  
PORTxn Register bit.  
Port Value  
Override Enable  
PVOE  
Port Value  
Override Value  
If PVOE is set, the port value is set to PVOV, regardless of the  
setting of the PORTxn Register bit.  
PVOV  
PTOE  
Port Toggle  
Override Enable  
If PTOE is set, the PORTxn Register bit is inverted.  
Digital Input  
Enable Override  
Enable  
If this bit is set, the Digital Input Enable is controlled by the  
DIEOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Digital Input Enable  
is determined by MCU state (Normal mode, sleep mode).  
DIEOE  
DIEOV  
Digital Input  
Enable Override  
Value  
If DIEOE is set, the Digital Input is enabled/disabled when  
DIEOV is set/cleared, regardless of the MCU state (Normal  
mode, sleep mode).  
This is the Digital Input to alternate functions. In the figure, the  
signal is connected to the output of the schmitt-trigger but  
before the synchronizer. Unless the Digital Input is used as a  
clock source, the module with the alternate function will use its  
own synchronizer.  
DI  
Digital Input  
This is the Analog Input/Output to/from alternate functions. The  
signal is connected directly to the pad, and can be used bi-  
directionally.  
Analog  
Input/Output  
AIO  
The following subsections shortly describe the alternate functions for each port, and relate the  
overriding signals to the alternate function. Refer to the alternate function description for further  
details.  
58  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
12.3.1  
MCUCR – MCU Control Register  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
5
4
3
2
R
0
1
0
0x35  
PUD  
R/W  
0
SE  
R/W  
0
SM1  
R/W  
0
SM0  
R/W  
0
ISC01  
ISC00  
MCUCR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7, 2– Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 6 – PUD: Pull-up Disable  
When this bit is written to one, the pull-ups in the I/O ports are disabled even if the DDxn and  
PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-ups ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). See ”Con-  
figuring the Pin” on page 52 for more details about this feature.  
12.3.2  
Alternate Functions of Port B  
The Port B pins with alternate function are shown in Table 12-3.  
Table 12-3. Port B Pins Alternate Functions  
Port Pin  
PB5  
Alternate Function  
RESET / dW / ADC0 / PCINT5(1)  
PB4  
XTAL2 / CLKO / ADC2 / OC1B / PCINT4(2)  
XTAL1 / CLKI / ADC3 / OC1B / PCINT3(3)  
SCK / ADC1 / T0 / USCK / SCL / INT0 / PCINT2(4)  
MISO / AIN1 / OC0B / OC1A / DO / PCINT1(5)  
MOSI / AIN0 / OC0A / OC1A / DI / SDA / AREF / PCINT0(6)  
PB3  
PB2  
PB1  
PB0  
Notes: 1. Reset Pin, debugWIRE I/O, ADC Input Channel or Pin Change Interrupt.  
2. XOSC Output, Divided System Clock Output, ADC Input Channel, Timer/Counter1 Output  
Compare and PWM Output B, or Pin Change Interrupt.  
3. XOSC Input / External Clock Input, ADC Input Channel, Timer/Counter1 Inverted Output Com-  
pare and PWM Output B, or Pin Change Interrupt.  
4. Serial Clock Input, ADC Input Channel, Timer/Counter Clock Input, USI Clock (three-wire  
mode), USI Clock (two-wire mode), External Interrupt, or Pin Change Interrupt.  
5. Serial Data Input, Analog Comparator Negative Input, Timer/Counter0 Output Compare and  
PWM Output B, Timer/Counter1 Output Compare and PWM Output A, USI Data Output  
(three-wire mode), or Pin Change Interrupt.  
6. Serial Data Output, Analog Comparator Positive Input, Timer/Counter0 Output Compare and  
PWM Output A, Timer/Counter1 Inverted Output Compare and PWM Output A, USI Data Input  
(three-wire mode), USI Data (two-wire mode), Voltage Ref., or Pin Change Interrupt.  
• Port B, Bit 5 - RESET/dW/ADC0/PCINT5  
RESET: External Reset input is active low and enabled by unprogramming (“1”) the RSTDISBL  
Fuse. Pullup is activated and output driver and digital input are deactivated when the pin is used  
as the RESET pin.  
dW: When the debugWIRE Enable (DWEN) Fuse is programmed and Lock bits are unpro-  
grammed, the debugWIRE system within the target device is activated. The RESET port pin is  
configured as a wire-AND (open-drain) bi-directional I/O pin with pull-up enabled and becomes  
the communication gateway between target and emulator.  
59  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ADC0: Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 0.  
PCINT5: Pin Change Interrupt source 5.  
• Port B, Bit 4- XTAL2/CLKO/ADC2/OC1B/PCINT4  
XTAL2: Chip Clock Oscillator pin 2. Used as clock pin for all chip clock sources except internal  
calibrateble RC Oscillator and external clock. When used as a clock pin, the pin can not be used  
as an I/O pin. When using internal calibratable RC Oscillator or External clock as a Chip clock  
sources, PB4 serves as an ordinary I/O pin.  
CLKO: The devided system clock can be output on the pin PB4. The divided system clock will be  
output if the CKOUT Fuse is programmed, regardless of the PORTB4 and DDB4 settings. It will  
also be output during reset.  
ADC2: Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 2.  
OC1B: Output Compare Match output: The PB4 pin can serve as an external output for the  
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B when configured as an output (DDB4 set). The OC1B pin is  
also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.  
PCINT4: Pin Change Interrupt source 4.  
• Port B, Bit 3 - XTAL1/CLKI/ADC3/OC1B/PCINT3  
XTAL1: Chip Clock Oscillator pin 1. Used for all chip clock sources except internal calibrateble  
RC oscillator. When used as a clock pin, the pin can not be used as an I/O pin.  
CLKI: Clock Input from an external clock source, see ”External Clock” on page 28.  
ADC3: Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 3.  
OC1B: Inverted Output Compare Match output: The PB3 pin can serve as an external output for  
the Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B when configured as an output (DDB3 set). The OC1B pin  
is also the inverted output pin for the PWM mode timer function.  
PCINT3: Pin Change Interrupt source 3.  
• Port B, Bit 2 - SCK/ADC1/T0/USCK/SCL/INT0/PCINT2  
SCK: Master Clock output, Slave Clock input pin for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a  
Slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB2. When the SPI is  
enabled as a Master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDPB2. When the pin is  
forced by the SPI to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB2 bit.  
ADC1: Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 1.  
T0: Timer/Counter0 counter source.  
USCK: Three-wire mode Universal Serial Interface Clock.  
SCL: Two-wire mode Serial Clock for USI Two-wire mode.  
INT0: External Interrupt source 0.  
PCINT2: Pin Change Interrupt source 2.  
• Port B, Bit 1 - MISO/AIN1/OC0B/OC1A/DO/PCINT1  
MISO: Master Data input, Slave Data output pin for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a  
Master, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB1. When the SPI is  
60  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
enabled as a Slave, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB1. When the pin is forced  
by the SPI to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB1 bit.  
AIN1: Analog Comparator Negative Input. Configure the port pin as input with the internal pull-up  
switched off to avoid the digital port function from interfering with the function of the Analog  
Comparator.  
OC0B: Output Compare Match output. The PB1 pin can serve as an external output for the  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match B. The PB1 pin has to be configured as an output (DDB1 set  
(one)) to serve this function. The OC0B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer  
function.  
OC1A: Output Compare Match output: The PB1 pin can serve as an external output for the  
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B when configured as an output (DDB1 set). The OC1A pin is  
also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.  
DO: Three-wire mode Universal Serial Interface Data output. Three-wire mode Data output over-  
rides PORTB1 value and it is driven to the port when data direction bit DDB1 is set (one).  
PORTB1 still enables the pull-up, if the direction is input and PORTB1 is set (one).  
PCINT1: Pin Change Interrupt source 1.  
• Port B, Bit 0 - MOSI/AIN0/OC0A/OC1A/DI/SDA/AREF/PCINT0  
MOSI: SPI Master Data output, Slave Data input for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a  
Slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB0. When the SPI is  
enabled as a Master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB0. When the pin is forced  
by the SPI to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB0 bit.  
AIN0: Analog Comparator Positive Input. Configure the port pin as input with the internal pull-up  
switched off to avoid the digital port function from interfering with the function of the Analog  
Comparator.  
OC0A: Output Compare Match output. The PB0 pin can serve as an external output for the  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A when configured as an output (DDB0 set (one)). The OC0A  
pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.  
OC1A: Inverted Output Compare Match output: The PB0 pin can serve as an external output for  
the Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B when configured as an output (DDB0 set). The OC1A pin  
is also the inverted output pin for the PWM mode timer function.  
SDA: Two-wire mode Serial Interface Data.  
AREF: External Analog Reference for ADC. Pullup and output driver are disabled on PB0 when  
the pin is used as an external reference or Internal Voltage Reference with external capacitor at  
the AREF pin.  
DI: Data Input in USI Three-wire mode. USI Three-wire mode does not override normal port  
functions, so pin must be configure as an input for DI function.  
PCINT0: Pin Change Interrupt source 0.  
Table 12-4 and Table 12-5 relate the alternate functions of Port B to the overriding signals  
shown in Figure 12-5 on page 57.  
61  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 12-4. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB5..PB3  
Signal  
Name  
PB5/RESET/  
ADC0/PCINT5  
PB4/ADC2/XTAL2/  
OC1B/PCINT4  
PB3/ADC3/XTAL1/  
OC1B/PCINT3  
PUOE  
PUOV  
DDOE  
DDOV  
PVOE  
PVOV  
PTOE  
RSTDISBL(1) • DWEN(1)  
0
0
1
0
0
RSTDISBL(1) • DWEN(1)  
0
0
debugWire Transmit  
0
0
0
0
0
OC1B Enable  
OC1B Enable  
OC1B  
0
OC1B  
0
RSTDISBL(1) + (PCINT5 •  
PCIE + ADC0D)  
DIEOE  
PCINT4 • PCIE + ADC2D  
PCINT3 • PCIE + ADC3D  
DIEOV  
DI  
ADC0D  
ADC2D  
ADC3D  
PCINT5 Input  
PCINT4 Input  
ADC2 Input  
PCINT3 Input  
ADC3 Input  
AIO  
RESET Input, ADC0 Input  
Note:  
1. 1 when the Fuse is “0” (Programmed).  
Table 12-5. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB2..PB0  
PB0/MOSI/DI/SDA/AIN0/AR  
EF/OC1A/OC0A/  
PCINT0  
Signal  
Name  
PB2/SCK/ADC1/T0/  
USCK/SCL/INT0/PCINT2  
PB1/MISO/DO/AIN1/  
OC1A/OC0B/PCINT1  
PUOE  
PUOV  
DDOE  
USI_TWO_WIRE  
0
0
0
0
USI_TWO_WIRE  
0
USI_TWO_WIRE  
USI_TWO_WIRE  
(USI_SCL_HOLD +  
PORTB2) • DDRB2  
DDOV  
PVOE  
0
(SDA + PORTD) • DDRB0  
OC0B Enable + OC1A  
Enable +  
USI_THREE_WIRE  
OC0A Enable + OC1A  
Enable + (USI_TWO_WIRE  
• DDRB0)  
USI_TWO_WIRE • DDRB2  
PVOV  
PTOE  
0
OC0B + OC1A + DO  
0
OC0A + OC1A  
0
USI_PTOE  
PCINT2 • PCIE + ADC1D +  
USISIE  
PCINT0 • PCIE + AIN0D +  
USISIE  
DIEOE  
DIEOV  
DI  
PCINT1 • PCIE + AIN1D  
AIN1D  
ADC1D  
AIN0D  
T0/USCK/SCL/INT0/  
PCINT2 Input  
PCINT1 Input  
DI/SDA/PCINT0 Input  
Analog Comparator  
Negative Input  
Analog Comparator Positive  
Input  
AIO  
ADC1 Input  
62  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
12.4 Register Description for I/O-Ports  
12.4.1  
12.4.2  
12.4.3  
PORTB – Port B Data Register  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x18  
PORTB5  
PORTB4  
PORTB3  
PORTB2  
PORTB1  
PORTB0  
PORTB  
DDRB  
PINB  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
DDRB – Port B Data Direction Register  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x17  
DDB5  
R/W  
0
DDB4  
R/W  
0
DDB3  
R/W  
0
DDB2  
R/W  
0
DDB1  
R/W  
0
DDB0  
R/W  
0
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
PINB – Port B Input Pins Address  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x16  
PINB5  
R/W  
N/A  
PINB4  
R/W  
N/A  
PINB3  
R/W  
N/A  
PINB2  
R/W  
N/A  
PINB1  
R/W  
N/A  
PINB0  
R/W  
N/A  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
63  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
13. 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM  
Timer/Counter0 is a general purpose 8-bit Timer/Counter module, with two independent Output  
Compare Units, and with PWM support. It allows accurate program execution timing (event man-  
agement) and wave generation. The main features are:  
Two Independent Output Compare Units  
Double Buffered Output Compare Registers  
Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)  
Glitch Free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)  
Variable PWM Period  
Frequency Generator  
Three Independent Interrupt Sources (TOV0, OCF0A, and OCF0B)  
13.1 Overview  
A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 13-1. For the actual  
placement of I/O pins, refer to ”Pinout ATtiny25/45/85” on page 2. CPU accessible I/O Registers,  
including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit loca-  
tions are listed in the ”8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description” on page 75.  
Figure 13-1. 8-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram  
Count  
TOVn  
(Int.Req.)  
Clear  
Control Logic  
Clock Select  
Direction  
clkTn  
Edge  
Detector  
Tn  
TOP  
BOTTOM  
( From Prescaler )  
Timer/Counter  
TCNTn  
=
= 0  
OCnA  
(Int.Req.)  
Waveform  
Generation  
OCnA  
OCnB  
=
OCRnA  
Fixed  
TOP  
Value  
OCnB  
(Int.Req.)  
Waveform  
Generation  
=
OCRnB  
TCCRnA  
TCCRnB  
13.1.1  
Registers  
The Timer/Counter (TCNT0) and Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are 8-bit  
registers. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req. in the figure) signals are all visible in the  
Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFR). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Inter-  
rupt Mask Register (TIMSK). TIFR and TIMSK are not shown in the figure.  
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on  
the T0 pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter  
uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source  
is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkT0).  
64  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) is compared with the  
Timer/Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gen-  
erator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC0A and  
OC0B). See Section “13.4” on page 66. for details. The Compare Match event will also set the  
Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt  
request.  
13.1.2  
Definitions  
Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “n”  
replaces the Timer/Counter number, in this case 0. A lower case “x” replaces the Output Com-  
pare Unit, in this case Compare Unit A or Compare Unit B. However, when using the register or  
bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT0 for accessing  
Timer/Counter0 counter value and so on.  
The definitions in Table 13-1 are also used extensively throughout the document.  
Table 13-1. Definitions  
BOTTOM  
MAX  
The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes 0x00.  
The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFF (decimal 255).  
TOP  
The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the  
count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value 0xFF  
(MAX) or the value stored in the OCR0A Register. The assignment is depen-  
dent on the mode of operation.  
13.2 Timer/Counter Clock Sources  
The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal or an external clock source. The clock source  
is selected by the Clock Select logic which is controlled by the Clock Select (CS02:0) bits  
located in the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0B). For details on clock sources and pres-  
caler, see ”Timer/Counter Prescaler” on page 82.  
13.3 Counter Unit  
The main part of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable bi-directional counter unit. Figure  
13-2 shows a block diagram of the counter and its surroundings.  
Figure 13-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram  
TOVn  
(Int.Req.)  
DATA BUS  
Clock Select  
count  
clear  
Edge  
Detector  
Tn  
clkTn  
TCNTn  
Control Logic  
direction  
( From Prescaler )  
bottom  
top  
65  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Signal description (internal signals):  
count  
direction  
clear  
Increment or decrement TCNT0 by 1.  
Select between increment and decrement.  
Clear TCNT0 (set all bits to zero).  
clkTn  
Timer/Counter clock, referred to as clkT0 in the following.  
Signalize that TCNT0 has reached maximum value.  
Signalize that TCNT0 has reached minimum value (zero).  
top  
bottom  
Depending of the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented  
at each timer clock (clkT0). clkT0 can be generated from an external or internal clock source,  
selected by the Clock Select bits (CS02:0). When no clock source is selected (CS02:0 = 0) the  
timer is stopped. However, the TCNT0 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of  
whether clkT0 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or  
count operations.  
The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM01 and WGM00 bits located in  
the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0A) and the WGM02 bit located in the Timer/Counter  
Control Register B (TCCR0B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves  
(counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare output OC0A. For more  
details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see ”Modes of Opera-  
tion” on page 69.  
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set according to the mode of operation selected by  
the WGM01:0 bits. TOV0 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt.  
13.4 Output Compare Unit  
The 8-bit comparator continuously compares TCNT0 with the Output Compare Registers  
(OCR0A and OCR0B). Whenever TCNT0 equals OCR0A or OCR0B, the comparator signals a  
match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) at the next timer clock  
cycle. If the corresponding interrupt is enabled, the Output Compare Flag generates an Output  
Compare interrupt. The Output Compare Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is exe-  
cuted. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by software by writing a logical one to its I/O bit  
location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output according to  
operating mode set by the WGM02:0 bits and Compare Output mode (COM0x1:0) bits. The max  
and bottom signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the  
extreme values in some modes of operation (See Section “13.6” on page 69.).  
Figure 13-3 shows a block diagram of the Output Compare unit.  
66  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 13-3. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram  
DATA BUS  
OCRnx  
TCNTn  
= (8-bit Comparator )  
OCFnx (Int.Req.)  
top  
bottom  
Waveform Generator  
OCnx  
FOCn  
WGMn1:0  
COMnX1:0  
The OCR0x Registers are double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation  
(PWM) modes. For the normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the dou-  
ble buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR0x Compare  
Registers to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the  
occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free.  
The OCR0x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering  
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR0x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-  
abled the CPU will access the OCR0x directly.  
13.4.1  
Force Output Compare  
In non-PWM waveform generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by  
writing a one to the Force Output Compare (FOC0x) bit. Forcing Compare Match will not set the  
OCF0x Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OC0x pin will be updated as if a real Compare  
Match had occurred (the COM0x1:0 bits settings define whether the OC0x pin is set, cleared or  
toggled).  
13.4.2  
13.4.3  
Compare Match Blocking by TCNT0 Write  
All CPU write operations to the TCNT0 Register will block any Compare Match that occur in the  
next timer clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCR0x to be initial-  
ized to the same value as TCNT0 without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is  
enabled.  
Using the Output Compare Unit  
Since writing TCNT0 in any mode of operation will block all Compare Matches for one timer  
clock cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNT0 when using the Output Compare  
Unit, independently of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to TCNT0  
equals the OCR0x value, the Compare Match will be missed, resulting in incorrect waveform  
67  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNT0 value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is  
down-counting.  
The setup of the OC0x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the  
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC0x value is to use the Force Output Com-  
pare (FOC0x) strobe bits in Normal mode. The OC0x Registers keep their values even when  
changing between Waveform Generation modes.  
Be aware that the COM0x1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.  
Changing the COM0x1:0 bits will take effect immediately.  
13.5 Compare Match Output Unit  
The Compare Output mode (COM0x1:0) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses  
the COM0x1:0 bits for defining the Output Compare (OC0x) state at the next Compare Match.  
Also, the COM0x1:0 bits control the OC0x pin output source. Figure 13-4 shows a simplified  
schematic of the logic affected by the COM0x1:0 bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O  
pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers  
(DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COM0x1:0 bits are shown. When referring to the  
OC0x state, the reference is for the internal OC0x Register, not the OC0x pin. If a system reset  
occur, the OC0x Register is reset to “0”.  
Figure 13-4. Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic  
COMnx1  
Waveform  
Generator  
COMnx0  
FOCn  
D
Q
1
0
OCn  
Pin  
OCnx  
D
Q
PORT  
D
Q
DDR  
clkI/O  
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC0x) from the Waveform  
Generator if either of the COM0x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC0x pin direction (input or out-  
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction  
Register bit for the OC0x pin (DDR_OC0x) must be set as output before the OC0x value is visi-  
ble on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode.  
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC0x state before the out-  
put is enabled. Note that some COM0x1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of  
operation. See Section “13.8” on page 75.  
68  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
13.5.1  
Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation  
The Waveform Generator uses the COM0x1:0 bits differently in Normal, CTC, and PWM modes.  
For all modes, setting the COM0x1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the  
OC0x Register is to be performed on the next Compare Match. For compare output actions in  
the non-PWM modes refer to Table 13-2 on page 75. For fast PWM mode, refer to Table 13-3 on  
page 75, and for phase correct PWM refer to Table 13-4 on page 76.  
A change of the COM0x1:0 bits state will have effect at the first Compare Match after the bits are  
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the  
FOC0x strobe bits.  
13.6 Modes of Operation  
The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is  
defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGM02:0) and Compare Output  
mode (COM0x1:0) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence,  
while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COM0x1:0 bits control whether the PWM out-  
put generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes  
the COM0x1:0 bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggled at a Compare  
Match (See Section “13.5” on page 68.).  
For detailed timing information refer to Figure 13-8, Figure 13-9, Figure 13-10 and Figure 13-11  
in ”Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams” on page 73.  
13.6.1  
Normal Mode  
The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM02:0 = 0). In this mode the counting  
direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply  
overruns when it passes its maximum 8-bit value (TOP = 0xFF) and then restarts from the bot-  
tom (0x00). In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) will be set in the same  
timer clock cycle as the TCNT0 becomes zero. The TOV0 Flag in this case behaves like a ninth  
bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt  
that automatically clears the TOV0 Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software.  
There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written  
anytime.  
The Output Compare Unit can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Out-  
put Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will  
occupy too much of the CPU time.  
13.6.2  
Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode  
In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGM02:0 = 2), the OCR0A Register is used to  
manipulate the counter resolution. In CTC mode the counter is cleared to zero when the counter  
value (TCNT0) matches the OCR0A. The OCR0A defines the top value for the counter, hence  
also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the Compare Match output frequency. It  
also simplifies the operation of counting external events.  
The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown in Figure 13-5. The counter value (TCNT0)  
increases until a Compare Match occurs between TCNT0 and OCR0A, and then counter  
(TCNT0) is cleared.  
69  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 13-5. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram  
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set  
TCNTn  
OCn  
(Toggle)  
(COMnx1:0 = 1)  
1
2
3
4
Period  
An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the  
OCF0A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating  
the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is run-  
ning with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not  
have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR0A is lower than the current  
value of TCNT0, the counter will miss the Compare Match. The counter will then have to count to  
its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the Compare Match can  
occur.  
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC0A output can be set to toggle its logical  
level on each Compare Match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode  
(COM0A1:0 = 1). The OC0A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for  
the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0  
clk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following  
equation:  
=
f
f
clk_I/O  
f
= -------------------------------------------------  
OCnx  
2 N ⋅ (1 + OCRnx)  
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).  
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV0 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the  
counter counts from MAX to 0x00.  
13.6.3  
Fast PWM Mode  
The fast Pulse Width Modulation or fast PWM mode (WGM02:0 = 3 or 7) provides a high fre-  
quency PWM waveform generation option. The fast PWM differs from the other PWM option by  
its single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP then restarts from BOT-  
TOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR0A when WGM2:0 = 7. In non-  
inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC0x) is cleared on the Compare Match  
between TCNT0 and OCR0x, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare Output mode, the out-  
put is set on Compare Match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope operation, the  
operating frequency of the fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase correct PWM  
mode that use dual-slope operation. This high frequency makes the fast PWM mode well suited  
for power regulation, rectification, and DAC applications. High frequency allows physically small  
sized external components (coils, capacitors), and therefore reduces total system cost.  
In fast PWM mode, the counter is incremented until the counter value matches the TOP value.  
The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast  
70  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
PWM mode is shown in Figure 13-6. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a his-  
togram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and  
inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent Com-  
pare Matches between OCR0x and TCNT0.  
Figure 13-6. Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram  
OCRnx Interrupt Flag Set  
OCRnx Update and  
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set  
TCNTn  
(COMnx1:0 = 2)  
(COMnx1:0 = 3)  
OCn  
OCn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Period  
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the inter-  
rupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value.  
In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC0x pins.  
Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output  
can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A1:0 bits to one allowes  
the AC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is not available  
for the OC0B pin (See Table 13-3 on page 75). The actual OC0x value will only be visible on the  
port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is generated by  
setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between OCR0x and TCNT0, and  
clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes  
from TOP to BOTTOM).  
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:  
f
clk_I/O  
f
= -----------------  
OCnxPWM  
N 256  
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).  
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represents special cases when generating a PWM  
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will  
be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR0A equal to MAX will result  
in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM0A1:0  
bits.)  
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-  
ting OC0x to toggle its logical level on each Compare Match (COM0x1:0 = 1). The waveform  
generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero. This  
71  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
feature is similar to the OC0A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Out-  
put Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.  
13.6.4  
Phase Correct PWM Mode  
The phase correct PWM mode (WGM02:0 = 1 or 5) provides a high resolution phase correct  
PWM waveform generation option. The phase correct PWM mode is based on a dual-slope  
operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM to TOP and then from TOP to BOT-  
TOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 1, and OCR0A when WGM2:0 = 5. In non-  
inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC0x) is cleared on the Compare Match  
between TCNT0 and OCR0x while upcounting, and set on the Compare Match while down-  
counting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation  
has lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. However, due to the sym-  
metric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control  
applications.  
In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches TOP.  
When the counter reaches TOP, it changes the count direction. The TCNT0 value will be equal  
to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown  
on Figure 13-7. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating  
the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The  
small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent Compare Matches between OCR0x  
and TCNT0.  
Figure 13-7. Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram  
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set  
OCRnx Update  
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set  
TCNTn  
(COMnx1:0 = 2)  
OCn  
(COMnx1:0 = 3)  
OCn  
1
2
3
Period  
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The  
Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM  
value.  
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the  
OC0x pins. Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted  
PWM output can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A0 bits to  
72  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
one allows the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is  
not available for the OC0B pin (See Table 13-4 on page 76). The actual OC0x value will only be  
visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is  
generated by clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between OCR0x  
and TCNT0 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at Com-  
pare Match between OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for  
the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation:  
f
clk_I/O  
f
= -----------------  
OCnxPCPWM  
N 510  
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).  
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM  
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the  
output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for  
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values.  
At the very start of period 2 in Figure 13-7 OCn has a transition from high to low even though  
there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guaratee symmetry around BOT-  
TOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match.  
• OCR0A changes its value from MAX, like in Figure 13-7. When the OCR0A value is MAX the  
OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting Compare Match. To ensure  
symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-  
counting Compare Match.  
• The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR0A, and for that reason  
misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the way  
up.  
13.7 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams  
The Timer/Counter is a synchronous design and the timer clock (clkT0) is therefore shown as a  
clock enable signal in the following figures. The figures include information on when Interrupt  
Flags are set. Figure 13-8 contains timing data for basic Timer/Counter operation. The figure  
shows the count sequence close to the MAX value in all modes other than phase correct PWM  
mode.  
Figure 13-8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling  
clkI/O  
clkTn  
(clkI/O/1)  
TCNTn  
TOVn  
MAX - 1  
MAX  
BOTTOM  
BOTTOM + 1  
Figure 13-9 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.  
73  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 13-9. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)  
clkI/O  
clkTn  
(clkI/O/8)  
TCNTn  
TOVn  
MAX - 1  
MAX  
BOTTOM  
BOTTOM + 1  
Figure 13-10 shows the setting of OCF0B in all modes and OCF0A in all modes except CTC  
mode and PWM mode, where OCR0A is TOP.  
Figure 13-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF0x, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)  
clkI/O  
clkTn  
(clkI/O/8)  
TCNTn  
OCRnx  
OCFnx  
OCRnx - 1  
OCRnx  
OCRnx + 1  
OCRnx + 2  
OCRnx Value  
Figure 13-11 shows the setting of OCF0A and the clearing of TCNT0 in CTC mode and fast  
PWM mode where OCR0A is TOP.  
Figure 13-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Pres-  
caler (fclk_I/O/8)  
clkI/O  
clkTn  
(clkI/O/8)  
TCNTn  
(CTC)  
TOP - 1  
TOP  
BOTTOM  
BOTTOM + 1  
OCRnx  
TOP  
OCFnx  
74  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
13.8 8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description  
13.8.1  
TCCR0A – Timer/Counter Control Register A  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
R
0
2
R
0
1
0
0x2A  
COM0A1  
COM0A0  
COM0B1  
COM0B0  
WGM01  
R/W  
0
WGM00  
R/W  
0
TCCR0A  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
• Bits 7:6 – COM01A:0: Compare Match Output A Mode  
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0A) behavior. If one or both of the COM0A1:0  
bits are set, the OC0A output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected  
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0A pin  
must be set in order to enable the output driver.  
When OC0A is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0A1:0 bits depends on the  
WGM02:0 bit setting. Table 13-2 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits  
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).  
Table 13-2. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode  
COM01  
COM00  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.  
Toggle OC0A on Compare Match  
Clear OC0A on Compare Match  
Set OC0A on Compare Match  
Table 13-3 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM01:0 bits are set to fast PWM  
mode.  
Table 13-3. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)  
COM01  
COM00  
Description  
0
0
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.  
WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected.  
WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match.  
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC0A on Compare Match, set OC0A at TOP  
Set OC0A on Compare Match, clear OC0A at TOP  
Note:  
1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-  
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See ”Fast PWM Mode” on page 70  
for more details.  
75  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 13-4 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase cor-  
rect PWM mode.  
Table 13-4. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)  
COM0A1  
COM0A0  
Description  
0
0
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.  
WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected.  
WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match.  
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0A on  
Compare Match when down-counting.  
Set OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0A on  
Compare Match when down-counting.  
Note:  
1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-  
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See ”Phase Correct PWM Mode” on  
page 72 for more details.  
• Bits 5:4 – COM0B1:0: Compare Match Output B Mode  
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0B) behavior. If one or both of the COM0B1:0  
bits are set, the OC0B output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected  
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0B pin  
must be set in order to enable the output driver.  
When OC0B is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0B1:0 bits depends on the  
WGM02:0 bit setting. Table 13-2 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits  
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).  
Table 13-5. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode  
COM01  
COM00  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.  
Toggle OC0B on Compare Match  
Clear OC0B on Compare Match  
Set OC0B on Compare Match  
Table 13-3 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to fast PWM  
mode.  
Table 13-6. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)  
COM01  
COM00  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.  
Reserved  
Clear OC0B on Compare Match, set OC0B at TOP  
Set OC0B on Compare Match, clear OC0B at TOP  
Note:  
1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-  
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See ”Fast PWM Mode” on page 70  
for more details.  
76  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 13-4 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase cor-  
rect PWM mode.  
Table 13-7. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)  
COM0A1  
COM0A0  
Description  
0
0
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.  
Reserved  
Clear OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0B on  
Compare Match when down-counting.  
1
1
0
1
Set OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0B on  
Compare Match when down-counting.  
Note:  
1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-  
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See ”Phase Correct PWM Mode” on  
page 72 for more details.  
• Bits 3, 2 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 1:0 – WGM01:0: Waveform Generation Mode  
Combined with the WGM02 bit found in the TCCR0B Register, these bits control the counting  
sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of wave-  
form generation to be used, see Table 13-8. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter  
unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode, and two types of  
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes (see ”Modes of Operation” on page 69).  
Table 13-8. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description  
Timer/Counter  
Mode of  
Operation  
Update of  
OCRx at  
TOV Flag  
Mode  
WGM2  
WGM1  
WGM0  
TOP  
Set on(1)(2)  
0
0
0
0
Normal  
0xFF  
Immediate  
TOP  
MAX  
PWM, Phase  
Correct  
1
0
0
1
0xFF  
BOTTOM  
2
3
4
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
CTC  
OCRA  
0xFF  
Immediate  
MAX  
MAX  
Fast PWM  
Reserved  
TOP  
PWM, Phase  
Correct  
5
1
0
1
OCRA  
TOP  
BOTTOM  
6
7
1
1
1
1
0
1
Reserved  
Fast PWM  
OCRA  
TOP  
TOP  
Notes: 1. MAX  
= 0xFF  
2. BOTTOM = 0x00  
77  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
13.8.2  
TCCR0B – Timer/Counter Control Register B  
Bit  
7
6
5
R
0
4
R
0
3
2
1
0
0x33  
FOC0A  
FOC0B  
WGM02  
CS02  
CS01  
R/W  
0
CS00  
R/W  
0
TCCR0B  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
W
0
W
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 – FOC0A: Force Output Compare A  
The FOC0A bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.  
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when  
TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0A bit,  
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0A output is  
changed according to its COM0A1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC0A bit is implemented as a  
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0A1:0 bits that determines the effect of the  
forced compare.  
A FOC0A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using  
OCR0A as TOP.  
The FOC0A bit is always read as zero.  
• Bit 6 – FOC0B: Force Output Compare B  
The FOC0B bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.  
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when  
TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0B bit,  
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0B output is  
changed according to its COM0B1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC0B bit is implemented as a  
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0B1:0 bits that determines the effect of the  
forced compare.  
A FOC0B strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using  
OCR0B as TOP.  
The FOC0B bit is always read as zero.  
• Bits 5:4 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 3 – WGM02: Waveform Generation Mode  
See the description in the ”TCCR0A – Timer/Counter Control Register A” on page 75.  
• Bits 2:0 – CS02:0: Clock Select  
The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter.  
Table 13-9. Clock Select Bit Description  
CS02  
CS01  
CS00  
Description  
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped)  
clkI/O/(No prescaling)  
clkI/O/8 (From prescaler)  
78  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 13-9. Clock Select Bit Description (Continued)  
CS02  
CS01  
CS00  
Description  
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
clkI/O/64 (From prescaler)  
clkI/O/256 (From prescaler)  
clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler)  
External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on falling edge.  
External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on rising edge.  
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the  
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the  
counting.  
13.8.3  
TCNT0 – Timer/Counter Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x32  
TCNT0[7:0]  
TCNT0  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the  
Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT0 Register blocks (removes) the Compare  
Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT0) while the counter is running,  
introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT0 and the OCR0x Registers.  
13.8.4  
OCR0A – Output Compare Register A  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x29  
OCR0A[7:0]  
OCR0A  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the  
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to  
generate a waveform output on the OC0A pin.  
13.8.5  
OCR0B – Output Compare Register B  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x28  
OCR0B[7:0]  
OCR0B  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the  
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to  
generate a waveform output on the OC0B pin.  
79  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
13.8.6  
TIMSK – Timer/Counter Interrupt Mask Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
OCIE0B  
R/W  
0
2
TOIE1  
R/W  
0
1
TOIE0  
R/W  
0
0
0x39  
OCIE1A  
OCIE1B  
OCIE0A  
TIMSK  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7:5, 0 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 4 – OCIE0A: Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Match A Interrupt Enable  
When the OCIE0A bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed  
if a Compare Match in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the OCF0A bit is set in the  
Timer/Counter 0 Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR0.  
• Bit 3 – OCIE0B: Timer/Counter Output Compare Match B Interrupt Enable  
When the OCIE0B bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the  
Timer/Counter Compare Match B interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if  
a Compare Match in Timer/Counter occurs, i.e., when the OCF0B bit is set in the Timer/Counter  
Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR0.  
• Bit 1 – TOIE0: Timer/Counter0 Overflow Interrupt Enable  
When the TOIE0 bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the  
Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an  
overflow in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the TOV0 bit is set in the Timer/Counter 0 Inter-  
rupt Flag Register – TIFR0.  
13.8.7  
TIFR – Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register  
Bit  
0x38  
7
6
5
4
3
OCF0B  
R/W  
0
2
TOV1  
R/W  
0
1
TOV0  
R/W  
0
0
OCF1A  
OCF1B  
OCF0A  
TIFR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7, 0 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.  
• Bit 4– OCF0A: Output Compare Flag 0 A  
The OCF0A bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter0 and the data  
in OCR0A – Output Compare Register0. OCF0A is cleared by hardware when executing the cor-  
responding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0A is cleared by writing a logic one to  
the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0A (Timer/Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt Enable),  
and OCF0A are set, the Timer/Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 3 – OCF0B: Output Compare Flag 0 B  
The OCF0B bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter and the data in  
OCR0B – Output Compare Register0 B. OCF0B is cleared by hardware when executing the cor-  
responding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0B is cleared by writing a logic one to  
the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0B (Timer/Counter Compare B Match Interrupt Enable),  
and OCF0B are set, the Timer/Counter Compare Match Interrupt is executed.  
80  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
• Bit 1 – TOV0: Timer/Counter0 Overflow Flag  
The bit TOV0 is set when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter0. TOV0 is cleared by hardware  
when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV0 is cleared by  
writing a logic one to the flag. When the SREG I-bit, TOIE0 (Timer/Counter0 Overflow Interrupt  
Enable), and TOV0 are set, the Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is executed.  
The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGM02:0 bit setting. Refer to Table 13-8, ”Waveform  
Generation Mode Bit Description” on page 77.  
81  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
14. Timer/Counter Prescaler  
The Timer/Counter can be clocked directly by the system clock (by setting the CSn2:0 = 1). This  
provides the fastest operation, with a maximum Timer/Counter clock frequency equal to system  
clock frequency (fCLK_I/O). Alternatively, one of four taps from the prescaler can be used as a  
clock source. The prescaled clock has a frequency of either fCLK_I/O/8, fCLK_I/O/64, fCLK_I/O/256, or  
fCLK_I/O/1024.  
14.0.1  
Prescaler Reset  
The prescaler is free running, i.e., operates independently of the Clock Select logic of the  
Timer/Counter. Since the prescaler is not affected by the Timer/Counter’s clock select, the state  
of the prescaler will have implications for situations where a prescaled clock is used. One exam-  
ple of prescaling artifacts occurs when the timer is enabled and clocked by the prescaler (6 >  
CSn2:0 > 1). The number of system clock cycles from when the timer is enabled to the first count  
occurs can be from 1 to N+1 system clock cycles, where N equals the prescaler divisor (8, 64,  
256, or 1024).  
It is possible to use the Prescaler Reset for synchronizing the Timer/Counter to program  
execution.  
14.0.2  
External Clock Source  
An external clock source applied to the T0 pin can be used as Timer/Counter clock (clkT0). The  
T0 pin is sampled once every system clock cycle by the pin synchronization logic. The synchro-  
nized (sampled) signal is then passed through the edge detector. Figure 14-1 shows a functional  
equivalent block diagram of the T0 synchronization and edge detector logic. The registers are  
clocked at the positive edge of the internal system clock (clkI/O). The latch is transparent in the  
high period of the internal system clock.  
The edge detector generates one clkT0 pulse for each positive (CSn2:0 = 7) or negative (CSn2:0  
= 6) edge it detects.  
Figure 14-1. T0 Pin Sampling  
Tn_sync  
(To Clock  
Tn  
D
Q
D
Q
D
Q
Select Logic)  
LE  
clkI/O  
Synchronization  
Edge Detector  
The synchronization and edge detector logic introduces a delay of 2.5 to 3.5 system clock cycles  
from an edge has been applied to the T0 pin to the counter is updated.  
Enabling and disabling of the clock input must be done when T0 has been stable for at least one  
system clock cycle, otherwise it is a risk that a false Timer/Counter clock pulse is generated.  
Each half period of the external clock applied must be longer than one system clock cycle to  
ensure correct sampling. The external clock must be guaranteed to have less than half the sys-  
tem clock frequency (fExtClk < fclk_I/O/2) given a 50/50% duty cycle. Since the edge detector uses  
sampling, the maximum frequency of an external clock it can detect is half the sampling fre-  
quency (Nyquist sampling theorem). However, due to variation of the system clock frequency  
82  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
and duty cycle caused by Oscillator source (crystal, resonator, and capacitors) tolerances, it is  
recommended that maximum frequency of an external clock source is less than fclk_I/O/2.5.  
An external clock source can not be prescaled.  
Figure 14-2. Prescaler for Timer/Counter0  
clkI/O  
Clear  
PSR10  
T0  
Synchronization  
clkT0  
Note:  
1. The synchronization logic on the input pins (T0) is shown in Figure 14-1.  
14.0.3  
GTCCR – General Timer/Counter Control Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2C  
TSM  
R/W  
0
PWM1B  
COM1B1  
COM1B0  
FOC1B  
FOC1A  
PSR1  
PSR0  
R/W  
0
GTCCR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Synchronization Mode  
Writing the TSM bit to one activates the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode. In this mode, the  
value that is written to the PSR0 bit is kept, hence keeping the Prescaler Reset signal asserted.  
This ensures that the Timer/Counter is halted and can be configured without the risk of advanc-  
ing during configuration. When the TSM bit is written to zero, the PSR0 bit is cleared by  
hardware, and the Timer/Counter start counting.  
• Bit 0 – PSR0: Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter0  
When this bit is one, the Timer/Counter0 prescaler will be Reset. This bit is normally cleared  
immediately by hardware, except if the TSM bit is set.  
83  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
15. 8-bit Timer/Counter1  
The Timer/Counter1 is a general purpose 8-bit Timer/Counter module that has a separate pres-  
caling selection from the separate prescaler.  
Figure 15-1 shows the Timer/Counter1 prescaler that supports two clocking modes, a syncrho-  
nous clocking mode and an asynchronous clocking mode. The synchronous clocking mode uses  
the system clock (CK) as the clock timebase and asynchronous mode uses the fast peripheral  
clock (PCK) as the clock time base. The PCKE bit from the PLLCSR register enables the asyn-  
chronous mode when it is set (‘1’).  
Figure 15-1. Timer/Counter1 Prescaler  
PSR1  
PCKE  
CK  
T1CK  
S
A
14-BIT  
T/C PRESCALER  
PCK 64/32 MHz  
0
CS10  
CS11  
CS12  
CS13  
TIMER/COUNTER1 COUNT ENABLE  
In the asynchronous clocking mode the clock selections are from PCK to PCK/16384 and stop,  
and in the synchronous clocking mode the clock selections are from CK to CK/16384 and stop.  
The clock options are described in Table 15-2 on page 87 and the Timer/Counter1 Control Reg-  
ister, TCCR1. Setting the PSR1 bit in GTCCR register resets the prescaler. The PCKE bit in the  
PLLCSR register enables the asynchronous mode. The frequency of the fast peripheral clock is  
64 MHz (or 32 MHz in Low Speed Mode).  
15.1 Timer/Counter1  
The Timer/Counter1 general operation is described in the asynchronous mode and the opera-  
tion in the synchronous mode is mentioned only if there are differences between these two  
modes. Figure 15-2 shows Timer/Counter 1 synchronization register block diagram and syn-  
chronization delays in between registers. Note that all clock gating details are not shown in the  
figure. The Timer/Counter1 register values go through the internal synchronization registers,  
which cause the input synchronization delay, before affecting the counter operation. The regis-  
ters TCCR1, GTCCR, OCR1A, OCR1B, and OCR1C can be read back right after writing the  
register. The read back values are delayed for the Timer/Counter1 (TCNT1) register and flags  
(OCF1A, OCF1B, and TOV1), because of the input and output synchronization.  
The Timer/Counter1 features a high resolution and a high accuracy usage with the lower pres-  
caling opportunities. It can also support two accurate, high speed, 8-bit Pulse Width Modulators  
using clock speeds up to 64 MHz ( or 32 MHz in Low Speed Mode). In this mode,  
Timer/Counter1 and the output compare registers serve as dual stand-alone PWMs with non-  
overlapping non-inverted and inverted outputs. Refer to page 92 for a detailed description on  
84  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
this function. Similarly, the high prescaling opportunities make this unit useful for lower speed  
functions or exact timing functions with infrequent actions.  
Figure 15-2. Timer/Counter 1 Synchronization Register Block Diagram.  
8-BIT DATABUS  
IO-registers  
OCR1A  
Input synchronization  
registers  
Timer/Counter1  
Output synchronization  
registers  
OCR1A_SI  
OCR1B_SI  
OCR1C_SI  
TCCR1_SI  
GTCCR_SI  
TCNT1  
OCF1A  
OCR1B  
OCR1C  
TCCR1  
GTCCR  
TCNT_SO  
OCF1A_SO  
OCF1B_SO  
TOV1_SO  
TCNT1  
TCNT1  
OCF1A  
OCF1B  
TOV1  
TCNT1_SI  
OCF1A_SI  
OCF1B_SI  
TOV1_SI  
OCF1B  
TOV1  
PCKE  
CK  
S
A
S
A
PCK  
SYNC  
MODE  
1/2 CK Delay  
~1/2 CK Delay  
1 CK Delay  
1/2 CK Delay  
No Delay  
ASYNC  
MODE  
1 PCK Delay  
1/2 PCK - 1 CK Delay  
No Delay  
Timer/Counter1 and the prescaler allow running the CPU from any clock source while the pres-  
caler is operating on the fast 64 MHz (or 32 MHz in Low Speed Mode) PCK clock in the  
asynchronous mode.  
Note that the system clock frequency must be lower than one third of the PCK frequency. The  
synchronization mechanism of the asynchronous Timer/Counter1 needs at least two edges of  
the PCK when the system clock is high. If the frequency of the system clock is too high, it is a  
risk that data or control values are lost.  
The following Figure 15-3 shows the block diagram for Timer/Counter1.  
85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 15-3. Timer/Counter1 Block Diagram  
T/C1 OVER- T/C1 COMPARE T/C1 COMPARE  
FLOW IRQ MATCH A IRQ MATCH B IRQ  
OC1A  
(PB1)  
OC1A  
(PB0)  
OC1B  
(PB4)  
OC1B  
(PB3)  
DEAD TIME GENERATOR  
DEAD TIME GENERATOR  
TIMER INT. MASK  
REGISTER (TIMSK)  
TIMER INT. FLAG  
REGISTER (TIFR)  
T/C CONTROL  
REGISTER 1 (TCCR1)  
GLOBAL T/C CONTROL  
REGISTER (GTCCR)  
TIMER/COUNTER1  
TIMER/COUNTER1  
(TCNT1)  
T/C CLEAR  
CK  
T/C1 CONTROL  
LOGIC  
PCK  
8-BIT COMPARATOR  
8-BIT COMPARATOR  
8-BIT COMPARATOR  
T/C1 OUTPUT  
COMPARE REGISTER  
(OCR1B)  
T/C1 OUTPUT  
COMPARE REGISTER  
(OCR1C)  
T/C1 OUTPUT  
COMPARE REGISTER  
(OCR1A)  
8-BIT DATABUS  
Three status flags (overflow and compare matches) are found in the Timer/Counter Interrupt  
Flag Register - TIFR. Control signals are found in the Timer/Counter Control Registers TCCR1  
and GTCCR. The interrupt enable/disable settings are found in the Timer/Counter Interrupt  
Mask Register - TIMSK.  
The Timer/Counter1 contains three Output Compare Registers, OCR1A, OCR1B, and OCR1C  
as the data source to be compared with the Timer/Counter1 contents. In normal mode the Out-  
put Compare functions are operational with all three output compare registers. OCR1A  
determines action on the OC1A pin (PB1), and it can generate Timer1 OC1A interrupt in normal  
mode and in PWM mode. Likewise, OCR1B determines action on the OC1B pin (PB4) and it can  
generate Timer1 OC1B interrupt in normal mode and in PWM mode. OCR1C holds the  
Timer/Counter maximum value, i.e. the clear on compare match value. In the normal mode an  
overflow interrupt (TOV1) is generated when Timer/Counter1 counts from $FF to $00, while in  
the PWM mode the overflow interrupt is generated when Timer/Counter1 counts either from $FF  
to $00 or from OCR1C to $00. The inverted PWM outputs OC1A and OC1B are not connected in  
normal mode.  
In PWM mode, OCR1A and OCR1B provide the data values against which the Timer Counter  
value is compared. Upon compare match the PWM outputs (OC1A, OC1A, OC1B, OC1B) are  
generated. In PWM mode, the Timer Counter counts up to the value specified in the output com-  
pare register OCR1C and starts again from $00. This feature allows limiting the counter “full”  
value to a specified value, lower than $FF. Together with the many prescaler options, flexible  
PWM frequency selection is provided. Table 15-6 lists clock selection and OCR1C values to  
obtain PWM frequencies from 20 kHz to 250 kHz in 10 kHz steps and from 250 kHz to 500 kHz  
in 50 kHz steps. Higher PWM frequencies can be obtained at the expense of resolution.  
86  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
15.1.1  
TCCR1 – Timer/Counter1 Control Register  
Bit  
7
CTC1  
R/W  
0
6
PWM1A  
R/W  
0
5
COM1A1  
R/W  
4
COM1A0  
R/W  
3
CS13  
R/W  
0
2
CS12  
R/W  
0
1
CS11  
R/W  
0
0
CS10  
R/W  
0
0x30  
TCCR1  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
0
0
• Bit 7- CTC1 : Clear Timer/Counter on Compare Match  
When the CTC1 control bit is set (one), Timer/Counter1 is reset to $00 in the CPU clock cycle  
after a compare match with OCR1C register value. If the control bit is cleared, Timer/Counter1  
continues counting and is unaffected by a compare match.  
• Bit 6- PWM1A: Pulse Width Modulator A Enable  
When set (one) this bit enables PWM mode based on comparator OCR1A in Timer/Counter1  
and the counter value is reset to $00 in the CPU clock cycle after a compare match with OCR1C  
register value.  
• Bits 5,4 - COM1A1, COM1A0: Comparator A Output Mode, Bits 1 and 0  
The COM1A1 and COM1A0 control bits determine any output pin action following a compare  
match with compare register A in Timer/Counter1. Output pin actions affect pin PB1 (OC1A).  
Since this is an alternative function to an I/O port, the corresponding direction control bit must be  
set (one) in order to control an output pin. Note that OC1A is not connected in normal mode.  
Table 15-1. Comparator A Mode Select  
COM1A1  
COM1A0  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Timer/Counter Comparator A disconnected from output pin OC1A.  
Toggle the OC1A output line.  
Clear the OC1A output line.  
Set the OC1A output line  
In PWM mode, these bits have different functions. Refer to Table 15-4 on page 93 for a detailed  
description.  
• Bits 3:0 - CS13, CS12, CS11, CS10: Clock Select Bits 3, 2, 1, and 0  
The Clock Select bits 3, 2, 1, and 0 define the prescaling source of Timer/Counter1.  
Table 15-2. Timer/Counter1 Prescale Select  
Synchronous  
Asynchronous  
Clocking Mode  
CS13  
CS12  
CS11  
CS10  
Clocking Mode  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
T/C1 stopped  
PCK  
T/C1 stopped  
CK  
PCK/2  
CK/2  
PCK/4  
CK/4  
PCK/8  
CK/8  
PCK/16  
PCK/32  
CK/16  
CK/32  
87  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 15-2. Timer/Counter1 Prescale Select (Continued)  
Asynchronous  
Synchronous  
CS13  
CS12  
CS11  
CS10  
Clocking Mode  
Clocking Mode  
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
PCK/64  
CK/64  
PCK/128  
CK/128  
CK/256  
CK/512  
CK/1024  
CK/2048  
CK/4096  
CK/8192  
CK/16384  
PCK/256  
PCK/512  
PCK/1024  
PCK/2048  
PCK/4096  
PCK/8192  
PCK/16384  
The Stop condition provides a Timer Enable/Disable function.  
GTCCR – General Timer/Counter1 Control Register  
15.1.2  
Bit  
0x2C  
7
6
5
4
COM1B0  
R/W  
3
FOC1B  
W
2
FOC1A  
W
1
PSR1  
R/W  
0
0
TSM  
PWM1B  
COM1B1  
PSR0  
R/W  
0
GTCCR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
0
0
0
• Bit 6 - PWM1B: Pulse Width Modulator B Enable  
When set (one) this bit enables PWM mode based on comparator OCR1B in Timer/Counter1  
and the counter value is reset to $00 in the CPU clock cycle after a compare match with OCR1C  
register value.  
• Bits 5,4 - COM1B1, COM1B0: Comparator B Output Mode, Bits 1 and 0  
The COM1B1 and COM1B0 control bits determine any output pin action following a compare  
match with compare register B in Timer/Counter1. Output pin actions affect pin PB4 (OC1B).  
Since this is an alternative function to an I/O port, the corresponding direction control bit must be  
set (one) in order to control an output pin. Note that OC1B is not connected in normal mode.  
Table 15-3. Comparator B Mode Select  
COM1B1  
COM1B0  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Timer/Counter Comparator B disconnected from output pin OC1B.  
Toggle the OC1B output line.  
Clear the OC1B output line.  
Set the OC1B output line  
In PWM mode, these bits have different functions. Refer to Table 15-4 on page 93 for a detailed  
description.  
• Bit 3 - FOC1B: Force Output Compare Match 1B  
Writing a logical one to this bit forces a change in the compare match output pin PB3 (OC1B)  
according to the values already set in COM1B1 and COM1B0. If COM1B1 and COM1B0 written  
88  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
in the same cycle as FOC1B, the new settings will be used. The Force Output Compare bit can  
be used to change the output pin value regardless of the timer value. The automatic action pro-  
grammed in COM1B1 and COM1B0 takes place as if a compare match had occurred, but no  
interrupt is generated. The FOC1B bit always reads as zero. FOC1B is not in use if PWM1B bit  
is set.  
• Bit 2 - FOC1A: Force Output Compare Match 1A  
Writing a logical one to this bit forces a change in the compare match output pin PB1 (OC1A)  
according to the values already set in COM1A1 and COM1A0. If COM1A1 and COM1A0 written  
in the same cycle as FOC1A, the new settings will be used. The Force Output Compare bit can  
be used to change the output pin value regardless of the timer value. The automatic action pro-  
grammed in COM1A1 and COM1A0 takes place as if a compare match had occurred, but no  
interrupt is generated. The FOC1A bit always reads as zero. FOC1A is not in use if PWM1A bit  
is set.  
• Bit 1 - PSR1 : Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter1  
When this bit is set (one), the Timer/Counter prescaler (TCNT1 is unaffected) will be reset. The  
bit will be cleared by hardware after the operation is performed. Writing a zero to this bit will have  
no effect. This bit will always read as zero.  
15.1.3  
TCNT1 – Timer/Counter1  
Bit  
7
MSB  
R/W  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2F  
LSB  
R/W  
0
TCNT1  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
This 8-bit register contains the value of Timer/Counter1.  
Timer/Counter1 is realized as an up counter with read and write access. Due to synchronization  
of the CPU, Timer/Counter1 data written into Timer/Counter1 is delayed by one and half CPU  
clock cycles in synchronous mode and at most one CPU clock cycles for asynchronous mode.  
15.1.4  
OCR1A –Timer/Counter1 Output Compare RegisterA  
Bit  
0x2E  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB  
LSB  
R/W  
0
OCR1A  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The output compare register A is an 8-bit read/write register.  
The Timer/Counter Output Compare Register A contains data to be continuously compared with  
Timer/Counter1. Actions on compare matches are specified in TCCR1. A compare match does  
only occur if Timer/Counter1 counts to the OCR1A value. A software write that sets TCNT1 and  
OCR1A to the same value does not generate a compare match.  
A compare match will set the compare interrupt flag OCF1A after a synchronization delay follow-  
ing the compare event.  
89  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
15.1.5  
OCR1B – Timer/Counter1 Output Compare RegisterB  
Bit  
7
MSB  
R/W  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2B  
LSB  
R/W  
0
OCR1B  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The output compare register B is an 8-bit read/write register.  
The Timer/Counter Output Compare Register B contains data to be continuously compared with  
Timer/Counter1. Actions on compare matches are specified in TCCR1. A compare match does  
only occur if Timer/Counter1 counts to the OCR1B value. A software write that sets TCNT1 and  
OCR1B to the same value does not generate a compare match.  
A compare match will set the compare interrupt flag OCF1B after a synchronization delay follow-  
ing the compare event.  
15.1.6  
OCR1C – Timer/Counter1 Output Compare RegisterC  
Bit  
0x2D  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB  
LSB  
R/W  
1
OCR1C  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
The output compare register C is an 8-bit read/write register.  
The Timer/Counter Output Compare Register C contains data to be continuously compared with  
Timer/Counter1. A compare match does only occur if Timer/Counter1 counts to the OCR1C  
value. A software write that sets TCNT1 and OCR1C to the same value does not generate a  
compare match. If the CTC1 bit in TCCR1 is set, a compare match will clear TCNT1.  
This register has the same function in normal mode and PWM mode.  
15.1.7  
TIMSK – Timer/Counter Interrupt Mask Register  
Bit  
0x39  
7
6
5
4
3
2
TOIE1  
R/W  
0
1
TOIE0  
R/W  
0
0
-
-
OCIE1A  
OCIE1B  
R/W  
0
OCIE0A  
OCIE0B  
TIMSK  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R/W  
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
• Bit 6 - OCIE1A: Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Interrupt Enable  
When the OCIE1A bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Compare MatchA, interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt at vector  
$003 is executed if a compare matchA occurs. The Compare Flag in Timer/Counter1 is set (one)  
in the Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register.  
• Bit 5 - OCIE1B: Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Interrupt Enable  
When the OCIE1B bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Compare MatchB, interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt at vector  
$009 is executed if a compare matchB occurs. The Compare Flag in Timer/Counter1 is set (one)  
in the Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register.  
90  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
• Bit 2 - TOIE1: Timer/Counter1 Overflow Interrupt Enable  
When the TOIE1 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt (at vector $004) is  
executed if an overflow in Timer/Counter1 occurs. The Overflow Flag (Timer1) is set (one) in the  
Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register - TIFR.  
• Bit 0 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
15.1.8  
TIFR – Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register  
Bit  
0x38  
7
6
5
OCF1B  
R/W  
0
4
3
2
TOV1  
R/W  
0
1
TOV0  
R/W  
0
0
-
-
OCF1A  
OCF0A  
OCF0B  
TIFR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R/W  
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
• Bit 6 - OCF1A: Output Compare Flag 1A  
The OCF1A bit is set (one) when compare match occurs between Timer/Counter1 and the data  
value in OCR1A - Output Compare Register 1A. OCF1A is cleared by hardware when executing  
the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF1A is cleared, after synchroniza-  
tion clock cycle, by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE1A, and OCF1A  
are set (one), the Timer/Counter1 A compare match interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 5 - OCF1B: Output Compare Flag 1B  
The OCF1B bit is set (one) when compare match occurs between Timer/Counter1 and the data  
value in OCR1B - Output Compare Register 1A. OCF1B is cleared by hardware when executing  
the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF1B is cleared, after synchroniza-  
tion clock cycle, by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE1B, and OCF1B  
are set (one), the Timer/Counter1 B compare match interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 2 - TOV1: Timer/Counter1 Overflow Flag  
In normal mode (PWM1A=0 and PWM1B=0) the bit TOV1 is set (one) when an overflow occurs  
in Timer/Counter1. The bit TOV1 is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding  
interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV1 is cleared, after synchronization clock cycle, by  
writing a logical one to the flag.  
In PWM mode (either PWM1A=1 or PWM1B=1) the bit TOV1 is set (one) when compare match  
occurs between Timer/Counter1 and data value in OCR1C - Output Compare Register 1C.  
When the SREG I-bit, and TOIE1 (Timer/Counter1 Overflow Interrupt Enable), and TOV1 are set  
(one), the Timer/Counter1 Overflow interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 0 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
91  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
15.1.9  
PLLCSR – PLL Control and Status Register  
Bit  
7
LSM  
R
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKE  
R/W  
0
1
0
0x27  
PLLE  
R/W  
0/1  
PLOCK  
PLLCSR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
• Bit 7 - LSM: Low Speed Mode  
The high speed mode is enabled as default and the fast peripheral clock is 64 MHz, but the low  
speed mode can be set by writing the LSM bit to one. Then the fast peripheral clock is scaled  
down to 32 MHz. The low speed mode must be set, if the supply voltage is below 2.7 volts,  
because the Timer/Counter1 is not running fast enough on low voltage levels. It is highly recom-  
mended that Timer/Counter1 is stopped whenever the LSM bit is changed.  
• Bit 6:3- Res : Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always read as zero.  
• Bit 2- PCKE: PCK Enable  
The PCKE bit change the Timer/Counter1 clock source. When it is set, the asynchronous clock  
mode is enabled and fast 64 MHz (or 32 MHz in Low Speed Mode) PCK clock is used as  
Timer/Counter1 clock source. If this bit is cleared, the synchronous clock mode is enabled, and  
system clock CK is used as Timer/Counter1 clock source. This bit can be set only if PLLE bit is  
set. It is safe to set this bit only when the PLL is locked i.e the PLOCK bit is 1. The bit PCKE can  
only be set, if the PLL has been enabled earlier.  
• Bit 1 - PLLE: PLL Enable  
When the PLLE is set, the PLL is started and if needed internal RC-oscillator is started as a PLL  
reference clock. If PLL is selected as a system clock source the value for this bit is always 1.  
• Bit 0 - PLOCK: PLL Lock Detector  
When the PLOCK bit is set, the PLL is locked to the reference clock, and it is safe to enable PCK  
for Timer/Counter1. After the PLL is enabled, it takes about 100 micro seconds for the PLL to  
lock.  
15.1.10 Timer/Counter1 Initialization for Asynchronous Mode  
To change Timer/Counter1 to the asynchronous mode, first enable PLL, and poll the PLOCK bit  
until it is set, and then set the PCKE bit.  
15.1.11 Timer/Counter1 in PWM Mode  
When the PWM mode is selected, Timer/Counter1 and the Output Compare Register C -  
OCR1C form a dual 8-bit, free-running and glitch-free PWM generator with outputs on the  
PB1(OC1A) and PB4(OC1B) pins and inverted outputs on pins PB0(OC1A) and PB3(OC1B). As  
default non-overlapping times for complementary output pairs are zero, but they can be inserted  
using a Dead Time Generator (see description on page 100).  
92  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 15-4. The PWM Output Pair  
PWM1x  
PWM1x  
t non-overlap  
t non-overlap  
=0  
=0  
x = A or B  
When the counter value match the contents of OCR1A or OCR1B, the OC1A and OC1B outputs  
are set or cleared according to the COM1A1/COM1A0 or COM1B1/COM1B0 bits in the  
Timer/Counter1 Control Register A - TCCR1, as shown in Table 15-4.  
Timer/Counter1 acts as an up-counter, counting from $00 up to the value specified in the output  
compare register OCR1C, and starting from $00 up again. A compare match with OC1C will set  
an overflow interrupt flag (TOV1) after a synchronization delay following the compare event.  
Table 15-4. Compare Mode Select in PWM Mode  
COM11  
COM10  
Effect on Output Compare Pins  
OC1x not connected.  
OC1x not connected.  
0
0
OC1x cleared on compare match. Set whenTCNT1 = $01.  
OC1x set on compare match. Cleared when TCNT1 = $00.  
0
1
1
1
0
1
OC1x cleared on compare match. Set when TCNT1 = $01.  
OC1x not connected.  
OC1x Set on compare match. Cleared when TCNT1= $01.  
OC1x not connected.  
Note that in PWM mode, writing to the Output Compare Registers OCR1A or OCR1B, the data  
value is first transferred to a temporary location. The value is latched into OCR1A or OCR1B  
when the Timer/Counter reaches OCR1C. This prevents the occurrence of odd-length PWM  
pulses (glitches) in the event of an unsynchronized OCR1A or OCR1B. See Figure 15-5 for an  
example.  
93  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 15-5. Effects of Unsynchronized OCR Latching  
Compare Value changes  
Counter Value  
Compare Value  
PWM Output OC1x  
Synchronized OC1x Latch  
Compare Value changes  
Counter Value  
Compare Value  
PWM Output OC1x  
Glitch  
Unsynchronized OC1x Latch  
During the time between the write and the latch operation, a read from OCR1A or OCR1B will  
read the contents of the temporary location. This means that the most recently written value  
always will read out of OCR1A or OCR1B.  
When OCR1A or OCR1B contain $00 or the top value, as specified in OCR1C register, the out-  
put PB1(OC1A) or PB3(OC1B) is held low or high according to the settings of  
COM1A1/COM1A0. This is shown in Table 15-5.  
Table 15-5. PWM Outputs OCR1x = $00 or OCR1C, x = A or B  
COM1x1  
COM1x0  
OCR1x  
$00  
Output OC1x  
Output OC1x  
H
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
L
H
L
OCR1C  
$00  
L
Not connected.  
Not connected.  
Not connected.  
Not connected.  
OCR1C  
$00  
H
H
L
OCR1C  
In PWM mode, the Timer Overflow Flag - TOV1 is set when the TCNT1 counts to the OCR1C  
value and the TCNT1 is reset to $00. The Timer Overflow Interrupt1 is executed when TOV1 is  
set provided that Timer Overflow Interrupt and global interrupts are enabled. This also applies to  
the Timer Output Compare flags and interrupts.  
The frequency of the PWM will be Timer Clock 1 Frequency divided by (OCR1C value + 1). See  
the following equation:  
f
TCK1  
f
= -----------------------------------  
PWM  
(OCR1C + 1)  
Resolution shows how many bit is required to express the value in the OCR1C register. It is cal-  
culated by following equation  
ResolutionPWM = log2(OCR1C + 1).  
94  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 15-6. Timer/Counter1 Clock Prescale Select in the Asynchronous Mode  
PWM Frequency  
20 kHz  
Clock Selection  
PCK/16  
PCK/16  
PCK/8  
PCK/8  
PCK/8  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK  
CS13:CS10  
0101  
0101  
0100  
0100  
0100  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
OCR1C  
199  
132  
199  
159  
132  
228  
199  
177  
159  
144  
132  
245  
228  
212  
199  
187  
177  
167  
159  
255  
212  
182  
159  
141  
127  
RESOLUTION  
7.6  
30 kHz  
7.1  
40 kHz  
7.6  
50 kHz  
7.3  
60 kHz  
7.1  
70 kHz  
7.8  
80 kHz  
7.6  
90 kHz  
7.5  
100 kHz  
110 kHz  
120 kHz  
130 kHz  
140 kHz  
150 kHz  
160 kHz  
170 kHz  
180 kHz  
190 kHz  
200 kHz  
250 kHz  
300 kHz  
350 kHz  
400 kHz  
450 kHz  
500 kHz  
7.3  
7.2  
7.1  
7.9  
7.8  
7.7  
7.6  
7.6  
7.5  
7.4  
7.3  
8.0  
PCK  
7.7  
PCK  
7.5  
PCK  
7.3  
PCK  
7.1  
PCK  
7.0  
95  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
16. 8-bit Timer/Counter1 in ATtiny15 Mode  
The ATtiny15 compatibility mode is selected by writing the code “0011” to the CKSEL fuses (if  
any other code is written, the Timer/Counter1 is working in normal mode). When selected the  
ATtiny15 compatibility mode provides an ATtiny15 backward compatible prescaler and  
Timer/Counter. Furthermore, the clocking system has same clock frequencies as in ATtiny15.  
16.1 Timer/Counter1 Prescaler  
Figure 16-1 shows an ATtiny15 compatible prescaler. It has two prescaler units, the 3-bit pres-  
caler for the the system clock (CK) and the 10-bit prescaler for the fast peripheral clock (PCK).  
The clocking system of the Timer/Counter1 is always synchronous in the ATtiny15 compatibility  
mode, because the same RC Oscillator is used as a PLL clock source (generates the input clock  
for the prescaler) and the AVR core.  
Figure 16-1. Timer/Counter1 Prescaler  
PSR1  
CK (1.6 MHz)  
CLEAR  
CLEAR  
PCK (25.6 MHz)  
10-BIT T/C PRESCALER  
3-BIT T/C PRESCALER  
0
CS10  
CS11  
CS12  
CS13  
TIMER/COUNTER1 COUNT ENABLE  
The same clock selections as in ATtiny15 can be chosen for Timer/Counter1 from the output  
multiplexer, because the frequency of the fast peripheral clock is 25.6 MHz and the prescaler is  
similar in the ATtiny15 compatibility mode. The clock selections are PCK, PCK/2, PCK/4, PCK/8,  
CK, CK/2, CK/4, CK/8, CK/16, CK/32, CK/64, CK/128, CK/256, CK/512, CK/1024 and stop.  
16.2 Timer/Counter1  
Figure 16-2 shows Timer/Counter 1 synchronization register block diagram and synchronization  
delays in between registers. Note that all clock gating details are not shown in the figure. The  
Timer/Counter1 register values go through the internal synchronization registers, which cause  
the input synchronization delay, before affecting the counter operation. The registers TCCR1,  
GTCCR, OCR1A and OCR1C can be read back right after writing the register. The read back  
values are delayed for the Timer/Counter1 (TCNT1) register and flags (OCF1A and TOV1),  
because of the input and output synchronization.  
The Timer/Counter1 features a high resolution and a high accuracy usage with the lower pres-  
caling opportunities. It can also support an accurate, high speed, 8-bit Pulse Width Modulator  
(PWM) using clock speeds up to 25.6 MHz. In this mode, Timer/Counter1 and the Output Com-  
pare Registers serve as a stand-alone PWM. Refer to page 103 for a detailed description on this  
function. Similarly, the high prescaling opportunities make this unit useful for lower speed func-  
tions or exact timing functions with infrequent actions.  
96  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 16-2. Timer/Counter 1 Synchronization Register Block Diagram.  
8-BIT DATABUS  
IO-registers  
OCR1A  
Input synchronization  
registers  
Timer/Counter1  
Output synchronization  
registers  
OCR1A_SI  
TCNT1  
OCR1C  
OCR1C_SI  
TCNT_SO  
TCCR1  
GTCCR  
TCCR1_SI  
GTCCR_SI  
TCNT1  
TCNT1  
TCNT1_SI  
OCF1A  
TOV1  
OCF1A_SO  
TOV1_SO  
OCF1A  
TOV1  
OCF1A_SI  
TOV1_SI  
PCKE  
CK  
S
A
S
A
PCK  
SYNC  
MODE  
1/2 CK Delay  
~1/2 CK Delay  
1CK Delay  
1/2 CK Delay  
No Delay  
No Delay  
ASYNC  
MODE  
1PCK Delay  
1/2PCK - 1CK Delay  
Timer/Counter1 and the prescaler allow running the CPU from any clock source while the pres-  
caler is operating on the fast 25.6 MHz PCK clock in the asynchronous mode.  
The following Figure 16-3 shows the block diagram for Timer/Counter1.  
97  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 16-3. Timer/Counter1 Block Diagram  
T/C1 OVER- T/C1 COMPARE  
FLOW IRQ MATCH A IRQ  
OC1A  
(PB1)  
TIMER INT. MASK  
REGISTER (TIMSK)  
TIMER INT. FLAG  
REGISTER (TIFR)  
T/C CONTROL  
REGISTER 1 (TCCR1)  
GLOBAL T/C CONTROL  
REGISTER 2 (GTCCR)  
TIMER/COUNTER1  
TIMER/COUNTER1  
(TCNT1)  
T/C CLEAR  
CK  
T/C1 CONTROL  
LOGIC  
PCK  
8-BIT COMPARATOR  
8-BIT COMPARATOR  
T/C1 OUTPUT  
COMPARE REGISTER  
(OCR1C)  
T/C1 OUTPUT  
COMPARE REGISTER  
(OCR1A)  
8-BIT DATABUS  
Two status flags (overflow and compare match) are found in the Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag  
Register - TIFR. Control signals are found in the Timer/Counter Control Registers TCCR1 and  
GTCCR. The interrupt enable/disable settings are found in the Timer/Counter Interrupt Mask  
Register - TIMSK.  
The Timer/Counter1 contains two Output Compare Registers, OCR1A and OCR1C as the data  
source to be compared with the Timer/Counter1 contents. In normal mode the Output Compare  
functions are operational with OCR1A only. OCR1A determines action on the OC1A pin (PB1),  
and it can generate Timer1 OC1A interrupt in normal mode and in PWM mode. OCR1C holds  
the Timer/Counter maximum value, i.e. the clear on compare match value. In the normal mode  
an overflow interrupt (TOV1) is generated when Timer/Counter1 counts from $FF to $00, while  
in the PWM mode the overflow interrupt is generated when the Timer/Counter1 counts either  
from $FF to $00 or from OCR1C to $00.  
In PWM mode, OCR1A provides the data values against which the Timer Counter value is com-  
pared. Upon compare match the PWM outputs (OC1A) is generated. In PWM mode, the Timer  
Counter counts up to the value specified in the output compare register OCR1C and starts again  
from $00. This feature allows limiting the counter “full” value to a specified value, lower than $FF.  
Together with the many prescaler options, flexible PWM frequency selection is provided. Table  
15-6 lists clock selection and OCR1C values to obtain PWM frequencies from 20 kHz to 250 kHz  
in 10 kHz steps and from 250 kHz to 500 kHz in 50 kHz steps. Higher PWM frequencies can be  
obtained at the expense of resolution.  
98  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
16.2.1  
TCCR1 – Timer/Counter1 Control Register  
Bit  
7
CTC1  
R/W  
0
6
PWM1A  
R/W  
0
5
COM1A1  
R/W  
4
COM1A0  
R/W  
3
CS13  
R/W  
0
2
CS12  
R/W  
0
1
CS11  
R/W  
0
0
CS10  
R/W  
0
0x30  
TCCR1A  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
0
0
• Bit 7- CTC1 : Clear Timer/Counter on Compare Match  
When the CTC1 control bit is set (one), Timer/Counter1 is reset to $00 in the CPU clock cycle  
after a compare match with OCR1A register. If the control bit is cleared, Timer/Counter1 contin-  
ues counting and is unaffected by a compare match.  
• Bit 6 - PWM1A: Pulse Width Modulator A Enable  
When set (one) this bit enables PWM mode based on comparator OCR1A in Timer/Counter1  
and the counter value is reset to $00 in the CPU clock cycle after a compare match with OCR1C  
register value.  
• Bits 5,4 - COM1A1, COM1A0: Comparator A Output Mode, Bits 1 and 0  
The COM1A1 and COM1A0 control bits determine any output pin action following a compare  
match with compare register A in Timer/Counter1. Output pin actions affect pin PB1 (OC1A).  
Since this is an alternative function to an I/O port, the corresponding direction control bit must be  
set (one) in order to control an output pin.  
Table 16-1. Comparator A Mode Select  
COM1A1  
COM1A0  
Description  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Timer/Counter Comparator A disconnected from output pin OC1A.  
Toggle the OC1A output line.  
Clear the OC1A output line.  
Set the OC1A output line  
In PWM mode, these bits have different functions. Refer to Table 16-3 on page 103 for a  
detailed description.  
• Bits 3:0 - CS13, CS12, CS11, CS10: Clock Select Bits 3, 2, 1, and 0  
The Clock Select bits 3, 2, 1, and 0 define the prescaling source of Timer/Counter1.  
Table 16-2. Timer/Counter1 Prescale Select  
CS13  
CS12  
CS11  
CS10  
T/C1 Clock  
T/C1 stopped  
PCK  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
PCK/2  
PCK/4  
PCK/8  
CK  
CK/2  
CK/4  
99  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 16-2. Timer/Counter1 Prescale Select (Continued)  
CS13  
CS12  
CS11  
CS10  
T/C1 Clock  
CK/8  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
CK/16  
CK/32  
CK/64  
CK/128  
CK/256  
CK/512  
CK/1024  
The Stop condition provides a Timer Enable/Disable function.  
GTCCR – General Timer/Counter1 Control Register  
16.2.2  
Bit  
0x2C  
7
6
5
4
COM1B0  
R/W  
3
FOC1B  
W
2
FOC1A  
W
1
0
TSM  
PWM1B  
COM1B1  
PSR1  
R/W  
0
PSR0  
R/W  
0
GTCCR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
0
0
0
• Bit 2- FOC1A: Force Output Compare Match 1A  
Writing a logical one to this bit forces a change in the compare match output pin PB1 (OC1A)  
according to the values already set in COM1A1 and COM1A0. If COM1A1 and COM1A0 written  
in the same cycle as FOC1A, the new settings will be used. The Force Output Compare bit can  
be used to change the output pin value regardless of the timer value. The automatic action pro-  
grammed in COM1A1 and COM1A0 takes place as if a compare match had occurred, but no  
interrupt is generated. The FOC1A bit always reads as zero. FOC1A is not in use if PWM1A bit  
is set.  
• Bit 1- PSR1 : Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter1  
When this bit is set (one), the Timer/Counter prescaler (TCNT1 is unaffected) will be reset. The  
bit will be cleared by hardware after the operation is performed. Writing a zero to this bit will have  
no effect. This bit will always read as zero.  
16.2.3  
TCNT1 – Timer/Counter1  
Bit  
7
MSB  
R/W  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2F  
LSB  
R/W  
0
TCNT1  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
This 8-bit register contains the value of Timer/Counter1.  
Timer/Counter1 is realized as an up counter with read and write access. Due to synchronization  
of the CPU, Timer/Counter1 data written into Timer/Counter1 is delayed by one CPU clock cycle  
in synchronous mode and at most two CPU clock cycles for asynchronous mode.  
100  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
16.2.4  
OCR1A – Timer/Counter1 Output Compare RegisterA  
Bit  
7
MSB  
R/W  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2E  
LSB  
R/W  
0
OCR1A  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The output compare register A is an 8-bit read/write register.  
The Timer/Counter Output Compare Register A contains data to be continuously compared with  
Timer/Counter1. Actions on compare matches are specified in TCCR1. A compare match does  
only occur if Timer/Counter1 counts to the OCR1A value. A software write that sets TCNT1 and  
OCR1A to the same value does not generate a compare match.  
A compare match will set the compare interrupt flag OCF1A after a synchronization delay follow-  
ing the compare event.  
16.2.5  
OCR1C – Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Register C  
Bit  
0x2D  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB  
LSB  
R/W  
1
OCR1C  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
R/W  
1
The Output Compare Register B - OCR1B from ATtiny15 is replaced with the output compare  
register C - OCR1C that is an 8-bit read/write register. This register has the same function as the  
Output Compare Register B in ATtiny15.  
The Timer/Counter Output Compare Register C contains data to be continuously compared with  
Timer/Counter1. A compare match does only occur if Timer/Counter1 counts to the OCR1C  
value. A software write that sets TCNT1 and OCR1C to the same value does not generate a  
compare match. If the CTC1 bit in TCCR1 is set, a compare match will clear TCNT1.  
16.2.6  
TIMSK – Timer/Counter Interrupt Mask Register  
Bit  
0x39  
7
6
5
4
3
2
TOIE1  
R/W  
0
1
TOIE0  
R/W  
0
0
-
-
OCIE1A  
OCIE1B  
R/W  
0
OCIE0A  
OCIE0B  
TIMSK  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R/W  
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
• Bit 6 - OCIE1A: Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Interrupt Enable  
When the OCIE1A bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Compare MatchA, interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt at vector  
$003 is executed if a compare matchA occurs. The Compare Flag in Timer/Counter1 is set (one)  
in the Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register.  
• Bit 2 - TOIE1: Timer/Counter1 Overflow Interrupt Enable  
When the TOIE1 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt (at vector $004) is  
executed if an overflow in Timer/Counter1 occurs. The Overflow Flag (Timer1) is set (one) in the  
Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register - TIFR.  
101  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
• Bit 0 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
16.2.7  
TIFR – Timer/Counter Interrupt Flag Register  
Bit  
0x38  
7
6
5
OCF1B  
R/W  
0
4
3
2
TOV1  
R/W  
0
1
TOV0  
R/W  
0
0
-
-
OCF1A  
OCF0A  
OCF0B  
TIFR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R/W  
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
• Bit 6 - OCF1A: Output Compare Flag 1A  
The OCF1A bit is set (one) when compare match occurs between Timer/Counter1 and the data  
value in OCR1A - Output Compare Register 1A. OCF1A is cleared by hardware when executing  
the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF1A is cleared, after synchroniza-  
tion clock cycle, by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE1A, and OCF1A  
are set (one), the Timer/Counter1 A compare match interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 2 - TOV1: Timer/Counter1 Overflow Flag  
The bit TOV1 is set (one) when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter1. TOV1 is cleared by hard-  
ware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV1 is  
cleared, after synchronization clock cycle, by writing a logical one to the flag. When the SREG I-  
bit, and TOIE1 (Timer/Counter1 Overflow Interrupt Enable), and TOV1 are set (one), the  
Timer/Counter1 Overflow interrupt is executed.  
• Bit 0 - Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always reads as zero.  
16.2.8  
PLLCSR – PLL Control and Status Register  
Bit  
0x27  
7
6
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
PCKE  
R/W  
0
1
0
LSM  
-
PLLE  
R/W  
0/1  
PLOCK  
PLLCSR  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7:3- Res : Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always read as zero.  
• Bit 2 - PCKE: PCK Enable  
The bit PCKE is always set in the ATtiny15 compatibility mode.  
• Bit 1 - PLLE: PLL Enable  
The PLL is always enabled in the ATtiny15 compatibility mode.  
• Bit 0 - PLOCK: PLL Lock Detector  
When the PLOCK bit is set, the PLL is locked to the reference clock.  
102  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
16.2.9  
Timer/Counter1 in PWM Mode  
When the PWM mode is selected, Timer/Counter1 and the Output Compare Register A -  
OCR1A form an 8-bit, free-running and glitch-free PWM generator with output on the  
PB1(OC1A).  
When the counter value match the content of OCR1A, the OC1A and output is set or cleared  
according to the COM1A1/COM1A0 bits in the Timer/Counter1 Control Register A - TCCR1, as  
shown in Table 16-3.  
Timer/Counter1 acts as an up-counter, counting from $00 up to the value specified in the output  
compare register OCR1C, and starting from $00 up again. A compare match with OCR1C will  
set an overflow interrupt flag (TOV1) after a synchronization delay following the compare event.  
Table 16-3. Compare Mode Select in PWM Mode  
COM1A1  
COM1A0  
Effect on Output Compare Pin  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
OC1A not connected.  
OC1A not connected.  
OC1A cleared on compare match. Set when TCNT1 = $01.  
OC1A set on compare match. Cleared when TCNT1 = $01.  
Note that in PWM mode, writing to the Output Compare Register OCR1A, the data value is first  
transferred to a temporary location. The value is latched into OCR1A when the Timer/Counter  
reaches OCR1C. This prevents the occurrence of odd-length PWM pulses (glitches) in the event  
of an unsynchronized OCR1A. See Figure 16-4 for an e xample.  
Figure 16-4. Effects of Unsynchronized OCR Latching  
Compare Value changes  
Counter Value  
Compare Value  
PWM Output OC1A  
Synchronized OC1A Latch  
Compare Value changes  
Counter Value  
Compare Value  
PWM Output OC1A  
Glitch  
Unsynchronized OC1A Latch  
During the time between the write and the latch operation, a read from OCR1A will read the con-  
tents of the temporary location. This means that the most recently written value always will read  
out of OCR1A.  
103  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
When OCR1A contains $00 or the top value, as specified in OCR1C register, the output  
PB1(OC1A) is held low or high according to the settings of COM1A1/COM1A0. This is shown in  
Table 16-4.  
Table 16-4. PWM Outputs OCR1A = $00 or OCR1C  
COM1A1  
COM1A0  
OCR1A  
$00  
Output OC1A  
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
L
H
L
OCR1C  
$00  
OCR1C  
$00  
H
H
L
OCR1C  
In PWM mode, the Timer Overflow Flag - TOV1 is set when the TCNT1 counts to the OCR1C  
value and the TCNT1 is reset to $00. The Timer Overflow Interrupt1 is executed when TOV1 is  
set provided that Timer Overflow Interrupt and global interrupts are enabled. This also applies to  
the Timer Output Compare flags and interrupts.  
The frequency of the PWM will be Timer Clock 1 Frequency divided by (OCR1C value + 1). See  
the following equation:  
f
TCK1  
f
= -----------------------------------  
PWM  
(OCR1C + 1)  
Resolution shows how many bit is required to express the value in the OCR1C register. It is cal-  
culated by following equation  
ResolutionPWM = log2(OCR1C + 1).  
104  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 16-5. Timer/Counter1 Clock Prescale Select in the Asynchronous Mode  
PWM Frequency  
20 kHz  
Clock Selection  
PCK/16  
PCK/16  
PCK/8  
PCK/8  
PCK/8  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/4  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK/2  
PCK  
CS13..CS10  
0101  
0101  
0100  
0100  
0100  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0011  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0010  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
0001  
OCR1C  
199  
132  
199  
159  
132  
228  
199  
177  
159  
144  
132  
245  
228  
212  
199  
187  
177  
167  
159  
255  
212  
182  
159  
141  
127  
RESOLUTION  
7.6  
30 kHz  
7.1  
40 kHz  
7.6  
50 kHz  
7.3  
60 kHz  
7.1  
70 kHz  
7.8  
80 kHz  
7.6  
90 kHz  
7.5  
100 kHz  
110 kHz  
120 kHz  
130 kHz  
140 kHz  
150 kHz  
160 kHz  
170 kHz  
180 kHz  
190 kHz  
200 kHz  
250 kHz  
300 kHz  
350 kHz  
400 kHz  
450 kHz  
500 kHz  
7.3  
7.2  
7.1  
7.9  
7.8  
7.7  
7.6  
7.6  
7.5  
7.4  
7.3  
8.0  
PCK  
7.7  
PCK  
7.5  
PCK  
7.3  
PCK  
7.1  
PCK  
7.0  
105  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
17. Dead Time Generator  
The Dead Time Generator is provided for the Timer/Counter1 PWM output pairs to allow driving  
external power control switches safely. The Dead Time Generator is a separate block that can  
be connected to Timer/Counter1 and it is used to insert dead times (non-overlapping times) for  
the Timer/Counter1 complementary output pairs (OC1A-OC1A and OC1B-OC1B). The sharing  
of tasks is as follows: the timer/counter generates the PWM output and the Dead Time Genera-  
tor generates the non-overlapping PWM output pair from the timer/counter PWM signal. Two  
Dead Time Generators are provided, one for each PWM output. The non-overlap time is adjust-  
able and the PWM output and it’s complementary output are adjusted separately, and  
independently for both PWM outputs.  
Figure 17-1. Timer/Counter1 & Dead Time Generators  
PCKE  
TIMER/COUNTER1  
T15M  
CK  
PWM GENERATOR  
PWM1A  
PWM1B  
PCK  
DT1AH  
DT1AL  
DT1BH  
DT1BL  
DEAD TIME GENERATOR  
DEAD TIME GENERATOR  
OC1A  
OC1B  
OC1B  
OC1A  
The dead time generation is based on the 4-bit down counters that count the dead time, as  
shown in Figure 46. There is a dedicated prescaler in front of the Dead Time Generator that can  
divide the Timer/Counter1 clock (PCK or CK) by 1, 2, 4 or 8. This provides for large range of  
dead times that can be generated. The prescaler is controlled by two control bits DTPS11..10  
from the I/O register at address 0x23. The block has also a rising and falling edge detector that  
is used to start the dead time counting period. Depending on the edge, one of the transitions on  
the rising edges, OC1x or OC1x is delayed until the counter has counted to zero. The compara-  
tor is used to compare the counter with zero and stop the dead time insertion when zero has  
been reached. The counter is loaded with a 4-bit DT1xH or DT1xL value from DT1x I/O register,  
depending on the edge of the PWM generator output when the dead time insertion is started.  
Figure 17-2. Dead Time Generator  
DTPS11..10  
T/C1 CLOCK  
COMPARATOR  
4-BIT COUNTER  
OC1x  
OC1x  
DEAD TIME  
PRESCALER  
CLOCK CONTROL  
DT1x  
I/O REGISTER  
PWM1x  
The length of the counting period is user adjustable by selecting the dead time prescaler setting  
in 0x23 register, and selecting then the dead time value in I/O register DT1x. The DT1x register  
106  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
consists of two 4-bit fields, DT1xH and DT1xL that control the dead time periods of the PWM  
output and its’ complementary output separately. Thus the rising edge of OC1x and OC1x can  
have different dead time periods. The dead time is adjusted as the number of prescaled dead  
time generator clock cycles.  
Figure 17-3. The Complementary Output Pair  
PWM1x  
OC1x  
OC1x  
x = A or B  
t non-overlap / rising edge t non-overlap / falling edge  
17.0.1  
DTPS1 – Timer/Counter1 Dead Time Prescaler Register 1  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DTPS11  
R/W  
0
0
DTPS10  
R/W  
0
0x23  
DTPS1  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
The dead time prescaler register, DTPS1 is a 2-bit read/write register.  
The dedicated Dead Time prescaler in front of the Dead Time Generator can divide the  
Timer/Counter1 clock (PCK or CK) by 1, 2, 4 or 8 providing a large range of dead times that can  
be generated. The Dead Time prescaler is controlled by two bits DTPS11..10 from the Dead  
Time Prescaler register. These bits define the division factor of the Dead Time prescaler. The  
division factors are given in table 46..  
Table 17-1. Division factors of the Dead Time prescaler  
DTPS11  
DTPS10  
Prescaler divides the T/C1 clock by  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1x (no division)  
2x  
4x  
8x  
17.0.2  
DT1A – Timer/Counter1 Dead Time A  
Bit  
7
DT1AH3  
R/W  
6
DT1AH2  
R/W  
5
DT1AH1  
R/W  
4
DT1AH0  
R/W  
3
DT1AL3  
R/W  
0
2
DT1AL2  
R/W  
0
1
DT1AL1  
R/W  
0
0
DT1AL0  
R/W  
0
0x25  
DT1A  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
0
0
0
0
The dead time value register A is an 8-bit read/write register.  
107  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
The dead time delay of is adjusted by the dead time value register, DT1A. The register consists  
of two fields, DT1AH3..0 and DT1AL3..0, one for each complementary output. Therefore a differ-  
ent dead time delay can be adjusted for the rising edge of OC1A and the rising edge of OC1A.  
• Bits 7:4- DT1AH3:DT1AH0: Dead Time Value for OC1A Output  
The dead time value for the OC1A output. The dead time delay is set as a number of the pres-  
caled timer/counter clocks. The minimum dead time is zero and the maximum dead time is the  
prescaled time/counter clock period multiplied by 15.  
• Bits 3:0- DT1AL3:DT1AL0: Dead Time Value for OC1A Output  
The dead time value for the OC1A output. The dead time delay is set as a number of the pres-  
caled timer/counter clocks. The minimum dead time is zero and the maximum dead time is the  
prescaled time/counter clock period multiplied by 15.  
17.0.3  
DT1B – Timer/Counter1 Dead Time B  
Bit  
0x24  
7
6
DT1BH2  
R/W  
5
DT1BH1  
R/W  
4
DT1BH0  
R/W  
3
DT1BL3  
R/W  
0
2
DT1BL2  
R/W  
0
1
DT1BL1  
R/W  
0
0
DT1BL0  
R/W  
0
DT1BH3  
DT1B  
Read/Write  
Initial value  
R/W  
0
0
0
0
The dead time value register Bis an 8-bit read/write register.  
The dead time delay of is adjusted by the dead time value register, DT1B. The register consists  
of two fields, DT1BH3:0 and DT1BL3:0, one for each complementary output. Therefore a differ-  
ent dead time delay can be adjusted for the rising edge of OC1A and the rising edge of OC1A.  
• Bits 7:4- DT1BH3:DT1BH0: Dead Time Value for OC1B Output  
The dead time value for the OC1B output. The dead time delay is set as a number of the pres-  
caled timer/counter clocks. The minimum dead time is zero and the maximum dead time is the  
prescaled time/counter clock period multiplied by 15.  
• Bits 3:0- DT1BL3:DT1BL0: Dead Time Value for OC1B Output  
The dead time value for the OC1B output. The dead time delay is set as a number of the pres-  
caled timer/counter clocks. The minimum dead time is zero and the maximum dead time is the  
prescaled time/counter clock period multiplied by 15.  
108  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
18. USI – Universal Serial Interface  
The Universal Serial Interface, or USI, provides the basic hardware resources needed for serial  
communication. Combined with a minimum of control software, the USI allows significantly  
higher transfer rates and uses less code space than solutions based on software only. Interrupts  
are included to minimize the processor load. The main features of the USI are:  
Two-wire Synchronous Data Transfer (Master or Slave, fSCLmax = fCK/16)  
Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer (Master or Slave fSCKmax = fCK/4)  
Data Received Interrupt  
Wakeup from Idle Mode  
Wake-up from All Sleep Modes In Two-wire Mode  
Two-wire Start Condition Detector with Interrupt Capability  
18.1 Overview  
A simplified block diagram of the USI is shown on Figure 18-1. For the actual placement of I/O  
pins, refer to ”Pinout ATtiny25/45/85” on page 2. CPU accessible I/O Registers, including I/O  
bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations are listed  
in the ”USI Register Descriptions” on page 116.  
Figure 18-1. Universal Serial Interface, Block Diagram  
(Output only)  
DO  
D
Q
LE  
(Input/Open Drain)  
DI/SDA  
3
2
USIDR  
USIDB  
1
0
TIM0 COMP  
3
2
0
1
(Input/Open Drain)  
USCK/SCL  
4-bit Counter  
1
0
CLOCK  
HOLD  
[1]  
Two-wire Clock  
Control Unit  
USISR  
2
USICR  
The 8-bit Shift Register is directly accessible via the data bus and contains the incoming and  
outgoing data. The register has no buffering so the data must be read as quickly as possible to  
ensure that no data is lost. The most significant bit is connected to one of two output pins  
depending of the wire mode configuration. A transparent latch is inserted between the Serial  
Register Output and output pin, which delays the change of data output to the opposite clock  
edge of the data input sampling. The serial input is always sampled from the Data Input (DI) pin  
independent of the configuration.  
The 4-bit counter can be both read and written via the data bus, and can generate an overflow  
interrupt. Both the Serial Register and the counter are clocked simultaneously by the same clock  
source. This allows the counter to count the number of bits received or transmitted and generate  
109  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
an interrupt when the transfer is complete. Note that when an external clock source is selected  
the counter counts both clock edges. In this case the counter counts the number of edges, and  
not the number of bits. The clock can be selected from three different sources: The USCK pin,  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match or from software.  
The Two-wire clock control unit can generate an interrupt when a start condition is detected on  
the Two-wire bus. It can also generate wait states by holding the clock pin low after a start con-  
dition is detected, or after the counter overflows.  
18.2 Functional Descriptions  
18.2.1  
Three-wire Mode  
The USI Three-wire mode is compliant to the Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) mode 0 and 1, but  
does not have the slave select (SS) pin functionality. However, this feature can be implemented  
in software if necessary. Pin names used by this mode are: DI, DO, and USCK.  
Figure 18-2. Three-wire Mode Operation, Simplified Diagram  
DO  
DI  
Bit7  
Bit6  
Bit5  
Bit4  
Bit3  
Bit2  
Bit1  
Bit0  
USCK  
SLAVE  
DO  
DI  
Bit7  
Bit6  
Bit5  
Bit4  
Bit3  
Bit2  
Bit1  
Bit0  
USCK  
PORTxn  
MASTER  
Figure 18-2 shows two USI units operating in Three-wire mode, one as Master and one as  
Slave. The two Shift Registers are interconnected in such way that after eight USCK clocks, the  
data in each register are interchanged. The same clock also increments the USI’s 4-bit counter.  
The Counter Overflow (interrupt) Flag, or USIOIF, can therefore be used to determine when a  
transfer is completed. The clock is generated by the Master device software by toggling the  
USCK pin via the PORT Register or by writing a one to the USITC bit in USICR.  
110  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 18-3. Three-wire Mode, Timing Diagram  
( Reference )  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CYCLE  
USCK  
USCK  
DO  
MSB  
MSB  
6
5
4
3
2
1
LSB  
LSB  
6
5
4
3
2
1
DI  
A
B
C
D
E
The Three-wire mode timing is shown in Figure 18-3. At the top of the figure is a USCK cycle ref-  
erence. One bit is shifted into the USI Shift Register (USIDR) for each of these cycles. The  
USCK timing is shown for both external clock modes. In External Clock mode 0 (USICS0 = 0), DI  
is sampled at positive edges, and DO is changed (Data Register is shifted by one) at negative  
edges. External Clock mode 1 (USICS0 = 1) uses the opposite edges versus mode 0, i.e., sam-  
ples data at negative and changes the output at positive edges. The USI clock modes  
corresponds to the SPI data mode 0 and 1.  
Referring to the timing diagram (Figure 18-3.), a bus transfer involves the following steps:  
1. The Slave device and Master device sets up its data output and, depending on the proto-  
col used, enables its output driver (mark A and B). The output is set up by writing the  
data to be transmitted to the Serial Data Register. Enabling of the output is done by set-  
ting the corresponding bit in the port Data Direction Register. Note that point A and B  
does not have any specific order, but both must be at least one half USCK cycle before  
point C where the data is sampled. This must be done to ensure that the data setup  
requirement is satisfied. The 4-bit counter is reset to zero.  
2. The Master generates a clock pulse by software toggling the USCK line twice (C and D).  
The bit value on the slave and master’s data input (DI) pin is sampled by the USI on the  
first edge (C), and the data output is changed on the opposite edge (D). The 4-bit counter  
will count both edges.  
3. Step 2. is repeated eight times for a complete register (byte) transfer.  
4. After eight clock pulses (i.e., 16 clock edges) the counter will overflow and indicate that  
the transfer is completed. The data bytes transferred must now be processed before a  
new transfer can be initiated. The overflow interrupt will wake up the processor if it is set  
to Idle mode. Depending of the protocol used the slave device can now set its output to  
high impedance.  
18.2.2  
SPI Master Operation Example  
The following code demonstrates how to use the USI module as a SPI Master:  
SPITransfer:  
sts  
ldi  
sts  
ldi  
USIDR,r16  
r16,(1<<USIOIF)  
USISR,r16  
r16,(1<<USIWM0)|(1<<USICS1)|(1<<USICLK)|(1<<USITC)  
SPITransfer_loop:  
sts  
USICR,r16  
lds  
r16, USISR  
r16, USIOIF  
sbrs  
111  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
rjmp  
lds  
SPITransfer_loop  
r16,USIDR  
ret  
The code is size optimized using only eight instructions (+ ret). The code example assumes that  
the DO and USCK pins are enabled as output in the DDRE Register. The value stored in register  
r16 prior to the function is called is transferred to the Slave device, and when the transfer is com-  
pleted the data received from the Slave is stored back into the r16 Register.  
The second and third instructions clears the USI Counter Overflow Flag and the USI counter  
value. The fourth and fifth instruction set Three-wire mode, positive edge Shift Register clock,  
count at USITC strobe, and toggle USCK. The loop is repeated 16 times.  
The following code demonstrates how to use the USI module as a SPI Master with maximum  
speed (fsck = fck/4):  
SPITransfer_Fast:  
sts  
ldi  
ldi  
USIDR,r16  
r16,(1<<USIWM0)|(0<<USICS0)|(1<<USITC)  
r17,(1<<USIWM0)|(0<<USICS0)|(1<<USITC)|(1<<USICLK)  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
sts  
USICR,r16 ; MSB  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16  
USICR,r17  
USICR,r16 ; LSB  
USICR,r17  
lds  
r16,USIDR  
ret  
112  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
18.2.3  
SPI Slave Operation Example  
The following code demonstrates how to use the USI module as a SPI Slave:  
init:  
ldi  
sts  
r16,(1<<USIWM0)|(1<<USICS1)  
USICR,r16  
...  
SlaveSPITransfer:  
sts  
ldi  
sts  
USIDR,r16  
r16,(1<<USIOIF)  
USISR,r16  
SlaveSPITransfer_loop:  
lds  
r16, USISR  
sbrs  
rjmp  
lds  
r16, USIOIF  
SlaveSPITransfer_loop  
r16,USIDR  
ret  
The code is size optimized using only eight instructions (+ ret). The code example assumes that  
the DO is configured as output and USCK pin is configured as input in the DDR Register. The  
value stored in register r16 prior to the function is called is transferred to the master device, and  
when the transfer is completed the data received from the Master is stored back into the r16  
Register.  
Note that the first two instructions is for initialization only and needs only to be executed  
once.These instructions sets Three-wire mode and positive edge Shift Register clock. The loop  
is repeated until the USI Counter Overflow Flag is set.  
18.2.4  
Two-wire Mode  
The USI Two-wire mode is compliant to the Inter IC (TWI) bus protocol, but without slew rate lim-  
iting on outputs and input noise filtering. Pin names used by this mode are SCL and SDA.  
113  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 18-4. Two-wire Mode Operation, Simplified Diagram  
VCC  
SDA  
SCL  
Bit7  
Bit6  
Bit5  
Bit4  
Bit3  
Bit2  
Bit1  
Bit0  
HOLD  
SCL  
Two-wire Clock  
Control Unit  
SLAVE  
SDA  
SCL  
Bit7  
Bit6  
Bit5  
Bit4  
Bit3  
Bit2  
Bit1  
Bit0  
PORTxn  
MASTER  
Figure 18-4 shows two USI units operating in Two-wire mode, one as Master and one as Slave.  
It is only the physical layer that is shown since the system operation is highly dependent of the  
communication scheme used. The main differences between the Master and Slave operation at  
this level, is the serial clock generation which is always done by the Master, and only the Slave  
uses the clock control unit. Clock generation must be implemented in software, but the shift  
operation is done automatically by both devices. Note that only clocking on negative edge for  
shifting data is of practical use in this mode. The slave can insert wait states at start or end of  
transfer by forcing the SCL clock low. This means that the Master must always check if the SCL  
line was actually released after it has generated a positive edge.  
Since the clock also increments the counter, a counter overflow can be used to indicate that the  
transfer is completed. The clock is generated by the master by toggling the USCK pin via the  
PORT Register.  
The data direction is not given by the physical layer. A protocol, like the one used by the TWI-  
bus, must be implemented to control the data flow.  
Figure 18-5. Two-wire Mode, Typical Timing Diagram  
SDA  
1 - 7  
8
9
1 - 8  
9
1 - 8  
9
SCL  
S
P
ADDRESS  
R/W  
ACK  
DATA  
ACK  
DATA  
ACK  
A
B
C
D
E
F
Referring to the timing diagram (Figure 18-5.), a bus transfer involves the following steps:  
114  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
1. The a start condition is generated by the Master by forcing the SDA low line while the  
SCL line is high (A). SDA can be forced low either by writing a zero to bit 7 of the Shift  
Register, or by setting the corresponding bit in the PORT Register to zero. Note that the  
Data Direction Register bit must be set to one for the output to be enabled. The slave  
device’s start detector logic (Figure 18-6.) detects the start condition and sets the USISIF  
Flag. The flag can generate an interrupt if necessary.  
2. In addition, the start detector will hold the SCL line low after the Master has forced an  
negative edge on this line (B). This allows the Slave to wake up from sleep or complete  
its other tasks before setting up the Shift Register to receive the address. This is done by  
clearing the start condition flag and reset the counter.  
3. The Master set the first bit to be transferred and releases the SCL line (C). The Slave  
samples the data and shift it into the Serial Register at the positive edge of the SCL  
clock.  
4. After eight bits are transferred containing slave address and data direction (read or  
write), the Slave counter overflows and the SCL line is forced low (D). If the slave is not  
the one the Master has addressed, it releases the SCL line and waits for a new start  
condition.  
5. If the Slave is addressed it holds the SDA line low during the acknowledgment cycle  
before holding the SCL line low again (i.e., the Counter Register must be set to 14 before  
releasing SCL at (D)). Depending of the R/W bit the Master or Slave enables its output. If  
the bit is set, a master read operation is in progress (i.e., the slave drives the SDA line)  
The slave can hold the SCL line low after the acknowledge (E).  
6. Multiple bytes can now be transmitted, all in same direction, until a stop condition is given  
by the Master (F). Or a new start condition is given.  
If the Slave is not able to receive more data it does not acknowledge the data byte it has last  
received. When the Master does a read operation it must terminate the operation by force the  
acknowledge bit low after the last byte transmitted.  
Figure 18-6. Start Condition Detector, Logic Diagram  
USISIF  
CLOCK  
HOLD  
D Q  
D Q  
SDA  
CLR  
CLR  
SCL  
Write( USISIF)  
18.2.5  
Start Condition Detector  
The start condition detector is shown in Figure 18-6. The SDA line is delayed (in the range of 50  
to 300 ns) to ensure valid sampling of the SCL line. The start condition detector is only enabled  
in Two-wire mode.  
The start condition detector is working asynchronously and can therefore wake up the processor  
from the Power-down sleep mode. However, the protocol used might have restrictions on the  
SCL hold time. Therefore, when using this feature in this case the Oscillator start-up time set by  
the CKSEL Fuses (see ”Clock Systems and their Distribution” on page 22) must also be taken  
into the consideration. Refer to the USISIF bit description on page 117 for further details.  
115  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
18.3 Alternative USI Usage  
When the USI unit is not used for serial communication, it can be set up to do alternative tasks  
due to its flexible design.  
18.3.1  
18.3.2  
18.3.3  
18.3.4  
Half-duplex Asynchronous Data Transfer  
By utilizing the Shift Register in Three-wire mode, it is possible to implement a more compact  
and higher performance UART than by software only.  
4-bit Counter  
The 4-bit counter can be used as a stand-alone counter with overflow interrupt. Note that if the  
counter is clocked externally, both clock edges will generate an increment.  
12-bit Timer/Counter  
Combining the USI 4-bit counter and Timer/Counter0 allows them to be used as a 12-bit  
counter.  
Edge Triggered External Interrupt  
By setting the counter to maximum value (F) it can function as an additional external interrupt.  
The Overflow Flag and Interrupt Enable bit are then used for the external interrupt. This feature  
is selected by the USICS1 bit.  
18.3.5  
Software Interrupt  
The counter overflow interrupt can be used as a software interrupt triggered by a clock strobe.  
18.4 USI Register Descriptions  
18.4.1  
USIDR – USI Data Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x0F  
MSB  
R/W  
0
LSB  
R/W  
0
USIDR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
When accessing the USI Data Register (USIDR) the Serial Register can be accessed directly. If  
a serial clock occurs at the same cycle the register is written, the register will contain the value  
written and no shift is performed. A (left) shift operation is performed depending of the USICS1:0  
bits setting. The shift operation can be controlled by an external clock edge, by a  
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match, or directly by software using the USICLK strobe bit. Note that  
even when no wire mode is selected (USIWM1:0 = 0) both the external data input (DI/SDA) and  
the external clock input (USCK/SCL) can still be used by the Shift Register.  
The output pin in use, DO or SDA depending on the wire mode, is connected via the output latch  
to the most significant bit (bit 7) of the Data Register. The output latch is open (transparent) dur-  
ing the first half of a serial clock cycle when an external clock source is selected (USICS1 = 1),  
and constantly open when an internal clock source is used (USICS1 = 0). The output will be  
changed immediately when a new MSB written as long as the latch is open. The latch ensures  
that data input is sampled and data output is changed on opposite clock edges.  
Note that the corresponding Data Direction Register to the pin must be set to one for enabling  
data output from the Shift Register.  
116  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
18.4.2  
USIBR – USI Buffer Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x10  
MSB  
R
LSB  
R
USIBR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
The content of the Serial Register is loaded to the USI Buffer Register when the trasfer is com-  
pleted, and instead of accessing the USI Data Register (the Serial Register) the USI Data Buffer  
can be accessed when the CPU reads the received data. This gives the CPU time to handle  
other program tasks too as the controlling of the USI is not so timing critical. The USI flags as set  
same as when reading the USIDR register.  
18.4.3  
USISR – USI Status Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x0E  
USISIF  
R/W  
0
USIOIF  
R/W  
0
USIPF  
R/W  
0
USIDC  
USICNT3  
USICNT2  
USICNT1  
USICNT0  
USISR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The Status Register contains Interrupt Flags, line Status Flags and the counter value.  
• Bit 7 – USISIF: Start Condition Interrupt Flag  
When Two-wire mode is selected, the USISIF Flag is set (to one) when a start condition is  
detected. When output disable mode or Three-wire mode is selected and (USICSx = 0b11 &  
USICLK = 0) or (USICS = 0b10 & USICLK = 0), any edge on the SCK pin sets the flag.  
An interrupt will be generated when the flag is set while the USISIE bit in USICR and the Global  
Interrupt Enable Flag are set. The flag will only be cleared by writing a logical one to the USISIF  
bit. Clearing this bit will release the start detection hold of USCL in Two-wire mode.  
A start condition interrupt will wakeup the processor from all sleep modes.  
• Bit 6 – USIOIF: Counter Overflow Interrupt Flag  
This flag is set (one) when the 4-bit counter overflows (i.e., at the transition from 15 to 0). An  
interrupt will be generated when the flag is set while the USIOIE bit in USICR and the Global  
Interrupt Enable Flag are set. The flag will only be cleared if a one is written to the USIOIF bit.  
Clearing this bit will release the counter overflow hold of SCL in Two-wire mode.  
A counter overflow interrupt will wakeup the processor from Idle sleep mode.  
• Bit 5 – USIPF: Stop Condition Flag  
When Two-wire mode is selected, the USIPF Flag is set (one) when a stop condition is detected.  
The flag is cleared by writing a one to this bit. Note that this is not an Interrupt Flag. This signal is  
useful when implementing Two-wire bus master arbitration.  
• Bit 4 – USIDC: Data Output Collision  
This bit is logical one when bit 7 in the Shift Register differs from the physical pin value. The flag  
is only valid when Two-wire mode is used. This signal is useful when implementing Two-wire  
bus master arbitration.  
• Bits 3:0 – USICNT3:0: Counter Value  
These bits reflect the current 4-bit counter value. The 4-bit counter value can directly be read or  
written by the CPU.  
117  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
The 4-bit counter increments by one for each clock generated either by the external clock edge  
detector, by a Timer/Counter0 Compare Match, or by software using USICLK or USITC strobe  
bits. The clock source depends of the setting of the USICS1..0 bits. For external clock operation  
a special feature is added that allows the clock to be generated by writing to the USITC strobe  
bit. This feature is enabled by write a one to the USICLK bit while setting an external clock  
source (USICS1 = 1).  
Note that even when no wire mode is selected (USIWM1..0 = 0) the external clock input  
(USCK/SCL) are can still be used by the counter.  
18.4.4  
USICR – USI Control Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x0D  
USISIE  
R/W  
0
USIOIE  
R/W  
0
USIWM1  
USIWM0  
USICS1  
R/W  
0
USICS0  
R/W  
0
USICLK  
USITC  
USICR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
W
0
W
0
The Control Register includes interrupt enable control, wire mode setting, Clock Select setting,  
and clock strobe.  
• Bit 7 – USISIE: Start Condition Interrupt Enable  
Setting this bit to one enables the Start Condition detector interrupt. If there is a pending inter-  
rupt when the USISIE and the Global Interrupt Enable Flag is set to one, this will immediately be  
executed. Refer to the USISIF bit description on page 117 for further details.  
• Bit 6 – USIOIE: Counter Overflow Interrupt Enable  
Setting this bit to one enables the Counter Overflow interrupt. If there is a pending interrupt when  
the USIOIE and the Global Interrupt Enable Flag is set to one, this will immediately be executed.  
Refer to the USIOIF bit description on page 117 for further details.  
• Bit 5:4 – USIWM1:0: Wire Mode  
These bits set the type of wire mode to be used. Basically only the function of the outputs are  
affected by these bits. Data and clock inputs are not affected by the mode selected and will  
always have the same function. The counter and Shift Register can therefore be clocked exter-  
nally, and data input sampled, even when outputs are disabled. The relations between  
USIWM1:0 and the USI operation is summarized in Table 18-1.  
118  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 18-1. Relations between USIWM1..0 and the USI Operation  
USIWM1 USIWM0 Description  
0
0
Outputs, clock hold, and start detector disabled. Port pins operates as normal.  
Three-wire mode. Uses DO, DI, and USCK pins.  
The Data Output (DO) pin overrides the corresponding bit in the PORT Register  
in this mode. However, the corresponding DDR bit still controls the data  
direction. When the port pin is set as input the pins pull-up is controlled by the  
PORT bit.  
0
1
The Data Input (DI) and Serial Clock (USCK) pins do not affect the normal port  
operation. When operating as master, clock pulses are software generated by  
toggling the PORT Register, while the data direction is set to output. The USITC  
bit in the USICR Register can be used for this purpose.  
Two-wire mode. Uses SDA (DI) and SCL (USCK) pins(1)  
.
The Serial Data (SDA) and the Serial Clock (SCL) pins are bi-directional and  
uses open-collector output drives. The output drivers are enabled by setting the  
corresponding bit for SDA and SCL in the DDR Register.  
When the output driver is enabled for the SDA pin, the output driver will force the  
line SDA low if the output of the Shift Register or the corresponding bit in the  
PORT Register is zero. Otherwise the SDA line will not be driven (i.e., it is  
released). When the SCL pin output driver is enabled the SCL line will be forced  
low if the corresponding bit in the PORT Register is zero, or by the start  
detector. Otherwise the SCL line will not be driven.  
1
0
The SCL line is held low when a start detector detects a start condition and the  
output is enabled. Clearing the Start Condition Flag (USISIF) releases the line.  
The SDA and SCL pin inputs is not affected by enabling this mode. Pull-ups on  
the SDA and SCL port pin are disabled in Two-wire mode.  
Two-wire mode. Uses SDA and SCL pins.  
Same operation as for the Two-wire mode described above, except that the SCL  
line is also held low when a counter overflow occurs, and is held low until the  
Counter Overflow Flag (USIOIF) is cleared.  
1
1
Note:  
1. The DI and USCK pins are renamed to Serial Data (SDA) and Serial Clock (SCL) respectively  
to avoid confusion between the modes of operation.  
• Bit 3:2 – USICS1:0: Clock Source Select  
These bits set the clock source for the Shift Register and counter. The data output latch ensures  
that the output is changed at the opposite edge of the sampling of the data input (DI/SDA) when  
using external clock source (USCK/SCL). When software strobe or Timer/Counter0 Compare  
Match clock option is selected, the output latch is transparent and therefore the output is  
changed immediately. Clearing the USICS1..0 bits enables software strobe option. When using  
this option, writing a one to the USICLK bit clocks both the Shift Register and the counter. For  
external clock source (USICS1 = 1), the USICLK bit is no longer used as a strobe, but selects  
between external clocking and software clocking by the USITC strobe bit.  
119  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 18-2 shows the relationship between the USICS1..0 and USICLK setting and clock source  
used for the Shift Register and the 4-bit counter.  
Table 18-2. Relations between the USICS1..0 and USICLK Setting  
USICS1  
USICS0  
USICLK  
Shift Register Clock Source  
4-bit Counter Clock Source  
0
0
0
No Clock  
No Clock  
Software clock strobe  
(USICLK)  
Software clock strobe  
(USICLK)  
0
0
0
1
1
Timer/Counter0 Compare  
Match  
Timer/Counter0 Compare  
Match  
X
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
External, positive edge  
External, negative edge  
External, positive edge  
External, negative edge  
External, both edges  
External, both edges  
Software clock strobe (USITC)  
Software clock strobe (USITC)  
• Bit 1 – USICLK: Clock Strobe  
Writing a one to this bit location strobes the Shift Register to shift one step and the counter to  
increment by one, provided that the USICS1:0 bits are set to zero and by doing so the software  
clock strobe option is selected. The output will change immediately when the clock strobe is exe-  
cuted, i.e., in the same instruction cycle. The value shifted into the Shift Register is sampled the  
previous instruction cycle. The bit will be read as zero.  
When an external clock source is selected (USICS1 = 1), the USICLK function is changed from  
a clock strobe to a Clock Select Register. Setting the USICLK bit in this case will select the  
USITC strobe bit as clock source for the 4-bit counter (see Table 18-2).  
• Bit 0 – USITC: Toggle Clock Port Pin  
Writing a one to this bit location toggles the USCK/SCL value either from 0 to 1, or from 1 to 0.  
The toggling is independent of the setting in the Data Direction Register, but if the PORT value is  
to be shown on the pin the DDRE4 must be set as output (to one). This feature allows easy clock  
generation when implementing master devices. The bit will be read as zero.  
When an external clock source is selected (USICS1 = 1) and the USICLK bit is set to one, writ-  
ing to the USITC strobe bit will directly clock the 4-bit counter. This allows an early detection of  
when the transfer is done when operating as a master device.  
120  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
19. Analog Comparator  
The Analog Comparator compares the input values on the positive pin AIN0 and negative pin  
AIN1. When the voltage on the positive pin AIN0 is higher than the voltage on the negative pin  
AIN1, the Analog Comparator output, ACO, is set. The comparator can trigger a separate inter-  
rupt, exclusive to the Analog Comparator. The user can select Interrupt triggering on comparator  
output rise, fall or toggle. A block diagram of the comparator and its surrounding logic is shown  
in Figure 19-1.  
Figure 19-1. Analog Comparator Block Diagram(2)  
BANDGAP  
REFERENCE  
ACBG  
ACME  
ADEN  
ADC MULTIPLEXER  
OUTPUT(1)  
Notes: 1. See Table 19-2 on page 123.  
2. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 2 and Table 12-5 on page 62 for Analog Comparator pin  
placement.  
19.0.1  
ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B  
Bit  
0x03  
7
6
5
4
R
0
3
R
0
2
1
0
BIN  
ACME  
IPR  
R
ADTS2  
R/W  
0
ADTS1  
R/W  
0
ADTS0  
R/W  
0
ADCSRB  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R/W  
0
0
• Bit 6 – ACME: Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable  
When this bit is written logic one and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), the  
ADC multiplexer selects the negative input to the Analog Comparator. When this bit is written  
logic zero, AIN1 is applied to the negative input of the Analog Comparator. For a detailed  
description of this bit, see ”Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input” on page 122.  
19.0.2  
ACSR – Analog Comparator Control and Status Register  
Bit  
0x08  
7
6
5
4
3
2
R
0
1
0
ACD  
ACBG  
ACO  
ACI  
ACIE  
R/W  
0
ACIS1  
R/W  
0
ACIS0  
R/W  
0
ACSR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R
R/W  
0
N/A  
• Bit 7 – ACD: Analog Comparator Disable  
When this bit is written logic one, the power to the Analog Comparator is switched off. This bit  
can be set at any time to turn off the Analog Comparator. This will reduce power consumption in  
Active and Idle mode. When changing the ACD bit, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be  
121  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
disabled by clearing the ACIE bit in ACSR. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bit is  
changed.  
• Bit 6 – ACBG: Analog Comparator Bandgap Select  
When this bit is set an internal 1.1V / 2.56V reference voltage replaces the positive input to the  
Analog Comparator. The selection of the internal voltage reference is done by writing the  
REFS2..0 bits in ADMUX register. When this bit is cleared, AIN0 is applied to the positive input  
of the Analog Comparator.  
• Bit 5 – ACO: Analog Comparator Output  
The output of the Analog Comparator is synchronized and then directly connected to ACO. The  
synchronization introduces a delay of 1 - 2 clock cycles.  
• Bit 4 – ACI: Analog Comparator Interrupt Flag  
This bit is set by hardware when a comparator output event triggers the interrupt mode defined  
by ACIS1 and ACIS0. The Analog Comparator interrupt routine is executed if the ACIE bit is set  
and the I-bit in SREG is set. ACI is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding inter-  
rupt handling vector. Alternatively, ACI is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag.  
• Bit 3 – ACIE: Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable  
When the ACIE bit is written logic one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Analog Com-  
parator interrupt is activated. When written logic zero, the interrupt is disabled.  
• Bit 2 – Res: Reserved Bit  
This bit is a reserved bit in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 1, 0 – ACIS1, ACIS0: Analog Comparator Interrupt Mode Select  
These bits determine which comparator events that trigger the Analog Comparator interrupt. The  
different settings are shown in Table 19-1.  
Table 19-1. ACIS1/ACIS0 Settings  
ACIS1  
ACIS0  
Interrupt Mode  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Comparator Interrupt on Output Toggle.  
Reserved  
Comparator Interrupt on Falling Output Edge.  
Comparator Interrupt on Rising Output Edge.  
When changing the ACIS1/ACIS0 bits, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be disabled by  
clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the ACSR Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the  
bits are changed.  
19.1 Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input  
It is possible to select any of the ADC3..0 pins to replace the negative input to the Analog Com-  
parator. The ADC multiplexer is used to select this input, and consequently, the ADC must be  
switched off to utilize this feature. If the Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable bit (ACME in  
ADCSRB) is set and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), MUX1..0 in ADMUX  
select the input pin to replace the negative input to the Analog Comparator, as shown in Table  
122  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
19-2. If ACME is cleared or ADEN is set, AIN1 is applied to the negative input to the Analog  
Comparator.  
Table 19-2. Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input  
ACME  
ADEN  
MUX1..0  
Analog Comparator Negative Input  
0
1
1
1
1
1
x
1
0
0
0
0
xx  
xx  
00  
01  
10  
11  
AIN1  
AIN1  
ADC0  
ADC1  
ADC2  
ADC3  
19.1.1  
DIDR0 – Digital Input Disable Register 0  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x14  
ADC0D  
R/W  
0
ADC2D  
R/W  
0
ADC3D  
R/W  
0
ADC1D  
R/W  
0
AIN1D  
R/W  
0
AIN0D  
R/W  
0
DIDR0  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 1, 0 – AIN1D, AIN0D: AIN1, AIN0 Digital Input Disable  
When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the AIN1/0 pin is disabled. The corre-  
sponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an analog signal is  
applied to the AIN1/0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this bit should be writ-  
ten logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer.  
123  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
20. Analog to Digital Converter  
20.1 Features  
10-bit Resolution  
0.5 LSB Integral Non-linearity  
± 2 LSB Absolute Accuracy  
65 - 260 µs Conversion Time  
Up to 15 kSPS at Maximum Resolution  
Four Multiplexed Single Ended Input Channels  
Two differential input channels with selectable gain  
Temperature sensor input channel  
Optional Left Adjustment for ADC Result Readout  
0 - VCC ADC Input Voltage Range  
Selectable 1.1V / 2.56V ADC Voltage Reference  
Free Running or Single Conversion Mode  
ADC Start Conversion by Auto Triggering on Interrupt Sources  
Interrupt on ADC Conversion Complete  
Sleep Mode Noise Cancele  
Unipolar / Bibilar Input Mode  
Input Polarity Reversal Mode  
The ATtiny25/45/85 features a 10-bit successive approximation ADC. The ADC is connected to  
a 4-channel Analog Multiplexer which allows one differential voltage input and four single-ended  
voltage inputs constructed from the pins of Port B. The differential input (PB3, PB4 or PB2, PB5)  
is equipped with a programmable gain stage, providing amplification step of 26 dB (20x) on the  
differential input voltage before the A/D conversion. The single-ended voltage inputs refer to 0V  
(GND).  
The ADC contains a Sample and Hold circuit which ensures that the input voltage to the ADC is  
held at a constant level during conversion. A block diagram of the ADC is shown in Figure 20-1.  
Internal voltage references of nominally 1.1V or 2.56V are provided On-chip and these voltage  
references can optionally be externally decoupled at the AREF (PB0) pin by a capacitor, for bet-  
ter noise performance. For , VCC can be used as voltage reference for single ended channels.  
There is also an option to use an external voltage reference and turn-off the internal voltage ref-  
erence. These options are selected using the REFS2..0 bits of the ADMUX control register.  
124  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 20-1. Analog to Digital Converter Block Schematic  
ADC CONVERSION  
COMPLETE IRQ  
INTERRUPT  
FLAGS  
ADTS[2:0]  
8-BIT DATA BUS  
15  
0
ADC CTRL. & STATUS B  
REGISTER (ADCSRB)  
ADC CTRL. & STATUS A  
REGISTER (ADCSRA)  
ADC MULTIPLEXER  
SELECT (ADMUX)  
ADC DATA REGISTER  
(ADCH/ADCL)  
BIN  
IPR  
TRIGGER  
SELECT  
MUX DECODER  
V
PRESCALER  
CC  
START  
AREF  
CONVERSION LOGIC  
INTERNAL 1.1V/2.56V  
REFERENCE  
TEMPERATURE  
SENSOR  
SAMPLE & HOLD  
COMPARATOR  
10-BIT DAC  
-
ADC4  
+
ADC3  
ADC2  
ADC1  
ADC0  
SINGLE ENDED / DIFFERENTIAL SELECTION  
INPUT  
MUX  
ADC MULTIPLEXER  
OUTPUT  
GAIN  
AMPLIFIER  
+
-
NEG.  
INPUT  
MUX  
20.2 Operation  
The ADC converts an analog input voltage to a 10-bit digital value through successive approxi-  
mation. The minimum value represents GND and the maximum value represents the voltage on  
V
CC, the voltage on the AREF pin or an internal 1.1V / 2.56V voltage reference.  
The voltage reference for the ADC may be selected by writing to the REFS2:0 bits in ADMUX.  
The VCC supply, the AREF pin or an internal 1.1V / 2.56V voltage reference may be selected as  
the ADC voltage reference. Optionally the internal 1.1V / 2.56V voltage reference may be decou-  
pled by an external capacitor at the AREF pin to improve noise immunity.  
The analog input channel and differential gain are selected by writing to the MUX3..0 bits in  
ADMUX. Any of the four ADC input pins ADC3..0 can be selected as single ended inputs to the  
ADC. ADC2 or ADC0 can be selected as positive input and ADC0, ADC1, ADC2 or ADC3 can  
be selected as negative input to the differential gain amplifier.  
If differential channels are selected, the differential gain stage amplifies the voltage difference  
between the selected input pair by the selected gain factor, 1x or 20x, according to the setting of  
the MUX3:0 bits in ADMUX. This amplified value then becomes the analog input to the ADC. If  
single ended channels are used, the gain amplifier is bypassed altogether.  
125  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
If ADC0 or ADC2 is selected as both the positive and negative input to the differential gain  
amplifier (ADC0-ADC0 or ADC2-ADC2), the remaining offset in the gain stage and conversion  
circuitry can be measured directly as the result of the conversion. This figure can be subtracted  
from subsequent conversions with the same gain setting to reduce offset error to below 1 LSW.  
The on-chip temperature sensor is selected by writing the code “1111” to the MUX3..0 bits in  
ADMUX register when the ADC4 channel is used as an ADC input.  
The ADC is enabled by setting the ADC Enable bit, ADEN in ADCSRA. Voltage reference and  
input channel selections will not go into effect until ADEN is set. The ADC does not consume  
power when ADEN is cleared, so it is recommended to switch off the ADC before entering power  
saving sleep modes.  
The ADC generates a 10-bit result which is presented in the ADC Data Registers, ADCH and  
ADCL. By default, the result is presented right adjusted, but can optionally be presented left  
adjusted by setting the ADLAR bit in ADMUX.  
If the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read  
ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH, to ensure that the content of the data  
registers belongs to the same conversion. Once ADCL is read, ADC access to data registers is  
blocked. This means that if ADCL has been read, and a conversion completes before ADCH is  
read, neither register is updated and the result from the conversion is lost. When ADCH is read,  
ADC access to the ADCH and ADCL Registers is re-enabled.  
The ADC has its own interrupt which can be triggered when a conversion completes. When ADC  
access to the data registers is prohibited between reading of ADCH and ADCL, the interrupt will  
trigger even if the result is lost.  
20.3 Starting a Conversion  
A single conversion is started by writing a logical one to the ADC Start Conversion bit, ADSC.  
This bit stays high as long as the conversion is in progress and will be cleared by hardware  
when the conversion is completed. If a different data channel is selected while a conversion is in  
progress, the ADC will finish the current conversion before performing the channel change.  
Alternatively, a conversion can be triggered automatically by various sources. Auto Triggering is  
enabled by setting the ADC Auto Trigger Enable bit, ADATE in ADCSRA. The trigger source is  
selected by setting the ADC Trigger Select bits, ADTS in ADCSRB (see description of the ADTS  
bits for a list of the trigger sources). When a positive edge occurs on the selected trigger signal,  
the ADC prescaler is reset and a conversion is started. This provides a method of starting con-  
versions at fixed intervals. If the trigger signal still is set when the conversion completes, a new  
conversion will not be started. If another positive edge occurs on the trigger signal during con-  
version, the edge will be ignored. Note that an Interrupt Flag will be set even if the specific  
interrupt is disabled or the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is cleared. A conversion can thus  
be triggered without causing an interrupt. However, the Interrupt Flag must be cleared in order to  
trigger a new conversion at the next interrupt event.  
126  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 20-2. ADC Auto Trigger Logic  
ADTS[2:0]  
PRESCALER  
CLKADC  
START  
ADIF  
ADATE  
SOURCE 1  
.
.
.
CONVERSION  
LOGIC  
.
EDGE  
DETECTOR  
SOURCE n  
ADSC  
Using the ADC Interrupt Flag as a trigger source makes the ADC start a new conversion as soon  
as the ongoing conversion has finished. The ADC then operates in Free Running mode, con-  
stantly sampling and updating the ADC Data Register. The first conversion must be started by  
writing a logical one to the ADSC bit in ADCSRA. In this mode the ADC will perform successive  
conversions independently of whether the ADC Interrupt Flag, ADIF is cleared or not.  
If Auto Triggering is enabled, single conversions can be started by writing ADSC in ADCSRA to  
one. ADSC can also be used to determine if a conversion is in progress. The ADSC bit will be  
read as one during a conversion, independently of how the conversion was started.  
20.4 Prescaling and Conversion Timing  
Figure 20-3. ADC Prescaler  
ADEN  
START  
Reset  
7-BIT ADC PRESCALER  
CK  
ADPS0  
ADPS1  
ADPS2  
ADC CLOCK SOURCE  
By default, the successive approximation circuitry requires an input clock frequency between 50  
kHz and 200 kHz to get maximum resolution. If a lower resolution than 10 bits is needed, the  
input clock frequency to the ADC can be higher than 200 kHz to get a higher sample rate.  
The ADC module contains a prescaler, which generates an acceptable ADC clock frequency  
from any CPU frequency above 100 kHz. The prescaling is set by the ADPS bits in ADCSRA.  
127  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
The prescaler starts counting from the moment the ADC is switched on by setting the ADEN bit  
in ADCSRA. The prescaler keeps running for as long as the ADEN bit is set, and is continuously  
reset when ADEN is low.  
When initiating a single ended conversion by setting the ADSC bit in ADCSRA, the conversion  
starts at the following rising edge of the ADC clock cycle.  
A normal conversion takes 13 ADC clock cycles. The first conversion after the ADC is switched  
on (ADEN in ADCSRA is set) takes 25 ADC clock cycles in order to initialize the analog circuitry.  
The actual sample-and-hold takes place 1.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of a normal conver-  
sion and 14.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of an first conversion. When a conversion is  
complete, the result is written to the ADC Data Registers, and ADIF is set. In Single Conversion  
mode, ADSC is cleared simultaneously. The software may then set ADSC again, and a new  
conversion will be initiated on the first rising ADC clock edge.  
When Auto Triggering is used, the prescaler is reset when the trigger event occurs. This assures  
a fixed delay from the trigger event to the start of conversion. In this mode, the sample-and-hold  
takes place two ADC clock cycles after the rising edge on the trigger source signal. Three addi-  
tional CPU clock cycles are used for synchronization logic.  
In Free Running mode, a new conversion will be started immediately after the conversion com-  
pletes, while ADSC remains high. For a summary of conversion times, see Table 20-1.  
Figure 20-4. ADC Timing Diagram, First Conversion (Single Conversion Mode)  
Next  
First Conversion  
Conversion  
Cycle Number  
1
2
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
1
2
3
ADC Clock  
ADEN  
ADSC  
ADIF  
Sign and MSB of Result  
LSB of Result  
ADCH  
ADCL  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
Conversion  
Complete  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
Sample & Hold  
Figure 20-5. ADC Timing Diagram, Single Conversion  
One Conversion  
Next Conversion  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
1
2
3
Cycle Number  
ADC Clock  
ADSC  
ADIF  
ADCH  
Sign and MSB of Result  
LSB of Result  
ADCL  
Sample & Hold  
Conversion  
Complete  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
128  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 20-6. ADC Timing Diagram, Auto Triggered Conversion  
One Conversion  
Next Conversion  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
1
2
Cycle Number  
ADC Clock  
Trigger  
Source  
ADATE  
ADIF  
ADCH  
ADCL  
Sign and MSB of Result  
LSB of Result  
Sample &  
Hold  
Prescaler  
Reset  
Conversion  
Complete  
Prescaler  
Reset  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
Figure 20-7. ADC Timing Diagram, Free Running Conversion  
One Conversion  
Next Conversion  
11  
12  
13  
1
2
3
4
Cycle Number  
ADC Clock  
ADSC  
ADIF  
ADCH  
ADCL  
Sign and MSB of Result  
LSB of Result  
Sample & Hold  
MUX and REFS  
Update  
Conversion  
Complete  
Table 20-1. ADC Conversion Time  
Sample & Hold  
Condition  
(Cycles from Start of Conversion)  
Conversion Time (Cycles)  
First conversion  
13.5  
1.5  
2
25  
13  
Normal conversions  
Auto Triggered conversions  
13.5  
20.5 Changing Channel or Reference Selection  
The MUX3:0 and REFS2:0 bits in the ADMUX Register are single buffered through a temporary  
register to which the CPU has random access. This ensures that the channels and voltage refer-  
ence selection only takes place at a safe point during the conversion. The channel and voltage  
reference selection is continuously updated until a conversion is started. Once the conversion  
starts, the channel and voltage reference selection is locked to ensure a sufficient sampling time  
for the ADC. Continuous updating resumes in the last ADC clock cycle before the conversion  
129  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
completes (ADIF in ADCSRA is set). Note that the conversion starts on the following rising ADC  
clock edge after ADSC is written. The user is thus advised not to write new channel or voltage  
reference selection values to ADMUX until one ADC clock cycle after ADSC is written.  
If Auto Triggering is used, the exact time of the triggering event can be indeterministic. Special  
care must be taken when updating the ADMUX Register, in order to control which conversion  
will be affected by the new settings.  
If both ADATE and ADEN is written to one, an interrupt event can occur at any time. If the  
ADMUX Register is changed in this period, the user cannot tell if the next conversion is based  
on the old or the new settings. ADMUX can be safely updated in the following ways:  
a. When ADATE or ADEN is cleared.  
b. During conversion, minimum one ADC clock cycle after the trigger event.  
c. After a conversion, before the Interrupt Flag used as trigger source is cleared.  
When updating ADMUX in one of these conditions, the new settings will affect the next ADC  
conversion.  
20.5.1  
ADC Input Channels  
When changing channel selections, the user should observe the following guidelines to ensure  
that the correct channel is selected:  
In Single Conversion mode, always select the channel before starting the conversion. The chan-  
nel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the  
simplest method is to wait for the conversion to complete before changing the channel selection.  
In Free Running mode, always select the channel before starting the first conversion. The chan-  
nel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the  
simplest method is to wait for the first conversion to complete, and then change the channel  
selection. Since the next conversion has already started automatically, the next result will reflect  
the previous channel selection. Subsequent conversions will reflect the new channel selection.  
20.5.2  
ADC Voltage Reference  
The voltage reference for the ADC (VREF) indicates the conversion range for the ADC. Single  
ended channels that exceed VREF will result in codes close to 0x3FF. VREF can be selected as  
either VCC, or internal 1.1V / 2.56V voltage reference, or external AREF pin. The first ADC con-  
version result after switching voltage reference source may be inaccurate, and the user is  
advised to discard this result.  
20.6 ADC Noise Canceler  
The ADC features a noise canceler that enables conversion during sleep mode to reduce noise  
induced from the CPU core and other I/O peripherals. The noise canceler can be used with ADC  
Noise Reduction and Idle mode. To make use of this feature, the following procedure should be  
used:  
a. Make sure that the ADC is enabled and is not busy converting. Single Conversion  
mode must be selected and the ADC conversion complete interrupt must be enabled.  
b. Enter ADC Noise Reduction mode (or Idle mode). The ADC will start a conversion  
once the CPU has been halted.  
c. If no other interrupts occur before the ADC conversion completes, the ADC interrupt  
will wake up the CPU and execute the ADC Conversion Complete interrupt routine. If  
another interrupt wakes up the CPU before the ADC conversion is complete, that  
130  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
interrupt will be executed, and an ADC Conversion Complete interrupt request will be  
generated when the ADC conversion completes. The CPU will remain in active mode  
until a new sleep command is executed.  
Note that the ADC will not be automatically turned off when entering other sleep modes than Idle  
mode and ADC Noise Reduction mode. The user is advised to write zero to ADEN before enter-  
ing such sleep modes to avoid excessive power consumption.  
20.6.1  
Analog Input Circuitry  
The analog input circuitry for single ended channels is illustrated in Figure 20-8. An analog  
source applied to ADCn is subjected to the pin capacitance and input leakage of that pin, regard-  
less of whether that channel is selected as input for the ADC. When the channel is selected, the  
source must drive the S/H capacitor through the series resistance (combined resistance in the  
input path).  
The ADC is optimized for analog signals with an output impedance of approximately 10 kor  
less. If such a source is used, the sampling time will be negligible. If a source with higher imped-  
ance is used, the sampling time will depend on how long time the source needs to charge the  
S/H capacitor, with can vary widely. The user is recommended to only use low impedant sources  
with slowly varying signals, since this minimizes the required charge transfer to the S/H  
capacitor.  
Signal components higher than the Nyquist frequency (fADC/2) should not be present to avoid  
distortion from unpredictable signal convolution. The user is advised to remove high frequency  
components with a low-pass filter before applying the signals as inputs to the ADC.  
Figure 20-8. Analog Input Circuitry  
IIH  
ADCn  
1..100 k  
CS/H= 14 pF  
IIL  
VCC/2  
131  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
20.6.2  
Analog Noise Canceling Techniques  
Digital circuitry inside and outside the device generates EMI which might affect the accuracy of  
analog measurements. If conversion accuracy is critical, the noise level can be reduced by  
applying the following techniques:  
a. Keep analog signal paths as short as possible. Make sure analog tracks run over the  
analog ground plane, and keep them well away from high-speed switching digital  
tracks.  
b. Use the ADC noise canceler function to reduce induced noise from the CPU.  
c. If any port pins are used as digital outputs, it is essential that these do not switch  
while a conversion is in progress.  
20.6.3  
ADC Accuracy Definitions  
An n-bit single-ended ADC converts a voltage linearly between GND and VREF in 2n steps  
(LSBs). The lowest code is read as 0, and the highest code is read as 2n-1.  
Several parameters describe the deviation from the ideal behavior:  
• Offset: The deviation of the first transition (0x000 to 0x001) compared to the ideal transition (at  
0.5 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB.  
Figure 20-9. Offset Error  
Output Code  
Ideal ADC  
Actual ADC  
Offset  
Error  
VREF  
Input Voltage  
• Gain Error: After adjusting for offset, the Gain Error is found as the deviation of the last  
transition (0x3FE to 0x3FF) compared to the ideal transition (at 1.5 LSB below maximum).  
Ideal value: 0 LSB  
132  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 20-10. Gain Error  
Gain  
Error  
Output Code  
Ideal ADC  
Actual ADC  
VREF  
Input Voltage  
• Integral Non-linearity (INL): After adjusting for offset and gain error, the INL is the maximum  
deviation of an actual transition compared to an ideal transition for any code. Ideal value: 0  
LSB.  
Figure 20-11. Integral Non-linearity (INL)  
Output Code  
Ideal ADC  
Actual ADC  
VREF Input Voltage  
• Differential Non-linearity (DNL): The maximum deviation of the actual code width (the interval  
between two adjacent transitions) from the ideal code width (1 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB.  
133  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 20-12. Differential Non-linearity (DNL)  
Output Code  
0x3FF  
1 LSB  
DNL  
0x000  
0
VREF Input Voltage  
• Quantization Error: Due to the quantization of the input voltage into a finite number of codes, a  
range of input voltages (1 LSB wide) will code to the same value. Always ± 0.5 LSB.  
• Absolute Accuracy: The maximum deviation of an actual (unadjusted) transition compared to  
an ideal transition for any code. This is the compound effect of offset, gain error, differential  
error, non-linearity, and quantization error. Ideal value: ± 0.5 LSB.  
20.7 ADC Conversion Result  
After the conversion is complete (ADIF is high), the conversion result can be found in the ADC  
Result Registers (ADCL, ADCH). The form of the conversion result depends on the type of the  
conversio as there are three types of conversions: single ended conversion, unipolar differential  
conversion and bipolar differential conversion.  
20.7.1  
Single Ended Conversion  
For single ended conversion, the result is  
V
1024  
IN  
ADC = --------------------------  
V
REF  
where VIN is the voltage on the selected input pin and VREF the selected voltage reference (see  
Table 20-2 on page 136 and Table 20-3 on page 137). 0x000 represents analog ground, and  
0x3FF represents the selected voltage reference minus one LSB. The result is presented in one-  
sided form, from 0x3FF to 0x000.  
20.7.2  
Unipolar Differential Conversion  
If differential channels and an unipolar input mode are used, the result is  
(V  
V  
) ⋅ 1024  
NEG  
POS  
-------------------------------------------------------  
ADC =  
GAIN  
V
REF  
where VPOS is the voltage on the positive input pin, VNEG the voltage on the negative input pin,  
and VREF the selected voltage reference (see Table 20-2 on page 136 and Table 20-3 on page  
134  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
137). The voltage on the positive pin must always be larger than the voltage on the negative pin  
or otherwise the voltage difference is saturated to zero. The result is presented in one-sided  
form, from 0x000 (0d) to 0x3FF (+1023d). The GAIN is either 1x or 20x.  
20.7.3  
Bipolar Differential Conversion  
As default the ADC converter operates in the unipolar input mode, but the bipolar input mode  
can be selected by writting the BIN bit in the ADCSRB to one. In the bipolar input mode two-  
sided voltage differences are allowed and thus the voltage on the negative input pin can also be  
larger than the voltage on the positive input pin. If differential channels and a bipolar input mode  
are used, the result is  
(V  
V  
) ⋅ 512  
NEG  
POS  
----------------------------------------------------  
ADC =  
GAIN  
V
REF  
where VPOS is the voltage on the positive input pin, VNEG the voltage on the negative input pin,  
and VREF the selected voltage reference. The result is presented in two’s complement form, from  
0x200 (-512d) through 0x000 (+0d) to 0x1FF (+511d). The GAIN is either 1x or 20x.  
However, if the signal is not bipolar by nature (9 bits + sign as the 10th bit), this scheme loses  
one bit of the converter dynamic range. Then, if the user wants to perform the conversion with  
the maximum dynamic range, the user can perform a quick polarity check of the result and use  
the unipolar differential conversion with selectable differential input pairs (see the Input Polarity  
Reversal mode ie. the IPR bit in the ADCSRB register on page 135). When the polarity check is  
performed, it is sufficient to read the MSB of the result (ADC9 in ADCH). If the bit is one, the  
result is negative, and if this bit is zero, the result is positive.  
135  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
20.7.4  
ADMUX – ADC Multiplexer Selection Register  
Bit  
7
REFS1  
R/W  
0
6
REFS0  
R/W  
0
5
ADLAR  
R/W  
0
4
REFS2  
R/W  
0
3
MUX3  
R/W  
0
2
MUX2  
R/W  
0
1
MUX1  
R/W  
0
0
MUX0  
R/W  
0
0x07  
ADMUX  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bit 7:6,4 – REFS2:REFS0: Voltage Reference Selection Bits  
These bits select the voltage reference (VREF) for the ADC, as shown in Table 20-2. If these bits  
are changed during a conversion, the change will not go in effect until this conversion is  
complete (ADIF in ADCSR is set). Whenever these bits are changed, the next conversion will  
take 25 ADC clock cycles. If active channels are used, using VCC or an external AREF higher  
than (VCC - 1V) as a voltage reference is not recommended, as this will affect the ADC accuracy.  
Table 20-2. Voltage Reference Selections for ADC  
REFS2  
REFS1  
REFS0  
Voltage Reference (VREF) Selection  
0
0
0
VCC used as Voltage Reference, disconnected from PB0 (AREF).  
External Voltage Reference at PB0 (AREF) pin, Internal Voltage  
Reference turned off.  
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
Internal 1.1V Voltage Reference without external bypass capacitor,  
disconnected from PB0 (AREF).  
Internal 1.1V Voltage Reference with external bypass capacitor at  
PB0 (AREF) pin.  
Internal 2.56V Voltage Reference without external bypass  
capacitor, disconnected from PB0 (AREF).  
Internal 2.56V Voltage Reference with external bypass capacitor at  
PB0 (AREF) pin.  
Bit 5 – ADLAR: ADC Left Adjust Result  
The ADLAR bit affects the presentation of the ADC conversion result in the ADC Data Register.  
Write one to ADLAR to left adjust the result. Otherwise, the result is right adjusted. Changing the  
ADLAR bit will affect the ADC Data Register immediately, regardless of any ongoing conver-  
sions. For a comple te description of this bit, see ”ADCL and ADCH – The ADC Data Register”  
on page 139.  
• Bits 3:0 – MUX3:0: Analog Channel and Gain Selection Bits  
The value of these bits selects which combination of analog inputs are connected to the ADC. In  
case of differential input (ADC0 - ADC1 or ADC2 - ADC3), gain selection is also made with these  
bits. Selecting ADC2 or ADC0 as both inputs to the differential gain stage enables offset mea-  
surements. Selecting the single-ended channel ADC4 enables the temperature sensor. Refer to  
Table 20-3 for details. If these bits are changed during a conversion, the change will not go into  
effect until this conversion is complete (ADIF in ADCSRA is set).  
136  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 20-3. Input Channel Selections  
Single Ended  
Positive  
Negative  
MUX3..0  
0000  
0001  
0010  
0011  
0100  
0101 (1)  
0110  
0111  
1000  
1001  
1010  
1011  
1100  
1101  
1110  
1111  
Input  
Differential Input Differential Input  
Gain  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC1 (PB2)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC3 (PB3)  
N/A  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC2 (PB4)  
ADC3 (PB3)  
ADC3 (PB3)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC0 (PB5)  
ADC1 (PB2)  
ADC1 (PB2)  
1x  
20x  
1x  
20x  
1x  
N/A  
20x  
1x  
20x  
1.1V/2.56V  
0V  
N/A  
N/A  
(2)  
ADC4  
1.  
2.  
For offset calibration only . See Section “20.2” on page 125.  
For Temperature Sensor  
20.7.5  
ADCSRA – ADC Control and Status Register A  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x06  
ADEN  
ADSC  
ADATE  
ADIF  
ADIE  
ADPS2  
R/W  
0
ADPS1  
R/W  
0
ADPS0  
ADCSRA  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
• Bit 7 – ADEN: ADC Enable  
Writing this bit to one enables the ADC. By writing it to zero, the ADC is turned off. Turning the  
ADC off while a conversion is in progress, will terminate this conversion.  
• Bit 6 – ADSC: ADC Start Conversion  
In Single Conversion mode, write this bit to one to start each conversion. In Free Running mode,  
write this bit to one to start the first conversion. The first conversion after ADSC has been written  
after the ADC has been enabled, or if ADSC is written at the same time as the ADC is enabled,  
will take 25 ADC clock cycles instead of the normal 13. This first conversion performs initializa-  
tion of the ADC.  
ADSC will read as one as long as a conversion is in progress. When the conversion is complete,  
it returns to zero. Writing zero to this bit has no effect.  
137  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
• Bit 5 – ADATE: ADC Auto Trigger Enable  
When this bit is written to one, Auto Triggering of the ADC is enabled. The ADC will start a con-  
version on a positive edge of the selected trigger signal. The trigger source is selected by setting  
the ADC Trigger Select bits, ADTS in ADCSRB.  
• Bit 4 – ADIF: ADC Interrupt Flag  
This bit is set when an ADC conversion completes and the data registers are updated. The ADC  
Conversion Complete Interrupt is executed if the ADIE bit and the I-bit in SREG are set. ADIF is  
cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively,  
ADIF is cleared by writing a logical one to the flag. Beware that if doing a Read-Modify-Write on  
ADCSRA, a pending interrupt can be disabled. This also applies if the SBI and CBI instructions  
are used.  
• Bit 3 – ADIE: ADC Interrupt Enable  
When this bit is written to one and the I-bit in SREG is set, the ADC Conversion Complete Inter-  
rupt is activated.  
• Bits 2:0 – ADPS2:0: ADC Prescaler Select Bits  
These bits determine the division factor between the system clock frequency and the input clock  
to the ADC.  
Table 20-4. ADC Prescaler Selections  
ADPS2  
ADPS1  
ADPS0  
Division Factor  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
2
4
8
16  
32  
64  
128  
138  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
20.7.6  
ADCL and ADCH – The ADC Data Register  
20.7.6.1  
ADLAR = 0  
Bit  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
0x05  
0x04  
ADC9  
ADC8  
ADCH  
ADCL  
ADC7  
ADC6  
ADC5  
ADC4  
ADC3  
ADC2  
ADC1  
ADC0  
7
R
R
0
6
R
R
0
5
R
R
0
4
R
R
0
3
R
R
0
2
R
R
0
1
R
R
0
0
R
R
0
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
20.7.6.2  
ADLAR = 1  
Bit  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
0x05  
0x04  
ADC9  
ADC8  
ADC7  
ADC6  
ADC5  
ADC4  
ADC3  
ADC2  
ADCH  
ADCL  
ADC1  
ADC0  
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
R
R
0
6
R
R
0
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When an ADC conversion is complete, the result is found in these two registers.  
When ADCL is read, the ADC Data Register is not updated until ADCH is read. Consequently, if  
the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read  
ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH.  
The ADLAR bit in ADMUX, and the MUXn bits in ADMUX affect the way the result is read from  
the registers. If ADLAR is set, the result is left adjusted. If ADLAR is cleared (default), the result  
is right adjusted.  
• ADC9:0: ADC Conversion Result  
These bits represent the result from the conversion, as detailed in ”ADC Conversion Result” on  
page 134.  
20.7.7  
ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B  
Bit  
7
BIN  
R/W  
0
6
ACME  
R/W  
0
5
IPR  
R/W  
0
4
3
2
ADTS2  
R/W  
0
1
ADTS1  
R/W  
0
0
ADTS0  
R/W  
0
0x03  
ADCSRB  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7 – BIN: Bipolar Input Mode  
The gain stage is working in the unipolar mode as default, but the bipolar mode can be selected  
by writing the BIN bit in the ADCSRB register. In the unipolar mode only one-sided conversions  
are supported and the voltage on the positive input must always be larger than the voltage on  
the negative input. Otherwise the result is saturated to the voltage reference. In the bipolar mode  
two-sided conversions are supported and the result is represented in the two’s complement  
form. In the unipolar mode the resolution is 10 bits and the bipolar mode the resolution is 9 bits +  
1 sign bit.  
139  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
• Bits 5 – IPR: Input Polarity Reversal  
The Input Polarity mode allows software selectable differential input pairs and full 10 bit ADC  
resolution, in the unipolar input mode, assuming a pre-determined input polarity. If the input  
polarity is not known it is actually possible to determine the polarity first by using the bipolar input  
mode (with 9 bit resolution + 1 sign bit ADC measurement). And once determined, set or clear  
the polarity reversal bit, as needed, for a succeeding 10 bit unipolar measurement.  
• Bits 4:3 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and will always read as zero.  
• Bits 2:0 – ADTS2:0: ADC Auto Trigger Source  
If ADATE in ADCSRA is written to one, the value of these bits selects which source will trigger  
an ADC conversion. If ADATE is cleared, the ADTS2:0 settings will have no effect. A conversion  
will be triggered by the rising edge of the selected Interrupt Flag. Note that switching from a trig-  
ger source that is cleared to a trigger source that is set, will generate a positive edge on the  
trigger signal. If ADEN in ADCSRA is set, this will start a conversion. Switching to Free Running  
mode (ADTS[2:0]=0) will not cause a trigger event, even if the ADC Interrupt Flag is set.  
Table 20-5. ADC Auto Trigger Source Selections  
ADTS2  
ADTS1  
ADTS0  
Trigger Source  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
Free Running mode  
Analog Comparator  
External Interrupt Request 0  
Timer/Counter Compare Match A  
Timer/Counter Overflow  
Timer/Counter Compare Match B  
Pin Change Interrupt Request  
20.7.8  
DIDR0 – Digital Input Disable Register 0  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x14  
ADC0D  
R/W  
0
ADC2D  
R/W  
0
ADC3D  
R/W  
0
ADC1D  
R/W  
0
AIN1D  
R/W  
0
AIN0D  
R/W  
0
DIDR0  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
• Bits 5:2 – ADC3D:ADC0D: ADC3:0 Digital Input Disable  
When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the corresponding ADC pin is dis-  
abled. The corresponding PIN register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an  
analog signal is applied to the ADC3:0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this  
bit should be written logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer.  
140  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
20.8 Temperature Measurement  
The temperature measurement is based on an on-chip temperature sensor that is coupled to a  
single ended ADC4 channel. Selecting the ADC4 channel by writing the MUX3..0 bits in ADMUX  
register to “1111” enables the temperature sensor. The internal 1.1V voltage reference must  
also be selected for the ADC voltage reference source in the temperature sensor measurement.  
When the temperature sensor is enabled, the ADC converter can be used in single conversion  
mode to measure the voltage over the temperature sensor.  
The measured voltage has a linear relationship to the temperature as described in Table 20-6 on  
page 141. The voltage sensitivity is approximately 1 mV/°C and the accuracy of the temperature  
measurement is +/- 10°C after bandgap calibration.  
Table 20-6. Temperature vs. Sensor Output Voltage (Typical Case)  
Temperature / °C  
-45 °C  
+25 °C  
+105 °C  
Voltage / mV  
242 mV  
314 mv  
403 mV  
The values described in Table 20-6 on page 141 are typical values. However, due to the process  
variation the temperature sensor output voltage varies from one chip to another. To be capable  
of achieving more accurate results the temperature measurement can be calibrated in the appli-  
cation software. The software calibration requires that a calibration value is measured and  
stored in a register or EEPROM for each chip, as a part of the production test. The sofware cali-  
bration can be done utilizing the formula:  
T = { [ (ADCH << 8) | ADCL ] - TOS } / k  
where ADCn are the ADC data registers, kis a fixed coefficient and TOS is the temperature sen-  
sor offset value determined and stored into EEPROM as a part of the production test.  
141  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
21. debugWIRE On-chip Debug System  
21.1 Features  
Complete Program Flow Control  
Emulates All On-chip Functions, Both Digital and Analog , except RESET Pin  
Real-time Operation  
Symbolic Debugging Support (Both at C and Assembler Source Level, or for Other HLLs)  
Unlimited Number of Program Break Points (Using Software Break Points)  
Non-intrusive Operation  
Electrical Characteristics Identical to Real Device  
Automatic Configuration System  
High-Speed Operation  
Programming of Non-volatile Memories  
21.2 Overview  
The debugWIRE On-chip debug system uses a One-wire, bi-directional interface to control the  
program flow, execute AVR instructions in the CPU and to program the different non-volatile  
memories.  
21.3 Physical Interface  
When the debugWIRE Enable (DWEN) Fuse is programmed and Lock bits are unprogrammed,  
the debugWIRE system within the target device is activated. The RESET port pin is configured  
as a wire-AND (open-drain) bi-directional I/O pin with pull-up enabled and becomes the commu-  
nication gateway between target and emulator.  
Figure 21-1. The debugWIRE Setup  
1.8 - 5.5V  
VCC  
dW  
dW(RESET)  
GND  
Figure 21-1 shows the schematic of a target MCU, with debugWIRE enabled, and the emulator  
connector. The system clock is not affected by debugWIRE and will always be the clock source  
selected by the CKSEL Fuses.  
142  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
When designing a system where debugWIRE will be used, the following observations must be  
made for correct operation:  
• Pull-Up resistor on the dW/(RESET) line must be in the range of 10k to 20 k. However, the  
pull-up resistor is optional.  
• Connecting the RESET pin directly to VCC will not work.  
• Capacitors inserted on the RESET pin must be disconnected when using debugWire.  
• All external reset sources must be disconnected.  
21.4 Software Break Points  
debugWIRE supports Program memory Break Points by the AVR Break instruction. Setting a  
Break Point in AVR Studio® will insert a BREAK instruction in the Program memory. The instruc-  
tion replaced by the BREAK instruction will be stored. When program execution is continued, the  
stored instruction will be executed before continuing from the Program memory. A break can be  
inserted manually by putting the BREAK instruction in the program.  
The Flash must be re-programmed each time a Break Point is changed. This is automatically  
handled by AVR Studio through the debugWIRE interface. The use of Break Points will therefore  
reduce the Falsh Data retention. Devices used for debugging purposes should not be shipped to  
end customers.  
21.5 Limitations of debugWIRE  
The debugWIRE communication pin (dW) is physically located on the same pin as External  
Reset (RESET). An External Reset source is therefore not supported when the debugWIRE is  
enabled.  
The debugWIRE system accurately emulates all I/O functions when running at full speed, i.e.,  
when the program in the CPU is running. When the CPU is stopped, care must be taken while  
accessing some of the I/O Registers via the debugger (AVR Studio).  
A programmed DWEN Fuse enables some parts of the clock system to be running in all sleep  
modes. This will increase the power consumption while in sleep. Thus, the DWEN Fuse should  
be disabled when debugWire is not used.  
21.6 debugWIRE Related Register in I/O Memory  
The following section describes the registers used with the debugWire.  
21.6.1  
DWDR – debugWire Data Register  
Bit  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x22  
DWDR[7:0]  
DWDR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
The DWDR Register provides a communication channel from the running program in the MCU  
to the debugger. This register is only accessible by the debugWIRE and can therefore not be  
used as a general purpose register in the normal operations.  
143  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
22. Self-Programming the Flash  
The device provides a Self-Programming mechanism for downloading and uploading program  
code by the MCU itself. The Self-Programming can use any available data interface and associ-  
ated protocol to read code and write (program) that code into the Program memory.  
The Program memory is updated in a page by page fashion. Before programming a page with  
the data stored in the temporary page buffer, the page must be erased. The temporary page  
buffer is filled one word at a time using SPM and the buffer can be filled either before the Page  
Erase command or between a Page Erase and a Page Write operation:  
Alternative 1, fill the buffer before a Page Erase  
• Fill temporary page buffer  
• Perform a Page Erase  
• Perform a Page Write  
Alternative 2, fill the buffer after Page Erase  
• Perform a Page Erase  
• Fill temporary page buffer  
• Perform a Page Write  
If only a part of the page needs to be changed, the rest of the page must be stored (for example  
in the temporary page buffer) before the erase, and then be re-written. When using alternative 1,  
the Boot Loader provides an effective Read-Modify-Write feature which allows the user software  
to first read the page, do the necessary changes, and then write back the modified data. If alter-  
native 2 is used, it is not possible to read the old data while loading since the page is already  
erased. The temporary page buffer can be accessed in a random sequence. It is essential that  
the page address used in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation is addressing the same  
page.  
22.0.1  
22.0.2  
Performing Page Erase by SPM  
To execute Page Erase, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “00000011” to SPMCSR and  
execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored.  
The page address must be written to PCPAGE in the Z-register. Other bits in the Z-pointer will  
be ignored during this operation.  
• The CPU is halted during the Page Erase operation.  
Filling the Temporary Buffer (Page Loading)  
To write an instruction word, set up the address in the Z-pointer and data in R1:R0, write  
“00000001” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The  
content of PCWORD in the Z-register is used to address the data in the temporary buffer. The  
temporary buffer will auto-erase after a Page Write operation or by writing the CTPB bit in  
SPMCSR. It is also erased after a system reset. Note that it is not possible to write more than  
one time to each address without erasing the temporary buffer.  
If the EEPROM is written in the middle of an SPM Page Load operation, all data loaded will be  
lost.  
22.0.3  
144  
Performing a Page Write  
To execute Page Write, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “00000101” to SPMCSR and  
execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored.  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
The page address must be written to PCPAGE. Other bits in the Z-pointer must be written to  
zero during this operation.  
• The CPU is halted during the Page Write operation.  
22.1 Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming  
The Z-pointer is used to address the SPM commands.  
Bit  
15  
Z15  
Z7  
7
14  
Z14  
Z6  
6
13  
Z13  
Z5  
5
12  
Z12  
Z4  
4
11  
Z11  
Z3  
3
10  
Z10  
Z2  
2
9
8
ZH (R31)  
ZL (R30)  
Z9  
Z1  
1
Z8  
Z0  
0
Since the Flash is organized in pages (see Table 23-6 on page 152), the Program Counter can  
be treated as having two different sections. One section, consisting of the least significant bits, is  
addressing the words within a page, while the most significant bits are addressing the pages.  
This is shown in Figure 22-1. Note that the Page Erase and Page Write operations are  
addressed independently. Therefore it is of major importance that the software addresses the  
same page in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation.  
The LPM instruction uses the Z-pointer to store the address. Since this instruction addresses the  
Flash byte-by-byte, also the LSB (bit Z0) of the Z-pointer is used.  
Figure 22-1. Addressing the Flash During SPM(1)  
BIT 15  
ZPCMSB  
ZPAGEMSB  
1
0
0
Z - REGISTER  
PCMSB  
PAGEMSB  
PCWORD  
PROGRAM  
COUNTER  
PCPAGE  
PAGE ADDRESS  
WITHIN THE FLASH  
WORD ADDRESS  
WITHIN A PAGE  
PROGRAM MEMORY  
PAGE  
PAGE  
INSTRUCTION WORD  
PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]:  
00  
01  
02  
PAGEEND  
Note:  
1. The different variables used in Figure 22-1 are listed in Table 23-6 on page 152.  
145  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
22.1.1  
SPMCSR – Store Program Memory Control and Status Register  
The Store Program Memory Control and Status Register contains the control bits needed to con-  
trol the Program memory operations.  
Bit  
7
R
0
6
R
0
5
R
0
4
3
2
1
0
0x37  
CTPB  
R/W  
0
RFLB  
R/W  
0
PGWRT  
R/W  
0
PGERS  
R/W  
0
SPMEN  
R/W  
0
SPMCSR  
Read/Write  
Initial Value  
• Bits 7:5 – Res: Reserved Bits  
These bits are reserved bits in the ATtiny25/45/85 and always read as zero.  
• Bit 4 – CTPB: Clear Temporary Page Buffer  
If the CTPB bit is written while filling the temporary page buffer, the temporary page buffer will be  
cleared and the data will be lost.  
• Bit 3 – RFLB: Read Fuse and Lock Bits  
An LPM instruction within three cycles after RFLB and SPMEN are set in the SPMCSR Register,  
will read either the Lock bits or the Fuse bits (depending on Z0 in the Z-pointer) into the destina-  
tion register. See ”EEPROM Write Prevents Writing to SPMCSR” on page 146 for details.  
• Bit 2 – PGWRT: Page Write  
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock  
cycles executes Page Write, with the data stored in the temporary buffer. The page address is  
taken from the high part of the Z-pointer. The data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGWRT bit  
will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Write, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four  
clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire Page Write operation.  
• Bit 1 – PGERS: Page Erase  
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock  
cycles executes Page Erase. The page address is taken from the high part of the Z-pointer. The  
data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGERS bit will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Erase,  
or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire  
Page Write operation.  
• Bit 0 – SPMEN: Store Program Memory Enable  
This bit enables the SPM instruction for the next four clock cycles. If written to one together with  
either CTPB, RFLB, PGWRT, or PGERS, the following SPM instruction will have a special  
meaning, see description above. If only SPMEN is written, the following SPM instruction will  
store the value in R1:R0 in the temporary page buffer addressed by the Z-pointer. The LSB of  
the Z-pointer is ignored. The SPMEN bit will auto-clear upon completion of an SPM instruction,  
or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. During Page Erase and Page Write,  
the SPMEN bit remains high until the operation is completed.  
Writing any other combination than “10001”, “01001”, “00101”, “00011” or “00001” in the lower  
five bits will have no effect.  
22.1.2  
146  
EEPROM Write Prevents Writing to SPMCSR  
Note that an EEPROM write operation will block all software programming to Flash. Reading the  
Fuses and Lock bits from software will also be prevented during the EEPROM write operation. It  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
is recommended that the user checks the status bit (EEPE) in the EECR Register and verifies  
that the bit is cleared before writing to the SPMCSR Register.  
22.1.3  
Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software  
It is possible to read both the Fuse and Lock bits from software. To read the Lock bits, load the  
Z-pointer with 0x0001 and set the RFLB and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an LPM instruction  
is executed within three CPU cycles after the RFLB and SPMEN bits are set in SPMCSR, the  
value of the Lock bits will be loaded in the destination register. The RFLB and SPMEN bits will  
auto-clear upon completion of reading the Lock bits or if no LPM instruction is executed within  
three CPU cycles or no SPM instruction is executed within four CPU cycles. When RFLB and  
SPMEN are cleared, LPM will work as described in the Instruction set Manual.  
Bit  
Rd  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LB2  
LB1  
The algorithm for reading the Fuse Low byte is similar to the one described above for reading  
the Lock bits. To read the Fuse Low byte, load the Z-pointer with 0x0000 and set the RFLB and  
SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after the  
RFLB and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR, the value of the Fuse Low byte (FLB) will be  
loaded in the destination register as shown below. Refer to Table 23-5 on page 151 for a  
detailed description and mapping of the Fuse Low byte.  
Bit  
Rd  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FLB7  
FLB6  
FLB5  
FLB4  
FLB3  
FLB2  
FLB1  
FLB0  
Similarly, when reading the Fuse High byte, load 0x0003 in the Z-pointer. When an LPM instruc-  
tion is executed within three cycles after the RFLB and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR, the  
value of the Fuse High byte (FHB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown below.  
Refer to Table XXX on page XXX for detailed description and mapping of the Fuse High byte.  
Bit  
Rd  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FHB7  
FHB6  
FHB5  
FHB4  
FHB3  
FHB2  
FHB1  
FHB0  
Fuse and Lock bits that are programmed, will be read as zero. Fuse and Lock bits that are  
unprogrammed, will be read as one.  
22.1.4  
Preventing Flash Corruption  
During periods of low VCC, the Flash program can be corrupted because the supply voltage is  
too low for the CPU and the Flash to operate properly. These issues are the same as for board  
level systems using the Flash, and the same design solutions should be applied.  
A Flash program corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First, a  
regular write sequence to the Flash requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Secondly,  
the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage for executing instructions  
is too low.  
Flash corruption can easily be avoided by following these design recommendations (one is  
sufficient):  
1. Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage.  
This can be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD) if the operating volt-  
age matches the detection level. If not, an external low VCC reset protection circuit can be  
147  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be  
completed provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient.  
2. Keep the AVR core in Power-down sleep mode during periods of low VCC. This will pre-  
vent the CPU from attempting to decode and execute instructions, effectively protecting  
the SPMCSR Register and thus the Flash from unintentional writes.  
22.1.5  
Programming Time for Flash when Using SPM  
The calibrated RC Oscillator is used to time Flash accesses. Table 22-1 shows the typical pro-  
gramming time for Flash accesses from the CPU.  
Table 22-1. SPM Programming Time  
Symbol  
Min Programming Time  
Max Programming Time  
Flash write (Page Erase, Page Write, and  
write Lock bits by SPM)  
3.7 ms  
4.5 ms  
148  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
23. Memory Programming  
This section describes the different methods for Programming the ATtiny25/45/85 memories.  
23.1 Program And Data Memory Lock Bits  
The ATtiny25/45/85 provides two Lock bits which can be left unprogrammed (“1”) or can be pro-  
grammed (“0”) to obtain the additional security listed in Table 23-2. The Lock bits can only be  
erased to “1” with the Chip Erase command.  
Program memory can be read out via the debugWIRE interface when the DWEN fuse is pro-  
grammed, even if the Lock Bits are set. Thus, when Lock Bit security is required, should always  
debugWIRE be disabled by clearing the DWEN fuse.  
Table 23-1. Lock Bit Byte(1)  
Lock Bit Byte  
Bit No  
Description  
Default Value  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
LB2  
LB1  
Lock bit  
Lock bit  
Note:  
1. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed  
Table 23-2. Lock Bit Protection Modes(1)(2)  
Memory Lock Bits Protection Type  
LB Mode  
LB2  
LB1  
1
2
1
1
No memory lock features enabled.  
Further programming of the Flash and EEPROM is disabled in  
High-voltage and Serial Programming mode. The Fuse bits are  
locked in both Serial and High-voltage Programming mode.(1)  
debugWire is disabled.  
1
0
0
0
Further programming and verification of the Flash and EEPROM  
is disabled in High-voltage and Serial Programming mode. The  
Fuse bits are locked in both Serial and High-voltage  
Programming mode.(1) debugWire is disabled.  
3
Notes: 1. Program the Fuse bits before programming the LB1 and LB2.  
2. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed  
149  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
23.2 Fuse Bytes  
The ATtiny25/45/85 has three Fuse bytes. Table 23-4, Table 23-5 and Table61 describe briefly  
the functionality of all the fuses and how they are mapped into the Fuse bytes. Note that the  
fuses are read as logical zero, “0”, if they are programmed.  
Table 23-3. Fuse Extended Byte  
Fuse High Byte  
Bit No Description  
Default Value  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
-
-
-
-
-
-
SELFPRGEN  
Self-Programming Enable  
Table 23-4. Fuse High Byte  
Fuse High Byte  
RSTDISBL(1)  
DWEN(2)  
Bit No Description  
Default Value  
7
6
External Reset disable  
DebugWIRE Enable  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
Enable Serial Program and Data  
Downloading  
0 (programmed, SPI prog.  
enabled)  
SPIEN(3)  
WDTON(4)  
EESAVE  
6
4
3
Watchdog Timer always on  
1 (unprogrammed)  
EEPROM memory is preserved  
through the Chip Erase  
1 (unprogrammed, EEPROM  
not preserved)  
BODLEVEL2(5)  
BODLEVEL1(5)  
BODLEVEL0(5)  
2
1
0
Brown-out Detector trigger level  
Brown-out Detector trigger level  
Brown-out Detector trigger level  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)  
Notes: 1. See ”Alternate Functions of Port B” on page 59 for description of RSTDISBL and DWEN  
Fuses.  
2. DWEN must be unprogrammed when Lock Bit security is required. See Section “23.1” on page  
149.  
3. The SPIEN Fuse is not accessible in SPI Programming mode.  
4. See ”WDTCR – Watchdog Timer Control Register” on page 42 for details.  
5. See Table 9-2 on page 38 for BODLEVEL Fuse decoding.  
6. When programming the RSTDISBL Fuse, High-voltage Serial programming has to be used to  
change fuses to perform further programming.  
150  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 23-5. Fuse Low Byte  
Fuse Low Byte  
CKDIV8(1)  
CKOUT(2)  
SUT1  
Bit No Description  
Default Value  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Divide clock by 8  
0 (programmed)  
Clock Output Enable  
Select start-up time  
Select start-up time  
Select Clock source  
Select Clock source  
Select Clock source  
Select Clock source  
1 (unprogrammed)  
1 (unprogrammed)(3)  
0 (programmed)(3)  
0 (programmed)(4)  
0 (programmed)(4)  
1 (unprogrammed)(4)  
0 (programmed)(4)  
SUT0  
CKSEL3  
CKSEL2  
CKSEL1  
CKSEL0  
Notes: 1. See ”System Clock Prescaler” on page 30 for details.  
2. The CKOUT Fuse allows the system clock to be output on PORTB4. See “Clock Output Buffer”  
on page 30 for details.  
3. The default value of SUT1..0 results in maximum start-up time for the default clock source.  
See Table 7-7 on page 27 for details.  
4. The default setting of CKSEL1..0 results in internal RC Oscillator @ 8.0 MHz. See Table 7-6  
on page 27 for details.  
The status of the Fuse bits is not affected by Chip Erase. Note that the Fuse bits are locked if  
Lock bit1 (LB1) is programmed. Program the Fuse bits before programming the Lock bits.  
23.2.1  
Latching of Fuses  
The fuse values are latched when the device enters programming mode and changes of the  
fuse values will have no effect until the part leaves Programming mode. This does not apply to  
the EESAVE Fuse which will take effect once it is programmed. The fuses are also latched on  
Power-up in Normal mode.  
23.3 Signature Bytes  
All Atmel microcontrollers have a three-byte signature code which identifies the device. This  
code can be read in both serial and High-voltage Programming mode, also when the device is  
locked. The three bytes reside in a separate address space.  
23.3.1  
23.3.2  
23.3.3  
ATtiny25 Signature Bytes  
1. 0x000: 0x1E (indicates manufactured by Atmel).  
2. 0x001: 0x91 (indicates 2 KB Flash memory).  
3. 0x002: 0x08 (indicates ATtiny25 device when 0x001 is 0x91).  
ATtiny45 Signature Bytes  
1. 0x000: 0x1E (indicates manufactured by Atmel).  
2. 0x001: 0x92 (indicates 4 KB Flash memory).  
3. 0x002: 0x06 (indicates ATtiny45 device when 0x001 is 0x92).  
ATtiny85 Signature Bytes  
1. 0x000: 0x1E (indicates manufactured by Atmel).  
2. 0x001: 0x93 (indicates 8 KB Flash memory).  
3. 0x002: 0x0B (indicates ATtiny85 device when 0x001 is 0x93).  
151  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
23.4 Calibration Byte  
Signature area of the ATtiny25/45/85 has one byte of calibration data for the internal RC Oscilla-  
tor. This byte resides in the high byte of address 0x000. During reset, this byte is automatically  
written into the OSCCAL Register to ensure correct frequency of the calibrated RC Oscillator.  
23.5 Page Size  
Table 23-6. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash  
Device  
Flash Size  
Page Size  
PCWORD  
No. of Pages  
PCPAGE  
PCMSB  
1K words  
(2K bytes)  
ATtiny25  
16 words  
PC[3:0]  
64  
PC[9:4]  
9
2K words  
(4K bytes)  
ATtiny45  
ATtiny85  
32 words  
32 words  
PC[4:0]  
PC[4:0]  
64  
PC[10:5]  
PC[11:5]  
10  
11  
4K words  
(8K bytes)  
128  
Table 23-7. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the EEPROM  
EEPROM  
Device  
ATtiny25  
ATtiny45  
ATtiny85  
Size  
Page Size  
4 bytes  
PCWORD  
EEA[1:0]  
EEA[1:0]  
EEA[1:0]  
No. of Pages  
PCPAGE  
EEA[6:2]  
EEA[7:2]  
EEA[8:2]  
EEAMSB  
128 bytes  
256 bytes  
512 bytes  
32  
64  
6
7
8
4 bytes  
4 bytes  
128  
152  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
23.6 Serial Downloading  
Both the Flash and EEPROM memory arrays can be programmed using the serial SPI bus while  
RESET is pulled to GND. The serial interface consists of pins SCK, MOSI (input) and MISO (out-  
put). After RESET is set low, the Programming Enable instruction needs to be executed first  
before program/erase operations can be executed. NOTE, in Table 23-8 on page 153, the pin  
mapping for SPI programming is listed. Not all parts use the SPI pins dedicated for the internal  
SPI interface.  
Figure 23-1. Serial Programming and Verify(1)  
+1.8 - 5.5V  
VCC  
MOSI  
MISO  
SCK  
RESET  
GND  
Notes: 1. If the device is clocked by the internal Oscillator, it is no need to connect a clock source to the  
CLKI pin.  
Table 23-8. Pin Mapping Serial Programming  
Symbol  
MOSI  
MISO  
SCK  
Pins  
PB0  
PB1  
PB2  
I/O  
Description  
Serial Data in  
Serial Data out  
Serial Clock  
I
O
I
When programming the EEPROM, an auto-erase cycle is built into the self-timed programming  
operation (in the Serial mode ONLY) and there is no need to first execute the Chip Erase  
instruction. The Chip Erase operation turns the content of every memory location in both the  
Program and EEPROM arrays into 0xFF.  
Depending on CKSEL Fuses, a valid clock must be present. The minimum low and high periods  
for the serial clock (SCK) input are defined as follows:  
Low: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz  
High: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz  
153  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
23.6.1  
Serial Programming Algorithm  
When writing serial data to the ATtiny25/45/85, data is clocked on the rising edge of SCK.  
When reading data from the ATtiny25/45/85, data is clocked on the falling edge of SCK. See  
Figure 23-3 and Figure 23-4 for timing details.  
To program and verify the ATtiny25/45/85 in the Serial Programming mode, the following  
sequence is recommended (see four byte instruction formats in Table 23-10):  
1. Power-up sequence:  
Apply power between VCC and GND while RESET and SCK are set to “0”. In some sys-  
tems, the programmer can not guarantee that SCK is held low during power-up. In this  
case, RESET must be given a positive pulse of at least two CPU clock cycles duration  
after SCK has been set to “0”.  
2. Wait for at least 20 ms and enable serial programming by sending the Programming  
Enable serial instruction to pin MOSI.  
3. The serial programming instructions will not work if the communication is out of synchro-  
nization. When in sync. the second byte (0x53), will echo back when issuing the third  
byte of the Programming Enable instruction. Whether the echo is correct or not, all four  
bytes of the instruction must be transmitted. If the 0x53 did not echo back, give RESET a  
positive pulse and issue a new Programming Enable command.  
4. The Flash is programmed one page at a time. The memory page is loaded one byte at a  
time by supplying the 5 LSB of the address and data together with the Load Program  
memory Page instruction. To ensure correct loading of the page, the data low byte must  
be loaded before data high byte is applied for a given address. The Program memory  
Page is stored by loading the Write Program memory Page instruction with the 6 MSB of  
the address. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not used, the user must wait at least tWD_FLASH before  
issuing the next page. (See Table 23-9.) Accessing the serial programming interface  
before the Flash write operation completes can result in incorrect programming.  
5. A: The EEPROM array is programmed one byte at a time by supplying the address and  
data together with the appropriate Write instruction. An EEPROM memory location is first  
automatically erased before new data is written. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not used, the  
user must wait at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next byte. (See Table 23-9.) In a  
chip erased device, no 0xFFs in the data file(s) need to be programmed.  
B: The EEPROM array is programmed one page at a time. The Memory page is loaded  
one byte at a time by supplying the 2 LSB of the address and data together with the Load  
EEPROM Memory Page instruction. The EEPROM Memory Page is stored by loading  
the Write EEPROM Memory Page Instruction with the 6 MSB of the address. When using  
EEPROM page access only byte locations loaded with the Load EEPROM Memory Page  
instruction is altered. The remaining locations remain unchanged. If polling (RDY/BSY) is  
not used, the used must wait at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next page (See Table  
23-7). In a chip erased device, no 0xFF in the data file(s) need to be programmed.  
6. Any memory location can be verified by using the Read instruction which returns the con-  
tent at the selected address at serial output MISO.  
7. At the end of the programming session, RESET can be set high to commence normal  
operation.  
8. Power-off sequence (if needed):  
Set RESET to “1”.  
Turn VCC power off.  
154  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 23-9. Minimum Wait Delay Before Writing the Next Flash or EEPROM Location  
Symbol  
Minimum Wait Delay  
tWD_FLASH  
tWD_EEPROM  
tWD_ERASE  
tWD_FUSE  
4.5 ms  
4.0 ms  
4.0 ms  
4.5 ms  
23.6.2  
Serial Programming Instruction set  
Table 23-10 on page 155 and Figure 23-2 on page 156 describes the Instruction set.  
Table 23-10. Serial Programming Instruction Set  
Instruction Format  
Instruction/Operation  
Byte 1  
$AC  
Byte 2  
Byte 3  
$00  
Byte4  
$00  
Programming Enable  
$53  
$80  
$00  
Chip Erase (Program Memory/EEPROM)  
Poll RDY/BSY  
$AC  
$00  
$00  
$F0  
$00  
data byte out  
Load Instructions  
Load Extended Address byte(1)  
Load Program Memory Page, High byte  
Load Program Memory Page, Low byte  
Load EEPROM Memory Page (page access)  
Read Instructions  
$4D  
$48  
$40  
$C1  
$00  
adr MSB  
adr MSB  
$00  
Extended adr  
adr LSB  
$00  
high data byte in  
low data byte in  
data byte in  
adr LSB  
0000 000aa  
Read Program Memory, High byte  
Read Program Memory, Low byte  
Read EEPROM Memory  
Read Lock bits  
$28  
$20  
$A0  
$58  
$30  
$50  
$58  
$50  
$38  
adr MSB  
adr MSB  
$00  
adr LSB  
adr LSB  
00aa aaaa  
$00  
high data byte out  
low data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
data byte out  
$00  
Read Signature Byte  
$00  
0000 000aa  
$00  
Read Fuse bits  
$00  
Read Fuse High bits  
$08  
$00  
Read Extended Fuse Bits  
Read Calibration Byte  
$08  
$00  
$00  
$00  
Write Instructions  
Write Program Memory Page  
Write EEPROM Memory  
Write EEPROM Memory Page (page access)  
Write Lock bits  
$4C  
$C0  
$C2  
$AC  
adr MSB  
$00  
adr LSB  
00aa aaaa  
00aa aa00  
$00  
$00  
data byte in  
$00  
$00  
$E0  
data byte in  
155  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 23-10. Serial Programming Instruction Set (Continued)  
Instruction Format  
Instruction/Operation  
Write Fuse bits  
Byte 1  
$AC  
Byte 2  
Byte 3  
$00  
Byte4  
$A0  
$A8  
$A4  
data byte in  
data byte in  
data byte in  
Write Fuse High bits  
Write Extended Fuse Bits  
$AC  
$00  
$AC  
$00  
Notes: 1. Not all instructions are applicable for all parts.  
2. a = address  
3. Bits are programmed ‘0’, unprogrammed ‘1’.  
4. To ensure future compatibility, unused Fuses and Lock bits should be unprogrammed (‘1’) .  
5. Refer to the correspondig section for Fuse and Lock bits, Calibration and Signature bytes and  
Page size.  
6. See htt://www.atmel.com/avr for Application Notes regarding programming and programmers.  
If the LSB in RDY/BSY data byte out is ‘1’, a programming operation is still pending. Wait until  
this bit returns ‘0’ before the next instruction is carried out.  
Within the same page, the low data byte must be loaded prior to the high data byte.  
After data is loaded to the page buffer, program the EEPROM page, see Figure 23-2 on page  
156.  
Figure 23-2. Serial Programming Instruction example  
Serial Programming Instruction  
Load Program Memory Page (High/Low Byte)/  
Load EEPROM Memory Page (page access)  
Write Program Memory Page/  
Write EEPROM Memory Page  
Byte 1  
Byte 2  
Byte 3  
Byte 4  
Byte 1  
Byte 2  
Byte 3  
Byte 4  
Adr MSB  
Adr LSB  
Adr MSB  
Adr LSB  
Bit 15 B  
0
Bit 15 B  
0
Page Buffer  
Page Offset  
Page 0  
Page 1  
Page 2  
Page Number  
Page N-1  
Program Memory/  
EEPROM Memory  
156  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
23.6.3  
Serial Programming Characteristics  
Figure 23-3. Serial Programming Waveforms  
SERIAL DATA INPUT  
(MOSI)  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
SERIAL DATA OUTPUT  
(MISO)  
MSB  
SERIAL CLOCK INPUT  
(SCK)  
SAMPLE  
Figure 23-4. Serial Programming Timing  
MOSI  
tOVSH  
tSLSH  
tSHOX  
SCK  
tSHSL  
MISO  
tSLIV  
Table 23-11. Serial Programming Characteristics, TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8 - 5.5V (Unless  
Otherwise Noted)  
Symbol  
1/tCLCL  
tCLCL  
Parameter  
Min  
0
Typ  
Max  
Units  
MHz  
ns  
Oscillator Frequency (ATtiny25/45/85V)  
Oscillator Period (ATtiny25/45/85V)  
4
250  
Oscillator Frequency (ATtiny25/45/85L, VCC = 2.7 -  
5.5V)  
1/tCLCL  
tCLCL  
0
100  
0
10  
20  
MHz  
ns  
Oscillator Period (ATtiny25/45/85L, VCC = 2.7 - 5.5V)  
Oscillator Frequency (ATtiny25/45/85, VCC = 4.5V -  
5.5V)  
1/tCLCL  
MHz  
tCLCL  
tSHSL  
tSLSH  
tOVSH  
tSHOX  
tSLIV  
Oscillator Period (ATtiny25/45/85, VCC = 4.5V - 5.5V)  
SCK Pulse Width High  
50  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
2 tCLCL*  
SCK Pulse Width Low  
2 tCLCL  
*
MOSI Setup to SCK High  
tCLCL  
MOSI Hold after SCK High  
SCK Low to MISO Valid  
2 tCLCL  
TBD  
TBD  
TBD  
Note:  
1. 2 tCLCL for fck < 12 MHz, 3 tCLCL for fck >= 12 MHz  
157  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
23.7 High-voltage Serial Programming  
This section describes how to program and verify Flash Program memory, EEPROM Data mem-  
ory, Lock bits and Fuse bits in the ATtiny25/45/85.  
Figure 23-5. High-voltage Serial Programming  
+11.5 - 12.5V  
+1.8 - 5.5V  
PB5  
PB3  
VCC  
PB2  
(RESET)  
SCI  
SDO  
SII  
PB1  
PB0  
GND  
SDI  
Table 23-12. Pin Name Mapping  
Signal Name in High-voltage  
Serial Programming Mode  
Pin Name  
PB0  
I/O  
Function  
Serial Data Input  
SDI  
SII  
I
PB1  
I
Serial Instruction Input  
SDO  
SCI  
PB2  
O
I
Serial Data Output  
PB3  
Serial Clock Input (min. 220ns period)  
The minimum period for the Serial Clock Input (SCI) during High-voltage Serial Programming is  
220 ns.  
Table 23-13. Pin Values Used to Enter Programming Mode  
Pin  
SDI  
SII  
Symbol  
Value  
Prog_enable[0]  
Prog_enable[1]  
Prog_enable[2]  
0
0
0
SDO  
158  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
23.8 High-voltage Serial Programming Algorithm  
To program and verify the ATtiny25/45/85 in the High-voltage Serial Programming mode, the fol-  
lowing sequence is recommended (See instruction formats in Table 23-15):  
23.8.1  
Enter High-voltage Serial Programming Mode  
The following algorithm puts the device in High-voltage Serial Programming mode:  
1. Set Prog_enable pins listed in Table 23-13 to “000”, RESET pin and VCC to 0V.  
2. Apply 4.5 - 5.5V between VCC and GND.  
Ensure that VCC reaches at least 1.8V within the next 20 µs.  
3. Wait 20 - 60 µs, and apply 11.5 - 12.5V to RESET.  
4. Keep the Prog_enable pins unchanged for at least 10 µs after the High-voltage has been  
applied to ensure the Prog_enable Signature has been latched.  
5. Release the Prog_enable[2] pin to avoid drive contention on the Prog_enable[2]/SDO  
pin.  
6. Wait at least 300 µs before giving any serial instructions on SDI/SII.  
7. Exit Programming mode by power the device down or by bringing RESET pin to 0V.  
If the rise time of the VCC is unable to fulfill the requirements listed above, the following alterna-  
tive algorithm can be used:  
1. Set Prog_enable pins listed in Table 23-13 to “000”, RESET pin and VCC to 0V.  
2. Apply 4.5 - 5.5V between VCC and GND.  
3. Monitor VCC, and as soon as VCC reaches 0.9 - 1.1V, apply 11.5 - 12.5V to RESET.  
4. Keep the Prog_enable pins unchanged for at least 10 µs after the High-voltage has been  
applied to ensure the Prog_enable Signature has been latched.  
5. Release the Prog_enable[2] pin to avoid drive contention on the Prog_enable[2]/SDO  
pin.  
6. Wait until VCC actually reaches 4.5 - 5.5V before giving any serial instructions on SDI/SII.  
7. Exit Programming mode by power the device down or by bringing RESET pin to 0V.  
Table 23-14. High-voltage Reset Characteristics  
Minimum High-voltage Period for  
Supply Voltage  
RESET Pin High-voltage Threshold  
Latching Prog_enable  
VCC  
VHVRST  
11.5V  
11.5V  
tHVRST  
100 ns  
100 ns  
4.5V  
5.5V  
23.8.2  
Considerations for Efficient Programming  
The loaded command and address are retained in the device during programming. For efficient  
programming, the following should be considered.  
• The command needs only be loaded once when writing or reading multiple memory locations.  
• Skip writing the data value 0xFF that is the contents of the entire EEPROM (unless the  
EESAVE Fuse is programmed) and Flash after a Chip Erase.  
159  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
• Address High byte needs only be loaded before programming or reading a new 256 word  
window in Flash or 256 byte EEPROM. This consideration also applies to Signature bytes  
reading.  
23.8.3  
Chip Erase  
The Chip Erase will erase the Flash and EEPROM(1) memories plus Lock bits. The Lock bits are  
not reset until the Program memory has been completely erased. The Fuse bits are not  
changed. A Chip Erase must be performed before the Flash and/or EEPROM are re-  
programmed.  
Note:  
1. The EEPROM memory is preserved during Chip Erase if the EESAVE Fuse is programmed.  
1. Load command “Chip Erase” (see Table 23-15).  
2. Wait after Instr. 3 until SDO goes high for the “Chip Erase” cycle to finish.  
3. Load Command “No Operation”.  
23.8.4  
Programming the Flash  
The Flash is organized in pages, see Table 23-10 on page 155. When programming the Flash,  
the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of program data to be pro-  
grammed simultaneously. The following procedure describes how to program the entire Flash  
memory:  
1. Load Command “Write Flash” (see Table 23-15).  
2. Load Flash Page Buffer.  
3. Load Flash High Address and Program Page. Wait after Instr. 3 until SDO goes high for  
the “Page Programming” cycle to finish.  
4. Repeat 2 through 3 until the entire Flash is programmed or until all data has been  
programmed.  
5. End Page Programming by Loading Command “No Operation”.  
When writing or reading serial data to the ATtiny25/45/85, data is clocked on the rising edge of  
the serial clock, see Figure 23-7, Figure 23-8 and Table 23-16 for details.  
Figure 23-6. Addressing the Flash which is Organized in Pages  
PCMSB  
PAGEMSB  
PCWORD  
PROGRAM  
COUNTER  
PCPAGE  
PAGE ADDRESS  
WITHIN THE FLASH  
WORD ADDRESS  
WITHIN A PAGE  
PROGRAM MEMORY  
PAGE  
PAGE  
INSTRUCTION WORD  
PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]:  
00  
01  
02  
PAGEEND  
160  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 23-7. High-voltage Serial Programming Waveforms  
SDI  
PB0  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
SII  
PB1  
MSB  
SDO  
PB2  
MSB  
LSB  
SCI  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
PB3  
23.8.5  
Programming the EEPROM  
The EEPROM is organized in pages, see Table 23-11 on page 157. When programming the  
EEPROM, the data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of data to be pro-  
grammed simultaneously. The programming algorithm for the EEPROM Data memory is as  
follows (refer to Table 23-15):  
1. Load Command “Write EEPROM”.  
2. Load EEPROM Page Buffer.  
3. Program EEPROM Page. Wait after Instr. 2 until SDO goes high for the “Page Program-  
ming” cycle to finish.  
4. Repeat 2 through 3 until the entire EEPROM is programmed or until all data has been  
programmed.  
5. End Page Programming by Loading Command “No Operation”.  
23.8.6  
23.8.7  
Reading the Flash  
The algorithm for reading the Flash memory is as follows (refer to Table 23-15):  
1. Load Command "Read Flash".  
2. Read Flash Low and High Bytes. The contents at the selected address are available at  
serial output SDO.  
Reading the EEPROM  
The algorithm for reading the EEPROM memory is as follows (refer to Table 23-15):  
1. Load Command “Read EEPROM”.  
2. Read EEPROM Byte. The contents at the selected address are available at serial output  
SDO.  
23.8.8  
23.8.9  
Programming and Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits  
The algorithms for programming and reading the Fuse Low/High bits and Lock bits are shown in  
Table 23-15.  
Reading the Signature Bytes and Calibration Byte  
The algorithms for reading the Signature bytes and Calibration byte are shown in Table 23-15.  
23.8.10 Power-off sequence  
Set SCI to “0”. Set RESET to “1”. Turn VCC power off.  
161  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 23-15. High-voltage Serial Programming Instruction Set for ATtiny25/45/85  
Instruction Format  
Instruction  
Instr.1/5  
Instr.2/6  
Instr.3  
Instr.4  
Operation Remarks  
SDI  
SII  
0_1000_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Wait after Instr.3 until SDO  
goes high for the Chip Erase  
cycle to finish.  
Chip Erase  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0001_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load “Write  
Flash”  
Command  
Enter Flash Programming  
code.  
SDO  
Repeat after Instr. 1 - 5 until  
the entire page buffer is filled  
or until all data within the  
page is filled. See Note 1.  
SDI  
SII  
0_ bbbb_bbbb _00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_eeee_eeee_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_dddd_dddd_00  
0_0011_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1101_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
SDO  
Load Flash  
Page Buffer  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Instr 5.  
SDO  
Wait after Instr 3 until SDO  
goes high. Repeat Instr. 2 - 3  
for each loaded Flash Page  
until the entire Flash or all  
data is programmed. Repeat  
Instr. 1 for a new 256 byte  
page. See Note 1.  
Load Flash  
High Address  
and Program  
Page  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_000a_00  
0_0001_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0010_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load “Read  
Flash”  
Command  
Enter Flash Read mode.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_bbbb_bbbb_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_000a_00  
0_0001_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
q_qqqq_qqqx_xx  
Repeat Instr. 1, 3 - 6 for each  
new address. Repeat Instr. 2  
for a new 256 byte page.  
Read Flash  
Low and High  
Bytes  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1100_00  
p_pppp_pppx_xx  
Instr 5 - 6.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0001_0001_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load “Write  
EEPROM”  
Command  
Enter EEPROM Programming  
mode.  
SDO  
Repeat Instr. 1 - 4 until the  
entire page buffer is filled or  
until all data within the page is  
filled. See Note 2.  
SDI  
SII  
0_00bb_bbbb_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_eeee_eeee_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1101_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load  
EEPROM  
Page Buffer  
SDO  
Wait after Instr. 2 until SDO  
goes high. Repeat Instr. 1 - 2  
for each loaded EEPROM  
page until the entire  
EEPROM or all data is  
programmed.  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Program  
EEPROM  
Page  
SDO  
162  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table 23-15. High-voltage Serial Programming Instruction Set for ATtiny25/45/85 (Continued)  
Instruction Format  
Instruction  
Instr.1/5  
Instr.2/6  
Instr.3  
Instr.4  
Operation Remarks  
Repeat Instr. 1 - 5 for each  
SDI  
SII  
0_00bb_bbbb_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_eeee_eeee_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1101_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
new address. Wait after Instr.  
5 until SDO goes high. See  
Note 3.  
Write  
SDO  
EEPROM  
Byte  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Instr. 5  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0011_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load “Read  
EEPROM”  
Command  
Enter EEPROM Read mode.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_bbbb_bbbb_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_aaaa_aaaa_00  
0_0001_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
q_qqqq_qqq0_00  
Read  
EEPROM  
Byte  
Repeat Instr. 1, 3 - 4 for each  
new address. Repeat Instr. 2  
for a new 256 byte page.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0100_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_A987_6543_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Wait after Instr. 4 until SDO  
goes high. Write A - 3 = “0” to  
program the Fuse bit.  
Write Fuse  
Low Bits  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0100_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_000F_EDCB_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Wait after Instr. 4 until SDO  
goes high. Write F - B = “0” to  
program the Fuse bit.  
Write Fuse  
High Bits  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0100_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_000J_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0110_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1110_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Wait after Instr. 4 until SDO  
goes high. Write J = “0” to  
program the Fuse bit.  
Write Fuse  
Extended Bits  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0010_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0021_00  
0_0010_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_0100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Wait after Instr. 4 until SDO  
goes high. Write 2 - 1 = “0” to  
program the Lock bit.  
Write Lock  
Bits  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0100_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
A_9876_543x_xx  
Read Fuse  
Low Bits  
Reading A - 3 = “0” means  
the Fuse bit is programmed.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0100_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1010_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1110_00  
x_xxFE_DCBx_xx  
Read Fuse  
High Bits  
Reading F - B = “0” means  
the Fuse bit is programmed.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0100_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1010_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1110_00  
x_xxxx_xxJx_xx  
Read Fuse  
Extended Bits  
Reading J = “0” means the  
Fuse bit is programmed.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0100_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1100_00  
x_xxxx_x21x_xx  
Read Lock  
Bits  
Reading 2, 1 = “0” means the  
Lock bit is programmed.  
SDO  
163  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Table 23-15. High-voltage Serial Programming Instruction Set for ATtiny25/45/85 (Continued)  
Instruction Format  
Instruction  
Instr.1/5  
Instr.2/6  
Instr.3  
Instr.4  
Operation Remarks  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_1000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_00bb_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0110_1100_00  
q_qqqq_qqqx_xx  
Read  
Signature  
Bytes  
Repeats Instr 2 4 for each  
signature byte address.  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_1000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0000_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1000_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0111_1100_00  
p_pppp_pppx_xx  
Read  
Calibration  
Byte  
SDO  
SDI  
SII  
0_0000_0000_00  
0_0100_1100_00  
x_xxxx_xxxx_xx  
Load “No  
Operation”  
Command  
SDO  
Note:  
a = address high bits, b = address low bits, d = data in high bits, e = data in low bits, p = data out high bits, q = data out low bits,  
x = don’t care, 1 = Lock Bit1, 2 = Lock Bit2, 3 = CKSEL0 Fuse, 4 = CKSEL1 Fuse, 5 = SUT0 Fuse, 6 = SUT1 Fuse, 7 = CKDIV8,  
Fuse, 8 = WDTON Fuse, 9 = EESAVE Fuse, A = SPIEN Fuse, B = RSTDISBL Fuse, C = BODLEVEL0 Fuse, D= BODLEVEL1  
Fuse, E = MONEN Fuse, F = SPMEN Fuse  
Notes: 1. For page sizes less than 256 words, parts of the address (bbbb_bbbb) will be parts of the page address.  
2. For page sizes less than 256 bytes, parts of the address (bbbb_bbbb) will be parts of the page address.  
3. The EEPROM is written page-wise. But only the bytes that are loaded into the page are actually written to the EEPROM.  
Page-wise EEPROM access is more efficient when multiple bytes are to be written to the same page. Note that auto-erase  
of EEPROM is not available in High-voltage Serial Programming, only in SPI Programming.  
23.9 High-voltage Serial Programming Characteristics  
Figure 23-8. High-voltage Serial Programming Timing  
CC  
CK  
Table 23-16. High-voltage Serial Programming Characteristics TA = 25°C ± 10%, VCC = 5.0V ±  
10% (Unless otherwise noted)  
Symbol  
tSHSL  
Parameter  
Min  
110  
110  
50  
Typ  
Max  
Units  
ns  
SCI (PB3) Pulse Width High  
tSLSH  
SCI (PB3) Pulse Width Low  
ns  
tIVSH  
SDI (PB0), SII (PB1) Valid to SCI (PB3) High  
SDI (PB0), SII (PB1) Hold after SCI (PB3) High  
SCI (PB3) High to SDO (PB2) Valid  
Wait after Instr. 3 for Write Fuse Bits  
ns  
tSHIX  
50  
ns  
tSHOV  
16  
ns  
tWLWH_PFB  
2.5  
ms  
164  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
24. Electrical Characteristics  
24.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings*  
*NOTICE:  
Stresses beyond those listed under “Absolute  
Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent dam-  
age to the device. This is a stress rating only and  
functional operation of the device at these or  
other conditions beyond those indicated in the  
operational sections of this specification is not  
implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating  
conditions for extended periods may affect  
device reliability.  
Operating Temperature.................................. -55°C to +125°C  
Storage Temperature..................................... -65°C to +150°C  
Voltage on any Pin except RESET  
with respect to Ground ................................-0.5V to VCC+0.5V  
Voltage on RESET with respect to Ground......-0.5V to +13.0V  
Maximum Operating Voltage ............................................ 6.0V  
DC Current per I/O Pin ............................................... 40.0 mA  
DC Current VCC and GND Pins................................ 200.0 mA  
24.2 DC Characteristics  
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted)(1)  
Symbol  
Parameter  
Condition  
Min.  
Typ.  
Max.  
Units  
Except XTAL1 and  
RESET pin  
VIL  
Input Low-voltage  
-0.5  
0.2VCC  
V
Except XTAL1 and  
RESET pin  
(3)  
(3)  
VIH  
Input High-voltage  
Input Low-voltage  
Input High-voltage  
0.6VCC  
-0.5  
VCC +0.5  
0.1VCC  
V
V
V
XTAL1 pin, External  
Clock Selected  
VIL1  
XTAL1 pin, External  
Clock Selected  
VIH1  
0.7VCC  
VCC +0.5  
VIL2  
VIH2  
VIL3  
VIH3  
Input Low-voltage  
Input High-voltage  
Input Low-voltage  
Input High-voltage  
RESET pin  
-0.5  
0.8VCC  
-0.5  
0.2VCC  
VCC +0.5  
0.2VCC  
V
V
V
V
(3)  
RESET pin  
RESET pin as I/O  
RESET pin as I/O  
(3)  
0.6VCC  
VCC +0.5  
Output Low Voltage(4)  
(Port B)  
IOL = 10 mA, VCC = 5V  
IOL = 5 mA, VCC = 3V  
0.6  
0.5  
V
V
VOL  
VOH  
IIL  
Output High-voltage(5)  
(Port B)  
I
OH = -10 mA, VCC = 5V  
4.3  
2.5  
V
V
IOH = -5 mA, VCC = 3V  
Input Leakage  
Current I/O Pin  
Vcc = 5.5V, pin low  
(absolute value)  
1
1
µA  
µA  
Input Leakage  
Current I/O Pin  
Vcc = 5.5V, pin high  
(absolute value)  
IIH  
RRST  
Rpu  
Reset Pull-up Resistor  
I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor  
30  
20  
60  
50  
kΩ  
kΩ  
165  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted)(1) (Continued)  
Symbol  
Parameter  
Condition  
Min.  
Typ.  
Max.  
0.55  
2.5  
8
Units  
mA  
mA  
mA  
mA  
mA  
mA  
µA  
Active 1MHz, VCC = 2V  
Active 4MHz, VCC = 3V  
Active 8MHz, VCC = 5V  
Idle 1MHz, VCC = 2V  
Idle 4MHz, VCC = 3V  
Idle 8MHz, VCC = 5V  
WDT enabled, VCC = 3V  
WDT disabled, VCC = 3V  
Power Supply Current  
0.2  
0.6  
2
ICC  
10  
Power-down mode  
2
µA  
Notes: 1. All DC Characteristics contained in this data sheet are based on simulation and characterization of other AVR microcontrol-  
lers manufactured in the same process technology. These values are preliminary values representing design targets, and  
will be updated after characterization of actual silicon.  
2. “Max” means the highest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as low.  
3. “Min” means the lowest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as high.  
4. Although each I/O port can sink more than the test conditions (10 mA at VCC = 5V, 5 mA at VCC = 3V) under steady state  
conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed:  
1] The sum of all IOL, for all ports, should not exceed 60 mA.  
If IOL exceeds the test condition, VOL may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to sink current greater  
than the listed test condition.  
5. Although each I/O port can source more than the test conditions (10 mA at VCC = 5V, 5 mA at VCC = 3V) under steady state  
conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed:  
1] The sum of all IOH, for all ports, should not exceed 60 mA.  
If IOH exceeds the test condition, VOH may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to source current  
greater than the listed test condition.  
24.3 External Clock Drive Waveforms  
Figure 24-1. External Clock Drive Waveforms  
VIH1  
VIL1  
0np  
166  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
24.4 External Clock Drive  
Table 24-1. External Clock Drive  
VCC = 1.8 - 5.5V  
VCC = 2.7 - 5.5V  
VCC = 4.5 - 5.5V  
Symbol  
1/tCLCL  
tCLCL  
Parameter  
Min.  
0
Max.  
Min.  
0
Max.  
Min.  
0
Max.  
Units  
MHz  
ns  
Clock Frequency  
4
10  
20  
Clock Period  
250  
100  
100  
100  
40  
50  
20  
20  
tCHCX  
tCLCX  
High Time  
ns  
Low Time  
40  
ns  
tCLCH  
Rise Time  
2.0  
2.0  
2
1.6  
1.6  
2
0.5  
0.5  
2
µs  
tCHCL  
Fall Time  
µs  
tCLCL  
Change in period from one clock cycle to the next  
%
24.5 Maximum Speed vs. VCC  
Figure 24-2. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC  
10 MHz  
Safe Operating Area  
4 MHz  
1.8V  
2.7V  
5.5V  
Figure 24-3. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC  
20 MHz  
10 MHz  
Safe Operating Area  
2.7V  
4.5V  
5.5V  
167  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
24.6 ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data  
Table 24-2. ADC Characteristics, Single Ended Channels. -40°C - 85°C  
Symbol  
Parameter  
Condition  
Min(1)  
Typ(1)  
Max(1)  
Units  
Resolution  
Single Ended Conversion  
10  
Bits  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
2
3
LSB  
LSB  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
ADC clock = 1 MHz  
Absolute accuracy (Including  
INL, DNL, quantization error,  
gain and offset error)  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
1.5  
2.5  
LSB  
LSB  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
Noise Reduction Mode  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
ADC clock = 1 MHz  
Noise Reduction Mode  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
Integral Non-linearity (INL)  
Differential Non-linearity (DNL)  
Gain Error  
1
LSB  
LSB  
LSB  
LSB  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
0.5  
2.5  
1.5  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
Single Ended Conversion  
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,  
Offset Error  
ADC clock = 200 kHz  
Conversion Time  
Free Running Conversion  
13  
50  
260  
1000  
VREF  
µs  
kHz  
V
Clock Frequency  
VIN  
Input Voltage  
GND  
Input Bandwidth  
38.5  
1.1  
kHz  
V
VINT  
Internal Voltage Reference  
Analog Input Resistance  
1.0  
1.2  
RAIN  
100  
MΩ  
Note:  
1. Values are preliminary.  
168  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
25. Typical Characteristics  
The data contained in this section is largely based on simulations and characterization of similar  
devices in the same process and design methods. Thus, the data should be treated as indica-  
tions of how the part will behave.  
The following charts show typical behavior. These figures are not tested during manufacturing.  
All current consumption measurements are performed with all I/O pins configured as inputs and  
with internal pull-ups enabled. A sine wave generator with rail-to-rail output is used as clock  
source.  
The power consumption in Power-down mode is independent of clock selection.  
The current consumption is a function of several factors such as: operating voltage, operating  
frequency, loading of I/O pins, switching rate of I/O pins, code executed and ambient tempera-  
ture. The dominating factors are operating voltage and frequency.  
The current drawn from capacitive loaded pins may be estimated (for one pin) as CL*VCC*f where  
CL = load capacitance, VCC = operating voltage and f = average switching frequency of I/O pin.  
The parts are characterized at frequencies higher than test limits. Parts are not guaranteed to  
function properly at frequencies higher than the ordering code indicates.  
The difference between current consumption in Power-down mode with Watchdog Timer  
enabled and Power-down mode with Watchdog Timer disabled represents the differential cur-  
rent drawn by the Watchdog Timer.  
25.1 Active Supply Current  
Figure 25-1. Active Supply Current vs. Low frequency (0.1 - 1.0 MHz)  
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. LOW FREQUENCY  
0.1 -1.0 MHz  
1,2  
5.5 V  
1
0,8  
0,6  
0,4  
0,2  
0
5.0 V  
4.5 V  
4.0 V  
3.3 V  
2.7 V  
1.8 V  
0
0,1  
0,2  
0,3  
0,4  
0,5  
0,6  
0,7  
0,8  
0,9  
1
Frequency (MHz)  
169  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-2. Active Supply Current vs. Frequency (1 - 20 MHz)  
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. FREQUENCY  
1 - 20 MHz  
14  
5.5 V  
12  
10  
8
5.0 V  
4.5 V  
4.0V  
6
4
2
0
3.3V  
2.7V  
1.8V  
0
2
4
6
8
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
Frequency (MHz)  
Figure 25-3. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC oscillator, 8 MHz)  
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 8 MHz  
7
-40 ˚C  
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
170  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-4. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 1 MHz)  
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 1 MHz  
1,6  
1,4  
1,2  
1
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
0,8  
0,6  
0,4  
0,2  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-5. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 128 kHz)  
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 128 KHz  
0,25  
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
0,2  
0,15  
0,1  
0,05  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
171  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-6. Idle Supply Current vs. low Frequency (0.1 - 1.0 MHz)  
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. LOW FREQUENCY  
0.1 - 1.0 MHz  
0,25  
5.5 V  
5.0 V  
4.5 V  
4.0 V  
3.3 V  
2.7 V  
1.8 V  
0,2  
0,15  
0,1  
0,05  
0
0
0,1  
0,2  
0,3  
0,4  
0,5  
0,6  
0,7  
0,8  
0,9  
1
Frequency (MHz)  
Figure 25-7. Idle Supply Current vs. Frequency (1 - 20 MHz)  
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. FREQUENCY  
1 - 20 MHz  
4
3,5  
3
5.5 V  
5.0 V  
4.5 V  
2,5  
2
4.0V  
1,5  
1
3.3V  
2.7V  
0,5  
0
1.8V  
0
2
4
6
8
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
Frequency (MHz)  
172  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-8. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 8 MHz)I  
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 8 MHz  
1,8  
1,6  
1,4  
1,2  
1
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
0,8  
0,6  
0,4  
0,2  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-9. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscilllator, 1 MHz)  
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 1 MHz  
0,5  
85 ˚C  
0,45  
0,4  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
0,35  
0,3  
0,25  
0,2  
0,15  
0,1  
0,05  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
173  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-10. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 128 MHz)  
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 128 kHz  
0,1  
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
0,09  
0,08  
0,07  
0,06  
0,05  
0,04  
0,03  
0,02  
0,01  
0
85 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
25.2 Supply Current of I/O modules  
The tables and formulas below can be used to calculate the additional current consumption for  
the different I/O modules in Active and Idle mode. The enabling or disabling of the I/O modules  
are controlled by the Power Reduction Register. See ”PRR – Power Reduction Register” on  
page 34 for details.  
Table 25-1. Additional Current Consumption for the different I/O modules (absolute values)  
PRR bit  
Typical numbers  
VCC = 2V, F = 1MHz  
VCC = 3V, F = 4MHz  
270 uA  
VCC = 5V, F = 8MHz  
1090 uA  
PRTIM1  
PRTIM0  
PRUSI  
43 uA  
5 uA  
28 uA  
25 uA  
84 uA  
116 uA  
102 uA  
351 uA  
4 uA  
PRADC  
13 uA  
Table 25-2. Additional Current Consumption (percentage) in Active and Idle mode  
Additional Current consumption  
compared to Active with external  
clock  
(see Figure 25-1 and Figure 25-2)  
Additional Current consumption  
compared to Idle with external clock  
(see Figure 25-6 and Figure 25-7)  
PRR bit  
PRTIM1  
PRTIM0  
PRUSI  
17.3 %  
1.8 %  
1.6 %  
5.4 %  
68.4 %  
7.3 %  
6.4 %  
PRADC  
21.4 %  
174  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
It is possible to calculate the typical current consumption based on the numbers from Table 2 for  
other VCC and frequency settings than listed in Table 1.  
25.2.0.1  
Example 1  
Calculate the expected current consumption in idle mode with USI, TIMER0, and ADC enabled  
at VCC = 2.0V and F = 1MHz. From Table 25-4 on page 171, third column, we see that we need  
to add 6.4% for the USI, 21.4% for the ADC, and 7.3% for the TIMER0 module. Reading from  
Figure 25-7, we find that the idle current consumption is ~0,1mA at VCC = 2.0V and F = 1MHz.  
The total current consumption in idle mode with USI, TIMER0, and ADC enabled, gives:  
ICCtotal 0.1mA • (1 + 0.064 + 0.073 + 0.214) ≈ 0.135mA  
25.3 Power-down Supply Current  
Figure 25-11. Power-down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Disabled)  
POWER-DOWN SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
WATCHDOG TIMER DISABLED  
2,5  
2
85 ˚C  
1,5  
1
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
0,5  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
175  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-12. Power-down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Enabled)  
POWER-DOWN SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
WATCHDOG TIMER ENABLED  
10  
-40 ˚C  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
25.4 Pin Pull-up  
Figure 25-13. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 1.8V)  
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE  
VCC = 1.8V  
60  
50  
40  
30  
20  
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
10  
0
0
0,2  
0,4  
0,6  
0,8  
1
1,2  
1,4  
1,6  
1,8  
2
VOP (V)  
176  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-14. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 2.7V)  
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE  
VCC = 2.7V  
80  
70  
60  
50  
40  
30  
20  
10  
0
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
0
0,5  
1
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
VOP (V)  
Figure 25-15. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 5V)  
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE  
VCC = 5V  
160  
140  
120  
100  
80  
60  
25 ˚C  
40  
85 ˚C  
20  
-40 ˚C  
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
VOP (V)  
177  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-16. Reset Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 1.8V)  
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE  
VCC = 1.8V  
40  
35  
30  
25  
20  
15  
10  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
5
0
0
0,2  
0,4  
0,6  
0,8  
1
1,2  
1,4  
1,6  
1,8  
2
VRESET(V)  
Figure 25-17. Reset Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 2.7V)  
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE  
VCC =2.7V  
60  
50  
40  
30  
20  
25 ˚C  
10  
-40 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
0
0
0,5  
1
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
VRESET(V)  
178  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-18. Reset Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 5V)  
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE  
VCC = 5V  
120  
100  
80  
60  
40  
20  
0
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
VRESET(V)  
25.5 Pin Driver Strength  
Figure 25-19. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Sink Current (VCC = 3V)  
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT  
VCC = 3V  
1,2  
1
85  
0,8  
0,6  
0,4  
0,2  
0
25  
-40  
0
5
10  
15  
20  
25  
IOL (mA)  
179  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-20. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Sink Current (VCC = 5V)  
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT  
VCC = 5V  
0,6  
85  
0,5  
25  
0,4  
-40  
0,3  
0,2  
0,1  
0
0
5
10  
15  
20  
25  
IOL (mA)  
Figure 25-21. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Source Current (VCC = 3V)  
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT  
VCC = 3V  
3,5  
3
-40  
2,5  
25  
2
85  
1,5  
1
0,5  
0
0
5
10  
15  
20  
25  
IOH (mA)  
180  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-22. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Source Current (VCC = 5V)  
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT  
VCC = 5V  
5,1  
5
4,9  
4,8  
4,7  
4,6  
4,5  
4,4  
-40  
25  
85  
0
5
10  
15  
20  
25  
IOH (mA)  
25.6 Pin Threshold and Hysteresis  
Figure 25-23. I/O Pin Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIH, IO Pin Read as ‘1’)  
I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC  
VIH, IO PIN READ AS '1'  
3
-40 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
2,5  
2
1,5  
1
0,5  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
181  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-24. I/O Pin Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIL, IO Pin Read as ‘0’)  
I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC  
VIL, IO PIN READ AS '0'  
3
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
2,5  
2
1,5  
1
0,5  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-25. I/O Pin Input Hysteresis vs. VCC  
I/O PIN INPUT HYSTERESIS vs. VCC  
0,6  
0,5  
0,4  
0,3  
0,2  
0,1  
0
-40 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
CC (V)  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
V
182  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-26. Reset Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIH, IO Pin Read as ‘1’)  
RESET INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC  
VIH, IO PIN READ AS '1'  
2,5  
2
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
1,5  
1
0,5  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-27. Reset Input Threshold Voltage vs, VCC (VIL, IO Pin Read as ‘0’)  
RESET INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC  
VIL, IO PIN READ AS '0'  
2,5  
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
2
1,5  
1
-40 ˚C  
0,5  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
183  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-28. Reset Pin Input Hysteresis vs. VCC  
RESET PIN INPUT HYSTERESIS vs. VCC  
0,045  
0,04  
0,035  
0,03  
0,025  
0,02  
0,015  
0,01  
0,005  
0
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
25.7 BOD Threshold and Analog Comparator Offset  
Figure 25-29. BOF Threshold vs, Temperature (BOD Level is 4.3V)  
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE  
BODLEVEL is 4.3V  
4,4  
4,35  
4,3  
4,25  
4,2  
Rising VCC  
Falling VCC  
4,15  
4,1  
4,05  
4
-50  
-40  
-30  
-20  
-10  
0
10  
20  
30  
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
90  
100  
Temperature (C)  
184  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-30. BOD Threshold vs. Temperature (BOD Level is 2.7V)  
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE  
BODLEVEL is 2.7V  
2,8  
2,75  
2,7  
Rising VCC  
Falling VCC  
2,65  
2,6  
2,55  
2,5  
-50  
-40  
-30  
-20  
-10  
0
10  
20  
30  
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
90  
100  
Temperature (C)  
Figure 25-31. BOD Threshold vs. Temperature (BOD Level is 1.8V)  
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE  
BODLEVEL is 1.8V  
1,9  
1,85  
1,8  
Risisng VCC  
Falling VCC  
1,75  
1,7  
1,65  
1,6  
-50  
-40  
-30  
-20  
-10  
0
10  
20  
30  
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
90  
100  
Temperature (C)  
185  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
25.8 Internal Oscillator Speed  
Figure 25-32. Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC  
WATCHDOG OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. VCC  
0,128  
0,126  
0,124  
0,122  
0,12  
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
0,118  
0,116  
0,114  
0,112  
85 ˚C  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-33. Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature  
WATCHDOG OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE  
0,128  
0,126  
0,124  
0,122  
0,12  
0,118  
0,116  
0,114  
0,112  
1.8 V  
2.7 V  
3.3 V  
4.0 V  
5.5 V  
-60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10  
0
10  
20  
30  
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
90 100  
Temperature  
186  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-34. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC  
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. VCC  
8,2  
8,1  
8
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
7,9  
7,8  
7,7  
7,6  
7,5  
-40 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
CC (V)  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
V
Figure 25-35. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature  
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE  
8,15  
3.0 V  
5.0 V  
8,1  
8,05  
8
7,95  
7,9  
7,85  
7,8  
7,75  
7,7  
-60  
-40  
-20  
0
20  
40  
60  
80  
100  
Temperature  
187  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Figure 25-36. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. OSCCAL Value  
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. OSCCAL VALUE  
18  
85 ˚C  
16  
14  
12  
10  
8
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
6
4
2
0
0
16  
32  
48  
64  
80  
96 112 128 144 160 176 192 208 224 240  
OSCCAL (X1)  
Figure 25-37. Calibrated 1.6 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC  
CALIBRATED 1.6 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. VCC  
1,65  
1,6  
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
1,55  
1,5  
-40 ˚C  
1,45  
1,4  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
188  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-38. Calibrated 1.6 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature  
CALIBRATED 1.6MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE  
1,64  
3.0 V  
1,62  
5.0 V  
1,6  
1,58  
1,56  
1,54  
1,52  
1,5  
-60  
-40  
-20  
0
20  
40  
60  
80  
100  
Temperature  
Figure 25-39. Calibrated 1.6 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. OSCCAL Value  
CALIBRATED 1.6 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. OSCCAL VALUE  
4,5  
85 ˚C  
4
3,5  
3
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
2,5  
2
1,5  
1
0,5  
0
0
16  
32  
48  
64  
80  
96 112 128 144 160 176 192 208 224 240  
OSCCAL (X1)  
189  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
25.9 Current Consumption of Peripheral Units  
Figure 25-40. Brownout Detector Current vs. VCC  
BROWNOUT DETECTOR CURRENT vs. VCC  
35  
30  
25  
20  
15  
10  
5
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
Figure 25-41. ADC Current vs, VCC (AREF = AVCC  
)
ADC CURRENT vs. VCC  
AREF = AVCC  
300  
250  
200  
150  
100  
50  
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
190  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-42. Analog Comparator Current vs. VCC  
ANALOG COMPARATOR CURRENT vs. VCC  
70  
60  
50  
40  
30  
20  
10  
0
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
85 ˚C  
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
CC (V)  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
V
Figure 25-43. Programming Current vs. VCC  
PROGRAMMING CURRENT vs. Vcc  
12  
10  
8
-40 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
6
85 ˚C  
4
2
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
191  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
25.10 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulsewidth  
Figure 25-44. Reset Supply Current vs, VCC (0.1 - 1.0 MHz, Excluding Current Through The  
Reset Pull-up)  
RESET SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
0.1 - 1.0 MHz, EXCLUDING CURRENT THROUGH THE RESET PULLUP  
0,16  
0,14  
0,12  
0,1  
5.5 V  
5.0 V  
4.5 V  
4.0 V  
0,08  
0,06  
0,04  
0,02  
0
3.3 V  
2.7 V  
1.8 V  
0
0,1  
0,2  
0,3  
0,4  
0,5  
0,6  
0,7  
0,8  
0,9  
1
Frequency (MHz)  
Figure 25-45. Reset Supply Current vs. VCC (1 - 20 MHz, Excluding Current Through The Reset  
Pull-up)  
RESET SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC  
1 - 20 MHz, EXCLUDING CURRENT THROUGH THE RESET PULLUP  
2,5  
5.5 V  
5.0 V  
2
4.5 V  
1,5  
4.0V  
1
3.3V  
0,5  
2.7V  
1.8V  
0
0
2
4
6
8
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
Frequency (MHz)  
192  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Figure 25-46. Minimum Reset Pulse Width vs, VCC  
MINIMUM RESET PULSE WIDTH vs. VCC  
2500  
2000  
1500  
1000  
500  
85 ˚C  
25 ˚C  
-40 ˚C  
0
1,5  
2
2,5  
3
3,5  
4
4,5  
5
5,5  
VCC (V)  
193  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
26. Register Summary  
Address  
Name  
Bit 7  
Bit 6  
Bit 5  
Bit 4  
Bit 3  
Bit 2  
Bit 1  
Bit 0  
Page  
0x3F  
0x3E  
0x3D  
0x3C  
0x3B  
0x3A  
0x39  
0x38  
0x37  
0x36  
0x35  
0x34  
0x33  
0x32  
0x31  
0x30  
0x2F  
0x2E  
0x2D  
0x2C  
0x2B  
0x2A  
0x29  
0x28  
0x27  
0x26  
0x25  
0x24  
0x23  
0x22  
0x21  
0x20  
0x1F  
0x1E  
0x1D  
0x1C  
0x1B  
0x1A  
0x19  
0x18  
0x17  
0x16  
0x15  
0x14  
0x13  
0x12  
0x11  
0x10  
0x0F  
0x0E  
0x0D  
0x0C  
0x0B  
0x0A  
0x09  
0x08  
0x07  
0x06  
0x05  
0x04  
0x03  
0x02  
0x01  
0x00  
SREG  
I
T
H
S
V
N
Z
C
page 7  
page 10  
page 10  
SPH  
SP9  
SP1  
SP8  
SP0  
SPL  
SP7  
SP6  
SP5  
SP4  
SP3  
SP2  
Reserved  
GIMSK  
GIFR  
INT0  
INTF0  
OCIE1A  
OCF1A  
PCIE  
PCIF  
page 49  
page 50  
TIMSK  
OCIE1B  
OCF1B  
OCIE0A  
OCF0A  
CTPB  
OCIE0B  
OCF0B  
RFLB  
TOIE1  
TOV1  
PGWRT  
TOIE0  
TOV0  
PGERS  
page 80/page 101  
page 80  
TIFR  
SPMCSR  
Reserved  
MCUCR  
MCUSR  
TCCR0B  
TCNT0  
OSCCAL  
TCCR1  
TCNT1  
OCR1A  
OCR1C  
GTCCR  
OCR1B  
TCCR0A  
OCR0A  
OCR0B  
PLLCSR  
CLKPR  
DT1A  
SPMEN  
page 146  
PUD  
SE  
SM1  
SM0  
ISC01  
EXTRF  
CS01  
ISC00  
PORF  
CS00  
page 32, page 59, page 49  
page 40,  
WDRF  
WGM02  
BORF  
CS02  
FOC0A  
FOC0B  
page 78  
Timer/Counter0  
page 79  
Oscillator Calibration Register  
page 27  
CTC1  
PWM1A  
COM1A1  
COM1A0  
CS13  
CS12  
CS11  
CS10  
page 87, page 99  
page 89, page 100  
page 89, page 101  
Timer/Counter1  
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Register A  
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Register C  
page 90, page 101  
page 83, page 88, page  
TSM  
PWM1B  
COM1B1  
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare Register B  
COM0B1 COM0B0  
COM1B0  
FOC1B  
FOC1A  
PSR1  
PSR0  
page 90  
page 75  
COM0A1  
COM0A0  
WGM01  
WGM00  
Timer/Counter0 – Output Compare Register A  
Timer/Counter0 – Output Compare Register B  
page 79  
page 79  
SM  
CLKPCE  
DT1AH3  
DT1BH3  
-
PCKE  
CLKPS2  
DT1AL2  
DT1BL2  
-
PLLE  
PLOCK  
CLKPS0  
DT1AL0  
DT1BL0  
DTPS10  
page 92, page 102  
page 30  
CLKPS3  
DT1AL3  
DT1BL3  
-
CLKPS1  
DT1AL1  
DT1BL1  
DTPS11  
DT1AH2  
DT1BH2  
-
DT1AH1  
DT1BH1  
-
DT1AH0  
DT1BH0  
-
page 107  
page 108  
page 107  
page 143  
page 42  
DT1B  
DTPS1  
DWDR  
DWDR[7:0]  
WDTCR  
PRR  
WDIF  
WDIE  
WDP3  
WDCE  
WDE  
WDP2  
WDP1  
PRUSI  
WDP0  
PRADC  
EEAR8  
EEAR0  
PRTIM1  
PRTIM0  
page 34  
EEARH  
EEARL  
EEDR  
page 16  
EEAR7  
EEAR6  
EEAR5  
EEPM1  
EEAR4  
EEAR3  
EEAR2  
EEMPE  
EEAR1  
EEPE  
page 16  
EEPROM Data Register  
page 16  
EECR  
EEPM0  
EERIE  
EERE  
page 17  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
PORTB  
DDRB  
PORTB5  
DDB5  
PORTB4  
DDB4  
PORTB3  
DDB3  
PORTB2  
DDB2  
PORTB1  
DDB1  
PORTB0  
DDB0  
page 63  
page 63  
PINB  
PINB5  
PINB4  
PINB3  
PINB2  
PINB1  
PINB0  
page 63  
PCMSK  
DIDR0  
PCINT5  
ADC0D  
PCINT4  
ADC2D  
PCINT3  
ADC3D  
PCINT2  
ADC1D  
PCINT1  
AIN1D  
PCINT0  
AIN0D  
page 50  
page 123, page 140  
page 9  
GPIOR2  
GPIOR1  
GPIOR0  
USIBR  
General Purpose I/O Register 2  
General Purpose I/O Register 1  
General Purpose I/O Register 0  
USI Buffer Register  
page 9  
page 9  
page 117  
page 116  
page 117  
page 118  
USIDR  
USI Data Register  
USISR  
USISIF  
USISIE  
USIOIF  
USIOIE  
USIPF  
USIDC  
USICNT3  
USICS1  
USICNT2  
USICS0  
USICNT1  
USICLK  
USICNT0  
USITC  
USICR  
USIWM1  
USIWM0  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
ACSR  
ACD  
REFS1  
ADEN  
ACBG  
REFS0  
ADSC  
ACO  
ACI  
REFS2  
ADIF  
ACIE  
MUX3  
ADIE  
ACIS1  
MUX1  
ADPS1  
ACIS0  
MUX0  
ADPS0  
page 121  
page 136  
ADMUX  
ADCSRA  
ADCH  
ADLAR  
ADATE  
MUX2  
ADPS2  
page 137  
ADC Data Register High Byte  
ADC Data Register Low Byte  
page 139  
ADCL  
page 139  
ADCSRB  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
BIN  
ACME  
IPR  
ADTS2  
ADTS1  
ADTS0  
page 121, page 139  
194  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Note:  
1. For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed. Reserved I/O memory addresses  
should never be written.  
2. I/O Registers within the address range 0x00 - 0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these  
registers, the value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions.  
3. Some of the Status Flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that, unlike most other AVRs, the CBI and SBI  
instructions will only operation the specified bit, and can therefore be used on registers containing such Status Flags. The  
CBI and SBI instructions work with registers 0x00 to 0x1F only.  
195  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
27. Instruction Set Summary  
Mnemonics  
Operands  
Description  
Operation  
Flags  
#Clocks  
ARITHMETIC AND LOGIC INSTRUCTIONS  
ADD  
ADC  
ADIW  
SUB  
SUBI  
SBC  
SBCI  
SBIW  
AND  
ANDI  
OR  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, Rr  
Rdl,K  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, K  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, K  
Rdl,K  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, K  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, K  
Rd, Rr  
Rd  
Add two Registers  
Rd Rd + Rr  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,S  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,C,N,V,S  
Z,N,V  
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Add with Carry two Registers  
Add Immediate to Word  
Subtract two Registers  
Subtract Constant from Register  
Subtract with Carry two Registers  
Subtract with Carry Constant from Reg.  
Subtract Immediate from Word  
Logical AND Registers  
Logical AND Register and Constant  
Logical OR Registers  
Rd Rd + Rr + C  
Rdh:Rdl Rdh:Rdl + K  
Rd Rd - Rr  
Rd Rd - K  
Rd Rd - Rr - C  
Rd Rd - K - C  
Rdh:Rdl Rdh:Rdl - K  
Rd Rd Rr  
Rd Rd K  
Z,N,V  
Rd Rd v Rr  
Z,N,V  
ORI  
Logical OR Register and Constant  
Exclusive OR Registers  
One’s Complement  
Rd Rd v K  
Z,N,V  
EOR  
COM  
NEG  
SBR  
CBR  
INC  
Rd Rd Rr  
Rd 0xFF Rd  
Rd 0x00 Rd  
Rd Rd v K  
Z,N,V  
Z,C,N,V  
Z,C,N,V,H  
Z,N,V  
Rd  
Two’s Complement  
Rd,K  
Rd,K  
Rd  
Set Bit(s) in Register  
Clear Bit(s) in Register  
Increment  
Rd Rd (0xFF - K)  
Rd Rd + 1  
Z,N,V  
Z,N,V  
DEC  
TST  
Rd  
Decrement  
Rd Rd 1  
Z,N,V  
Rd  
Test for Zero or Minus  
Clear Register  
Rd Rd Rd  
Rd Rd Rd  
Rd 0xFF  
Z,N,V  
CLR  
SER  
Rd  
Z,N,V  
Rd  
Set Register  
None  
BRANCH INSTRUCTIONS  
RJMP  
IJMP  
k
k
Relative Jump  
PC PC + k + 1  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
I
2
2
Indirect Jump to (Z)  
PC Z  
RCALL  
ICALL  
RET  
Relative Subroutine Call  
Indirect Call to (Z)  
PC PC + k + 1  
3
PC Z  
3
Subroutine Return  
PC STACK  
4
RETI  
Interrupt Return  
PC STACK  
4
CPSE  
CP  
Rd,Rr  
Compare, Skip if Equal  
Compare  
if (Rd = Rr) PC PC + 2 or 3  
Rd Rr  
None  
Z, N,V,C,H  
Z, N,V,C,H  
Z, N,V,C,H  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
1/2/3  
1
Rd,Rr  
CPC  
Rd,Rr  
Compare with Carry  
Rd Rr C  
1
CPI  
Rd,K  
Compare Register with Immediate  
Skip if Bit in Register Cleared  
Skip if Bit in Register is Set  
Skip if Bit in I/O Register Cleared  
Skip if Bit in I/O Register is Set  
Branch if Status Flag Set  
Branch if Status Flag Cleared  
Branch if Equal  
Rd K  
1
SBRC  
SBRS  
SBIC  
Rr, b  
if (Rr(b)=0) PC PC + 2 or 3  
if (Rr(b)=1) PC PC + 2 or 3  
if (P(b)=0) PC PC + 2 or 3  
if (P(b)=1) PC PC + 2 or 3  
if (SREG(s) = 1) then PCPC+k + 1  
if (SREG(s) = 0) then PCPC+k + 1  
if (Z = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (Z = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (C = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (C = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (C = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (C = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (N = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (N = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (N V= 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (N V= 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (H = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (H = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (T = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (T = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (V = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if (V = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
if ( I = 1) then PC PC + k + 1  
if ( I = 0) then PC PC + k + 1  
1/2/3  
1/2/3  
1/2/3  
1/2/3  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
Rr, b  
P, b  
P, b  
s, k  
s, k  
k
SBIS  
BRBS  
BRBC  
BREQ  
BRNE  
BRCS  
BRCC  
BRSH  
BRLO  
BRMI  
BRPL  
BRGE  
BRLT  
BRHS  
BRHC  
BRTS  
BRTC  
BRVS  
BRVC  
BRIE  
BRID  
k
Branch if Not Equal  
k
Branch if Carry Set  
k
Branch if Carry Cleared  
Branch if Same or Higher  
Branch if Lower  
k
k
k
Branch if Minus  
k
Branch if Plus  
k
Branch if Greater or Equal, Signed  
Branch if Less Than Zero, Signed  
Branch if Half Carry Flag Set  
Branch if Half Carry Flag Cleared  
Branch if T Flag Set  
k
k
k
k
k
Branch if T Flag Cleared  
Branch if Overflow Flag is Set  
Branch if Overflow Flag is Cleared  
Branch if Interrupt Enabled  
Branch if Interrupt Disabled  
k
k
k
k
BIT AND BIT-TEST INSTRUCTIONS  
SBI  
P,b  
P,b  
Rd  
Rd  
Rd  
Set Bit in I/O Register  
Clear Bit in I/O Register  
Logical Shift Left  
I/O(P,b) 1  
None  
2
2
1
1
1
CBI  
LSL  
LSR  
ROL  
I/O(P,b) 0  
None  
Rd(n+1) Rd(n), Rd(0) 0  
Rd(n) Rd(n+1), Rd(7) 0  
Rd(0)C,Rd(n+1)Rd(n),CRd(7)  
Z,C,N,V  
Z,C,N,V  
Z,C,N,V  
Logical Shift Right  
Rotate Left Through Carry  
196  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Mnemonics  
Operands  
Description  
Operation  
Flags  
#Clocks  
ROR  
Rd  
Rotate Right Through Carry  
Rd(7)C,Rd(n)Rd(n+1),CRd(0)  
Z,C,N,V  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
ASR  
SWAP  
BSET  
BCLR  
BST  
BLD  
SEC  
CLC  
SEN  
CLN  
SEZ  
CLZ  
SEI  
Rd  
Rd  
s
Arithmetic Shift Right  
Swap Nibbles  
Rd(n) Rd(n+1), n=0..6  
Z,C,N,V  
Rd(3..0)Rd(7..4),Rd(7..4)Rd(3..0)  
None  
Flag Set  
SREG(s) 1  
SREG(s) 0  
T Rr(b)  
Rd(b) T  
C 1  
SREG(s)  
s
Flag Clear  
SREG(s)  
Rr, b  
Rd, b  
Bit Store from Register to T  
Bit load from T to Register  
Set Carry  
T
None  
C
C
N
N
Z
Clear Carry  
C 0  
Set Negative Flag  
N 1  
Clear Negative Flag  
Set Zero Flag  
N 0  
Z 1  
Clear Zero Flag  
Z 0  
Z
Global Interrupt Enable  
Global Interrupt Disable  
Set Signed Test Flag  
Clear Signed Test Flag  
Set Twos Complement Overflow.  
Clear Twos Complement Overflow  
Set T in SREG  
I 1  
I
CLI  
I 0  
I
SES  
CLS  
SEV  
CLV  
SET  
CLT  
SEH  
CLH  
S 1  
S
S
V
V
T
S 0  
V 1  
V 0  
T 1  
Clear T in SREG  
T 0  
T
Set Half Carry Flag in SREG  
Clear Half Carry Flag in SREG  
H 1  
H
H
H 0  
DATA TRANSFER INSTRUCTIONS  
MOV  
MOVW  
LDI  
LD  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, Rr  
Rd, K  
Move Between Registers  
Copy Register Word  
Rd Rr  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
Rd+1:Rd Rr+1:Rr  
Load Immediate  
Rd K  
Rd, X  
Load Indirect  
Rd (X)  
LD  
Rd, X+  
Rd, - X  
Rd, Y  
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Load Indirect  
Rd (X), X X + 1  
X X - 1, Rd (X)  
Rd (Y)  
LD  
LD  
LD  
Rd, Y+  
Rd, - Y  
Rd,Y+q  
Rd, Z  
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Load Indirect with Displacement  
Load Indirect  
Rd (Y), Y Y + 1  
Y Y - 1, Rd (Y)  
Rd (Y + q)  
Rd (Z)  
LD  
LDD  
LD  
LD  
Rd, Z+  
Rd, -Z  
Rd, Z+q  
Rd, k  
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Load Indirect with Displacement  
Load Direct from SRAM  
Store Indirect  
Rd (Z), Z Z+1  
Z Z - 1, Rd (Z)  
Rd (Z + q)  
Rd (k)  
LD  
LDD  
LDS  
ST  
X, Rr  
(X) Rr  
ST  
X+, Rr  
- X, Rr  
Y, Rr  
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Store Indirect  
(X) Rr, X X + 1  
X X - 1, (X) Rr  
(Y) Rr  
ST  
ST  
ST  
Y+, Rr  
- Y, Rr  
Y+q,Rr  
Z, Rr  
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Store Indirect with Displacement  
Store Indirect  
(Y) Rr, Y Y + 1  
Y Y - 1, (Y) Rr  
(Y + q) Rr  
ST  
STD  
ST  
(Z) Rr  
ST  
Z+, Rr  
-Z, Rr  
Z+q,Rr  
k, Rr  
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.  
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.  
Store Indirect with Displacement  
Store Direct to SRAM  
Load Program Memory  
Load Program Memory  
Load Program Memory and Post-Inc  
Store Program Memory  
In Port  
(Z) Rr, Z Z + 1  
Z Z - 1, (Z) Rr  
(Z + q) Rr  
ST  
STD  
STS  
LPM  
LPM  
LPM  
SPM  
IN  
(k) Rr  
R0 (Z)  
Rd, Z  
Rd (Z)  
Rd, Z+  
Rd (Z), Z Z+1  
(z) R1:R0  
Rd, P  
P, Rr  
Rr  
Rd P  
1
1
2
2
OUT  
PUSH  
POP  
Out Port  
P Rr  
Push Register on Stack  
Pop Register from Stack  
STACK Rr  
Rd STACK  
Rd  
MCU CONTROL INSTRUCTIONS  
NOP  
No Operation  
Sleep  
None  
None  
None  
None  
1
1
SLEEP  
WDR  
(see specific descr. for Sleep function)  
(see specific descr. for WDR/Timer)  
For On-chip Debug Only  
Watchdog Reset  
Break  
1
BREAK  
N/A  
197  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
28. Ordering Information  
28.1 ATtiny25  
Speed (MHz)(3)  
Power Supply  
Ordering Code  
Package(1)(2)  
Operational Range  
ATtiny25V-10PI  
ATtiny25V-10PU  
ATtiny25V-10SI  
ATtiny25V-10SU  
ATtiny25V-10MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
10  
1.8 - 5.5V  
2.7 - 5.5V  
ATtiny25-20PI  
ATtiny25-20PU  
ATtiny25-20SI  
ATtiny25-20SU  
ATtiny25-20MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
20  
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information  
and minimum quantities.  
2. Pb-free packaging complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also  
Halide free and fully Green.  
3. For Speed vs. VCC,see Figure 24.5 on page 167  
Package Type  
8P3  
8-lead, 0.300" Wide, Plastic Dual Inline Package (PDIP)  
8S2  
8-lead, 0.209" Wide, Plastic Gull-Wing Small Outline (EIAJ SOIC)  
20-pad, 4 x 4 x 0.8 mm Body, Quad Flat No-Lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)  
20M1  
198  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
28.2 ATtiny45  
Speed (MHz)(3)  
Power Supply  
Ordering Code  
Package(1)(2)  
Operational Range  
ATtiny45V-10PI  
ATtiny45V-10PU  
ATtiny45V-10SI  
ATtiny45V-10SU  
ATtiny45V-10MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
10  
20  
1.8 - 5.5V  
ATtiny45-20PI  
ATtiny45-20PU  
ATtiny45-20SI  
ATtiny45-20SU  
ATtiny45-20MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
2.7 - 5.5V  
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information  
and minimum quantities.  
2. Pb-free packaging complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also  
Halide free and fully Green.  
3. For Speed vs. VCC,see Figure 24.5 on page 167  
Package Type  
8P3  
8-lead, 0.300" Wide, Plastic Dual Inline Package (PDIP)  
8S2  
8-lead, 0.209" Wide, Plastic Gull-Wing Small Outline (EIAJ SOIC)  
20-pad, 4 x 4 x 0.8 mm Body, Quad Flat No-Lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)  
20M1  
199  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
28.3 ATtiny85  
Speed (MHz)(3)  
Power Supply  
Ordering Code  
Package(1)(2)  
Operational Range  
ATtiny85V-10PI  
ATtiny85V-10PU  
ATtiny85V-10SI  
ATtiny85V-10SU  
ATtiny85V-10MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
10  
20  
1.8 - 5.5V  
ATtiny85-20PI  
ATtiny85-20PU  
ATtiny85-20SI  
ATtiny85-20SU  
ATtiny85-20MU  
8P3  
8P3  
8S2  
8S2  
20M1  
Industrial  
(-40°C to 85°C)  
2.7 - 5.5V  
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information  
and minimum quantities.  
2. Pb-free packaging complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also  
Halide free and fully Green.  
3. For Speed vs. VCC,see Figure 24.5 on page 167  
Package Type  
8P3  
8-lead, 0.300" Wide, Plastic Dual Inline Package (PDIP)  
8S2  
8-lead, 0.209" Wide, Plastic Gull-Wing Small Outline (EIAJ SOIC)  
20-pad, 4 x 4 x 0.8 mm Body, Quad Flat No-Lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)  
20M1  
200  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
29. Packaging Information  
29.1 8P3  
E
1
E1  
N
Top View  
c
eA  
End View  
COMMON DIMENSIONS  
(Unit of Measure = inches)  
D
e
MIN  
MAX  
NOM  
NOTE  
SYMBOL  
D1  
A2 A  
A
0.210  
0.195  
0.022  
0.070  
0.045  
0.014  
0.400  
2
A2  
b
0.115  
0.014  
0.045  
0.030  
0.008  
0.355  
0.005  
0.300  
0.240  
0.130  
0.018  
0.060  
0.039  
0.010  
0.365  
5
6
6
b2  
b3  
c
D
3
3
4
3
b2  
L
D1  
E
b3  
4 PLCS  
0.310  
0.250  
0.325  
0.280  
b
E1  
e
0.100 BSC  
0.300 BSC  
0.130  
Side View  
eA  
L
4
2
0.115  
0.150  
Notes: 1. This drawing is for general information only; refer to JEDEC Drawing MS-001, Variation BA for additional information.  
2. Dimensions A and L are measured with the package seated in JEDEC seating plane Gauge GS-3.  
3. D, D1 and E1 dimensions do not include mold Flash or protrusions. Mold Flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 inch.  
4. E and eA measured with the leads constrained to be perpendicular to datum.  
5. Pointed or rounded lead tips are preferred to ease insertion.  
6. b2 and b3 maximum dimensions do not include Dambar protrusions. Dambar protrusions shall not exceed 0.010 (0.25 mm).  
01/09/02  
TITLE  
DRAWING NO.  
REV.  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131  
8P3, 8-lead, 0.300" Wide Body, Plastic Dual  
In-line Package (PDIP)  
8P3  
B
R
201  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
29.2 8S2  
C
1
E
E1  
L
N
Top View  
End View  
e
b
COMMON DIMENSIONS  
(Unit of Measure = mm)  
A
MIN  
1.70  
0.05  
0.35  
0.15  
5.13  
5.18  
7.70  
0.51  
0˚  
MAX  
2.16  
0.25  
0.48  
0.35  
5.35  
5.40  
8.26  
0.85  
8˚  
NOM  
NOTE  
SYMBOL  
A1  
A
A1  
b
5
5
C
D
E1  
E
D
2, 3  
Side View  
L
e
1.27 BSC  
4
Notes: 1. This drawing is for general information only; refer to EIAJ Drawing EDR-7320 for additional information.  
2. Mismatch of the upper and lower dies and resin burrs are not included.  
3. It is recommended that upper and lower cavities be equal. If they are different, the larger dimension shall be regarded.  
4. Determines the true geometric position.  
5. Values b and C apply to pb/Sn solder plated terminal. The standard thickness of the solder layer shall be 0.010 +0.010/0.005 mm.  
10/7/03  
TITLE  
REV.  
DRAWING NO.  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131  
8S2, 8-lead, 0.209" Body, Plastic Small  
Outline Package (EIAJ)  
8S2  
C
R
202  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
29.3 20M1  
D
1
2
Pin 1 ID  
SIDE VIEW  
E
3
TOP VIEW  
A2  
A1  
D2  
A
0.08  
C
1
2
3
Pin #1  
Notch  
(0.20 R)  
COMMON DIMENSIONS  
(Unit of Measure = mm)  
E2  
MIN  
0.70  
MAX  
0.80  
0.05  
b
NOM  
0.75  
NOTE  
SYMBOL  
A
A1  
A2  
b
0.01  
L
0.20 REF  
0.23  
0.18  
2.45  
2.45  
0.35  
0.30  
2.75  
2.75  
0.55  
e
D
4.00 BSC  
2.60  
D2  
E
BOTTOM VIEW  
4.00 BSC  
2.60  
E2  
e
0.50 BSC  
0.40  
Reference JEDEC Standard MO-220, Fig. 1 (SAW Singulation) WGGD-5.  
Note:  
L
10/27/04  
DRAWING NO. REV.  
20M1  
TITLE  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131  
20M1, 20-pad, 4 x 4 x 0.8 mm Body, Lead Pitch 0.50 mm,  
A
R
2.6 mm Exposed Pad, Micro Lead Frame Package (MLF)  
203  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
30. Errata  
30.1 Errata ATtiny25  
The revision letter in this section refers to the revision of the ATtiny25 device.  
30.1.1  
Rev A and B  
Not sampled.  
204  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
30.2 Errata ATtiny45  
The revision letter in this section refers to the revision of the ATtiny45 device.  
30.2.1  
Rev A  
Too high power down power consumption  
DebugWIRE looses communication when single stepping into interrupts  
PLL not locking  
EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3  
EEPROM write may fail with VCC below 2.0 volts  
1. Too high power down power consumption  
Three situations will lead to a too high power down power consumption. These are:  
– An external clock is selected by fuses, but the I/O PORT is still enabled as an output.  
– The EEPROM is read before entering power down.  
– VCC is 4.5 volts or higher.  
Problem fix / Workaround  
– When using external clock, avoid setting the clock pin as Output.  
– Do not read the EEPROM if power down power consumption is important.  
– Use VCC lower than 4.5 Volts.  
2. DebugWIRE looses communication when single stepping into interrupts  
When receiving an interrupt during single stepping, debugwire will loose  
communication.  
Problem fix / Workaround  
– When singlestepping, disable interrupts.  
– When debugging interrupts, use breakpoints within the interrupt routine, and run into  
the interrupt.  
3. PLL not locking  
When at frequencies below 6.0 MHz, the PLL will not lock  
Problem fix / Workaround  
When using the PLL, run at 6.0 MHz or higher.  
4. EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3  
When the Memory Lock Bits LB2 and LB1 are programmed to mode 3, EEPROM read does  
not work from the application code.  
Problem Fix/Work around  
Do not set Lock Bit Protection Mode 3 when the application code needs to read from  
EEPROM.  
205  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
5. EEPROM Write may fail with VCC below 2.0 volts  
When VCC is below 2.0 volts, EEPROM write may fail.  
Problem Fix/Work around  
Do not write the EEPROM when VCC is below 2.0 volts  
30.2.2  
Rev B and C  
PLL not locking  
EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3  
EEPROM write may fail with VCC below 2.0 volts  
Timer Counter 1 PWM output generation on OC1B- XOC1B does not work correctly  
1. PLL not locking  
When at frequencies below 6.0 MHz, the PLL will not lock  
Problem fix / Workaround  
When using the PLL, run at 6.0 MHz or higher.  
2. EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3  
When the Memory Lock Bits LB2 and LB1 are programmed to mode 3, EEPROM read does  
not work from the application code.  
Problem Fix/Work around  
Do not set Lock Bit Protection Mode 3 when the application code needs to read from  
EEPROM.  
3. EEPROM Write may fail with VCC below 2.0 volts  
When VCC is below 2.0 volts, EEPROM write may fail.  
Problem Fix/Work around  
Do not write the EEPROM when VCC is below 2.0 volts  
4. Timer Counter 1 PWM output generation on OC1B – XOC1B does not work correctly  
Timer Counter1 PWM output OC1B-XOC1B does not work correctly. Only in the case when  
the control bits, COM1B1 and COM1B0 are in the same mode as COM1A1 and COM1A0,  
respectively, the OC1B-XOC1B output works correctly.  
Problem Fix/Work around  
The only workaround is to use same control setting on COM1B(1:0) and COM1B(1:0) con-  
trol bits, see table 14-4 inthe data sheet. The problem has been fixed for Tiny45 rev D.  
206  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
30.3 Errata ATtiny85  
The revision letter in this section refers to the revision of the ATtiny85 device.  
30.3.1  
Rev A  
No known errata.  
207  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
31. Datasheet Revision History  
31.1 Rev. 2586D-02/06  
1.  
Updated Table 7-4 on page 25, Table 7-5 on page 26, Table 7-10 on page  
28, Table 7-13 on page 29, Table 7-12 on page 29, Table 10-1 on page  
46,Table 20-3 on page 137, Table 23-15 on page 162, Table 24-2 on page  
168.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
Updated ”Timer/Counter1 in PWM Mode” on page 92.  
Updated text ”Bit 2 - TOV1: Timer/Counter1 Overflow Flag” on page 91.  
Updated values in ”DC Characteristics” on page 165.  
Updated ”Register Summary” on page 194.  
Updated ”Ordering Information” on page 198.  
Updated Rev B and C, ”Errata ATtiny45” on page 205.  
All references to power-save mode are removed.  
Updated Register Adresses.  
31.2 Rev. 2586C-06/05  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
Updated ”Features” on page 1.  
Updated Figure 1-1 on page 2.  
Updated Code Examples on page 19 and page 20.  
Moved “Temperature Measurement” to Section 20.8 page 141.  
Updated ”Register Summary” on page 194.  
Updated ”Ordering Information” on page 198.  
31.3 Rev. 2586B-05/05  
1.  
CLKI added, instances of EEMWE/EEWE renamed EEMPE/EEPE,  
removed some TBD.  
Removed “Preliminary Description” from ”Temperature Measurement”  
on page 141.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
Updated ”Features” on page 1.  
Updated Figure 1-1 on page 2 and Figure 9-1 on page 36.  
Updated Table 8-1 on page 32, Table 12-4 on page 62, Table 12-5 on  
page 62  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
Updated ”Serial Programming Instruction set” on page 155.  
Updated SPH register in ”Instruction Set Summary” on page 196.  
Updated ”DC Characteristics” on page 165.  
Updated ”Ordering Information” on page 198.  
Updated ”Errata” on page 204.  
31.4 Rev. 2586A-02/05  
1.  
Initial revision.  
208  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
Table of Contents  
Features..................................................................................................... 1  
1
2
Pin Configurations ................................................................................... 2  
1.1 Disclaimer .................................................................................................................2  
Overview ................................................................................................... 3  
2.1 Block Diagram ..........................................................................................................3  
2.2 Pin Descriptions .......................................................................................................4  
3
4
5
Resources ................................................................................................. 5  
About Code Examples ............................................................................. 5  
AVR CPU Core .......................................................................................... 6  
5.1 Introduction ...............................................................................................................6  
5.2 Architectural Overview .............................................................................................6  
5.3 ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit .....................................................................................7  
5.4 Status Register .........................................................................................................7  
5.5 General Purpose Register File .................................................................................9  
5.6 Stack Pointer ..........................................................................................................10  
5.7 Instruction Execution Timing ..................................................................................10  
5.8 Reset and Interrupt Handling .................................................................................11  
6
7
AVR Memories ........................................................................................ 14  
6.1 In-System Re-programmable Flash Program Memory ...........................................14  
6.2 SRAM Data Memory ..............................................................................................14  
6.3 EEPROM Data Memory .........................................................................................15  
6.4 I/O Memory .............................................................................................................21  
System Clock and Clock Options ......................................................... 22  
7.1 Clock Systems and their Distribution ......................................................................22  
7.2 Clock Sources ........................................................................................................24  
7.3 Default Clock Source ..............................................................................................24  
7.4 Crystal Oscillator ....................................................................................................24  
7.5 Low-frequency Crystal Oscillator ............................................................................26  
7.6 Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator ............................................................................26  
7.7 External Clock ........................................................................................................28  
7.8 128 kHz Internal Oscillator .....................................................................................29  
7.9 Clock Output Buffer ................................................................................................29  
i
2586D–AVR–02/06  
7.10 System Clock Prescaler .......................................................................................30  
8
9
Power Management and Sleep Modes ................................................. 32  
8.1 Idle Mode ................................................................................................................33  
8.2 ADC Noise Reduction Mode ..................................................................................33  
8.3 Power-down Mode .................................................................................................33  
8.4 Power Reduction Register ......................................................................................34  
8.5 Minimizing Power Consumption .............................................................................34  
System Control and Reset .................................................................... 36  
9.1 Internal Voltage Reference .....................................................................................40  
9.2 Watchdog Timer .....................................................................................................41  
9.3 Timed Sequences for Changing the Configuration of the Watchdog Timer ...........44  
10 Interrupts ................................................................................................ 46  
10.1 Interrupt Vectors in ATtiny25/45/85 ......................................................................46  
11 External Interrupts ................................................................................. 48  
11.1 Pin Change Interrupt Timing ................................................................................48  
11.2 External Interrupts Register Description ...............................................................49  
12 I/O Ports .................................................................................................. 51  
12.1 Introduction ...........................................................................................................51  
12.2 Ports as General Digital I/O ..................................................................................52  
12.3 Alternate Port Functions .......................................................................................57  
12.4 Register Description for I/O-Ports .........................................................................63  
13 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM ............................................................ 64  
13.1 Overview ..............................................................................................................64  
13.2 Timer/Counter Clock Sources ..............................................................................65  
13.3 Counter Unit .........................................................................................................65  
13.4 Output Compare Unit ...........................................................................................66  
13.5 Compare Match Output Unit .................................................................................68  
13.6 Modes of Operation ..............................................................................................69  
13.7 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams ..........................................................................73  
13.8 8-bit Timer/Counter Register Description .............................................................75  
14 Timer/Counter Prescaler ....................................................................... 82  
15 8-bit Timer/Counter1 .............................................................................. 84  
15.1 Timer/Counter1 ....................................................................................................84  
ii  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
16 8-bit Timer/Counter1 in ATtiny15 Mode ............................................... 96  
16.1 Timer/Counter1 Prescaler ....................................................................................96  
16.2 Timer/Counter1 ....................................................................................................96  
17 Dead Time Generator ........................................................................... 106  
18 USI – Universal Serial Interface .......................................................... 109  
18.1 Overview ............................................................................................................109  
18.2 Functional Descriptions ......................................................................................110  
18.3 Alternative USI Usage ........................................................................................116  
18.4 USI Register Descriptions ..................................................................................116  
19 Analog Comparator ............................................................................. 121  
19.1 Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input ................................................................122  
20 Analog to Digital Converter ................................................................ 124  
20.1 Features .............................................................................................................124  
20.2 Operation ............................................................................................................125  
20.3 Starting a Conversion .........................................................................................126  
20.4 Prescaling and Conversion Timing .....................................................................127  
20.5 Changing Channel or Reference Selection ........................................................129  
20.6 ADC Noise Canceler ..........................................................................................130  
20.7 ADC Conversion Result .....................................................................................134  
20.8 Temperature Measurement ................................................................................141  
21 debugWIRE On-chip Debug System .................................................. 142  
21.1 Features .............................................................................................................142  
21.2 Overview ............................................................................................................142  
21.3 Physical Interface ...............................................................................................142  
21.4 Software Break Points ........................................................................................143  
21.5 Limitations of debugWIRE ..................................................................................143  
21.6 debugWIRE Related Register in I/O Memory .....................................................143  
22 Self-Programming the Flash ............................................................... 144  
22.1 Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming ................................................145  
23 Memory Programming ......................................................................... 149  
23.1 Program And Data Memory Lock Bits ................................................................149  
23.2 Fuse Bytes .........................................................................................................150  
23.3 Signature Bytes ..................................................................................................151  
23.4 Calibration Byte ..................................................................................................152  
iii  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
23.5 Page Size ...........................................................................................................152  
23.6 Serial Downloading ............................................................................................153  
23.7 High-voltage Serial Programming .......................................................................158  
23.8 High-voltage Serial Programming Algorithm ......................................................159  
23.9 High-voltage Serial Programming Characteristics ..............................................164  
24 Electrical Characteristics .................................................................... 165  
24.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings* ..............................................................................165  
24.2 DC Characteristics .............................................................................................165  
24.3 External Clock Drive Waveforms ........................................................................166  
24.4 External Clock Drive ...........................................................................................167  
24.5 Maximum Speed vs. VCC ...........................................................................................................................167  
24.6 ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data .............................................................168  
25 Typical Characteristics ........................................................................ 169  
25.1 Active Supply Current .........................................................................................169  
25.2 Supply Current of I/O modules ...........................................................................174  
25.3 Power-down Supply Current ..............................................................................175  
25.4 Pin Pull-up ..........................................................................................................176  
25.5 Pin Driver Strength .............................................................................................179  
25.6 Pin Threshold and Hysteresis ............................................................................181  
25.7 BOD Threshold and Analog Comparator Offset .................................................184  
25.8 Internal Oscillator Speed ....................................................................................186  
25.9 Current Consumption of Peripheral Units ...........................................................190  
25.10 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulsewidth .....................................192  
26 Register Summary ............................................................................... 194  
27 Instruction Set Summary .................................................................... 196  
28 Ordering Information ........................................................................... 198  
28.1 ATtiny25 .............................................................................................................198  
28.2 ATtiny45 .............................................................................................................199  
28.3 ATtiny85 .............................................................................................................200  
29 Packaging Information ........................................................................ 201  
29.1 8P3 .....................................................................................................................201  
29.2 8S2 .....................................................................................................................202  
29.3 20M1 ..................................................................................................................203  
30 Errata ..................................................................................................... 204  
iv  
ATtiny25/45/85  
2586D–AVR–02/06  
ATtiny25/45/85  
30.1 Errata ATtiny25 ..................................................................................................204  
30.2 Errata ATtiny45 ..................................................................................................205  
30.3 Errata ATtiny85 ..................................................................................................207  
31 Datasheet Revision History ................................................................ 208  
31.1 Rev. 2586D-02/06 ..............................................................................................208  
31.2 Rev. 2586C-06/05 ..............................................................................................208  
31.3 Rev. 2586B-05/05 ..............................................................................................208  
31.4 Rev. 2586A-02/05 ..............................................................................................208  
Table of Contents....................................................................................... i  
v
2586D–AVR–02/06  
Atmel Corporation  
Atmel Operations  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131, USA  
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311  
Fax: 1(408) 487-2600  
Memory  
RF/Automotive  
Theresienstrasse 2  
Postfach 3535  
74025 Heilbronn, Germany  
Tel: (49) 71-31-67-0  
Fax: (49) 71-31-67-2340  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131, USA  
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311  
Fax: 1(408) 436-4314  
Regional Headquarters  
Microcontrollers  
2325 Orchard Parkway  
San Jose, CA 95131, USA  
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311  
Fax: 1(408) 436-4314  
1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.  
Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA  
Tel: 1(719) 576-3300  
Europe  
Atmel Sarl  
Route des Arsenaux 41  
Case Postale 80  
CH-1705 Fribourg  
Switzerland  
Tel: (41) 26-426-5555  
Fax: (41) 26-426-5500  
Fax: 1(719) 540-1759  
Biometrics/Imaging/Hi-Rel MPU/  
High Speed Converters/RF Datacom  
Avenue de Rochepleine  
La Chantrerie  
BP 70602  
44306 Nantes Cedex 3, France  
Tel: (33) 2-40-18-18-18  
Fax: (33) 2-40-18-19-60  
BP 123  
38521 Saint-Egreve Cedex, France  
Tel: (33) 4-76-58-30-00  
Fax: (33) 4-76-58-34-80  
Asia  
Room 1219  
Chinachem Golden Plaza  
77 Mody Road Tsimshatsui  
East Kowloon  
Hong Kong  
Tel: (852) 2721-9778  
Fax: (852) 2722-1369  
ASIC/ASSP/Smart Cards  
Zone Industrielle  
13106 Rousset Cedex, France  
Tel: (33) 4-42-53-60-00  
Fax: (33) 4-42-53-60-01  
1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.  
Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA  
Tel: 1(719) 576-3300  
Japan  
9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg.  
1-24-8 Shinkawa  
Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033  
Japan  
Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551  
Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581  
Fax: 1(719) 540-1759  
Scottish Enterprise Technology Park  
Maxwell Building  
East Kilbride G75 0QR, Scotland  
Tel: (44) 1355-803-000  
Fax: (44) 1355-242-743  
Literature Requests  
www.atmel.com/literature  
Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any  
intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMELS TERMS AND CONDI-  
TIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMELS WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY  
WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDEN-  
TAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT  
OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no  
representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications  
and product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Atmel’s products are not  
intended, authorized, or warranted for use as components in applications intended to support or sustain life.  
© Atmel Corporation 2006. All rights reserved. Atmel®, logo and combinations thereof, AVR®, AVR Studio®, and Everywhere You Are® are  
registered trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Other terms and product names may be trademarks of others.  
Printed on recycled paper.  
2586D–AVR–02/06  

相关型号:

ATTINY25-10PU

Microcontroller
ATMEL

ATTINY25-10SI

Microcontroller,
ATMEL

ATTINY25-10SU

Microcontroller,
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15MT

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15MT

IC MCU 8BIT 2KB FLASH 20WQFN
MICROCHIP

ATTINY25-15MT1

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15MT1

IC MCU 8BIT 2KB FLASH 20WQFN
MICROCHIP

ATTINY25-15MZ

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15ST

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15ST1

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL

ATTINY25-15ST1

IC MCU 8BIT 2KB FLASH 8SOIC
MICROCHIP

ATTINY25-15SZ

8-bit Microcontroller with 2/4/8K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL